]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
(shadowfile-unload-hook): Set as variable w/ add-hook.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004
12 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13
14 @quotation
15 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
16 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
17 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
18 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
19 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
20 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
21 License'' in the Emacs manual.
22
23 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
24 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
25 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
26
27 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
28 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
29 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
30 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
31 @end quotation
32 @end copying
33
34 @iftex
35 @iflatex
36 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
37 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
38 \usepackage{pagestyle}
39 \usepackage{epsfig}
40 \usepackage{pixidx}
41 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
42
43 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \else
45 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
46 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
47 \pdfcompresslevel=9
48 \fi
49
50 \makeindex
51 \begin{document}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
363
364 @end ifinfo
365
366 @iftex
367
368 @iflatex
369 \tableofcontents
370 \gnuscleardoublepage
371 @end iflatex
372
373 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
374 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
375
376 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
377 being accused of plagiarism:
378
379 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
380 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
381 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
382 can even read news with it!
383
384 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
385 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
386 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
387 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
388 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
389 the program.
390
391 @end iftex
392
393 @menu
394 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
395 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
396 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
397 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
398 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
399 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
400 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
401 * Various:: General purpose settings.
402 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
403 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
404 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
405 * Key Index:: Key Index.
406
407 Other related manuals
408
409 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
410 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
411 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
412 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
413
414 @detailmenu
415 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
416
417 Starting Gnus
418
419 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
420 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
421 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
422 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
423 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
424 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
425 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
426 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
427 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
428 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
429 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
430
431 New Groups
432
433 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
434 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
435 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
436
437 Group Buffer
438
439 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
440 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
441 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
442 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
443 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
444 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
445 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
446 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
447 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
448 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
449 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
450 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
451 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
452 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
453 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
454 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
455 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
456
457 Group Buffer Format
458
459 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
460 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
461 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
462
463 Group Topics
464
465 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
466 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
467 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
468 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
469 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
470
471 Misc Group Stuff
472
473 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
474 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
475 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
476 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
477 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
478
479 Summary Buffer
480
481 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
482 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
483 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
484 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
485 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
486 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
487 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
488 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
489 * Threading:: How threads are made.
490 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
491 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
492 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
493 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
494 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
495 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
496 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
497 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
498 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
499 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
500 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
501 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
502 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
503 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
504 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
505 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
506 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
507 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
508 or reselecting the current group.
509 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
510 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
511 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
512 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
513
514 Summary Buffer Format
515
516 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
517 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
518 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
519 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
520
521 Choosing Articles
522
523 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
524 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
525
526 Reply, Followup and Post
527
528 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
529 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
530 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
531 * Canceling and Superseding::
532
533 Marking Articles
534
535 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
536 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
537 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
538 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
539 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
540 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
541
542 Threading
543
544 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
545 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
546
547 Customizing Threading
548
549 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
550 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
551 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
552 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
553
554 Decoding Articles
555
556 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
557 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
558 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
559 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
560 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
561 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
562
563 Decoding Variables
564
565 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
566 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
567 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
568
569 Article Treatment
570
571 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
572 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
573 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
574 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
575 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
576 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
577 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
578 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
579 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
580 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
581 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
582
583 Alternative Approaches
584
585 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
586 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
587
588 Various Summary Stuff
589
590 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
591 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
592 * Summary Generation Commands::
593 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
594
595 Article Buffer
596
597 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
598 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
599 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
600 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
601 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
602
603 Composing Messages
604
605 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
606 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
607 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
608 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
609 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
610 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
611 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
612 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
613 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
614
615 Select Methods
616
617 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
618 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
619 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
620 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
621 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
622 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
623 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
624 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
625
626 Server Buffer
627
628 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
629 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
630 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
631 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
632 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
633 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
634 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
635
636 Getting News
637
638 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
639 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
640
641 @acronym{NNTP}
642
643 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
644 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
645 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
646
647 Getting Mail
648
649 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
650 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
651 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
652 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
653 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
654 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
655 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
656 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
657 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
658 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
659 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
660 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
661 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
662
663 Mail Sources
664
665 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
666 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
667 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
668
669 Choosing a Mail Back End
670
671 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
672 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
673 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
674 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
675 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
676 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
677 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
678
679 Browsing the Web
680
681 * Archiving Mail::
682 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
683 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
684 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
685 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
686 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
687 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
688
689 @acronym{IMAP}
690
691 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
692 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
693 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
694 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
695 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
696 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
697
698 Other Sources
699
700 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
701 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
702 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
703 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
704 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
705
706 Document Groups
707
708 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
709
710 SOUP
711
712 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
713 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
714 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
715
716 Combined Groups
717
718 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
719 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
720
721 Gnus Unplugged
722
723 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
724 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
725 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
726 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
727 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
728 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
729 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
730 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
731 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
732 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
733 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
734 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
735 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
736
737 Agent Categories
738
739 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
740 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
741 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
742
743 Agent Commands
744
745 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
746 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
747 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
748
749 Scoring
750
751 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
752 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
753 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
754 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
755 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
756 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
757 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
758 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
759 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
760 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
761 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
762 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
763 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
764 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
765 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
766 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
767 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
768
769 GroupLens
770
771 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
772 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
773 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
774 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
775
776 Advanced Scoring
777
778 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
779 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
780 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
781
782 Various
783
784 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
785 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
786 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
787 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
788 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
789 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
790 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
791 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
792 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
793 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
794 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
795 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
796 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
797 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
798 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
799 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
800 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
801 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
802 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
803 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
804
805 Formatting Variables
806
807 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
808 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
809 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
810 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
811 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
812 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
813 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
814 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
815
816 Image Enhancements
817
818 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
819 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
820 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
821 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
822 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
823
824 Thwarting Email Spam
825
826 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
827 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
828 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
829 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
830 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
831 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
832
833 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
834
835 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
836 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
838 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
839 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
840 * BBDB Whitelists::
841 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
842 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
843 * Blackholes::
844 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
845 * Bogofilter::
846 * ifile spam filtering::
847 * spam-stat spam filtering::
848 * SpamOracle::
849 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
850
851 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
852
853 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
854 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
855 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
856
857 Appendices
858
859 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
860 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
861 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
862 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
863 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
864 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
865 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
866 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
867 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
868
869 History
870
871 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
872 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
873 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
874 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
875 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
876 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
877 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
878 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
879 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
880
881 New Features
882
883 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
884 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
885 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
886 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
887 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
888 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10.
889
890 Customization
891
892 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
893 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
894 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
895 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
896
897 Gnus Reference Guide
898
899 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
900 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
901 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
902 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
903 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
904 * Group Info:: The group info format.
905 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
906 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
907 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
908
909 Back End Interface
910
911 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
912 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
913 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
914 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
915 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
916 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
917
918 Various File Formats
919
920 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
921 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
922
923 Emacs for Heathens
924
925 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
926 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
927
928 @end detailmenu
929 @end menu
930
931 @node Starting Up
932 @chapter Starting Gnus
933 @cindex starting up
934
935 @kindex M-x gnus
936 @findex gnus
937 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
938 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
939 your Emacs.
940
941 @findex gnus-other-frame
942 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
943 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
944 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945
946 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
947 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
948 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949
950 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
951 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
952
953 @menu
954 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
955 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
956 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
957 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
958 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
959 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
960 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
961 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
962 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
963 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
964 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
965 @end menu
966
967
968 @node Finding the News
969 @section Finding the News
970 @cindex finding news
971
972 @vindex gnus-select-method
973 @c @head
974 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
975 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
976 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
977 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
978 foreign groups.
979
980 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
981 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
982
983 @lisp
984 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
985 @end lisp
986
987 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
988
989 @lisp
990 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
991 @end lisp
992
993 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
994 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
995 server is running Leafnode; in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996
997 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex NNTPSERVER
999 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1000 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1001 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1002 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1003 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1004 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1005 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1008 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1009 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1010 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011
1012 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1013 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1014 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1015 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1016 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1017 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1018 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1019 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1020 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 server.)
1022
1023 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 @kindex B (Group)
1025 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1026 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1027 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1028 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1029 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1030 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 @c @head
1034 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1035 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1036 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1037 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1038 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1039 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 groups are.
1041
1042 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1043 you would typically set this variable to
1044
1045 @lisp
1046 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1047 @end lisp
1048
1049
1050 @node The First Time
1051 @section The First Time
1052 @cindex first time usage
1053
1054 If no startup files exist, Gnus will try to determine what groups should
1055 be subscribed by default.
1056
1057 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1058 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1059 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1060 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 something useful.
1062
1063 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1064 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1065 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066
1067 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1068 help you with most common problems.
1069
1070 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1071 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1072 special.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142 @node Fetching a Group
1143 @section Fetching a Group
1144 @cindex fetching a group
1145
1146 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1147 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1148 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
1149 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1150 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1151 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1152
1153
1154 @node New Groups
1155 @section New Groups
1156 @cindex new groups
1157 @cindex subscription
1158
1159 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1160 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1161 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1162 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1163 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1164 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1165 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1166 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1167 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1168
1169 @menu
1170 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1171 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1172 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1173 @end menu
1174
1175
1176 @node Checking New Groups
1177 @subsection Checking New Groups
1178
1179 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1180 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1181 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1182 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1183 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1184 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1185 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1186 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1187 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1188 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1189
1190 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1191 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1192 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1193 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1194 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1195 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1196 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1197 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1198 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1199 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1200 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1201
1202 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1203 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1204 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1205 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1206 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1207 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1208
1209
1210 @node Subscription Methods
1211 @subsection Subscription Methods
1212
1213 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1214 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1215 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1216
1217 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1218 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1219
1220 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1221
1222 @table @code
1223
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1226 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1227 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1228 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1229
1230 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1231 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1232 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1233 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1237 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1241 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1242 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1243 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1244 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1245 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1246 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1247 up. Or something like that.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1251 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1252 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1253 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1254
1255 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1256 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1257 Kill all new groups.
1258
1259 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1260 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1261 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1262 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1263 topic parameter that looks like
1264
1265 @example
1266 "nnslashdot"
1267 @end example
1268
1269 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1270 that topic.
1271
1272 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1273 top-level topic.
1274
1275 @end table
1276
1277 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1278 A closely related variable is
1279 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1280 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1281 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1282 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1283 hierarchy or not.
1284
1285 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1286 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1287 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1288 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1289
1290
1291 @node Filtering New Groups
1292 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1293
1294 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1295 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1296 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1297
1298 @example
1299 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1300 @end example
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1303 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1304 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1305 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1306 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1307 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1308 subscribing these groups.
1309 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1310 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1311
1312 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1313 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1314 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1315 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1316 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1317 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1318 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1319 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1320
1321 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1322 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1323 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1324 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1325 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1326 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1327 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1328 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1329 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1330 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1331 @code{nil}.
1332
1333 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1334 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1335
1336
1337 @node Changing Servers
1338 @section Changing Servers
1339 @cindex changing servers
1340
1341 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1342 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1343 very flaky and you want to use another.
1344
1345 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1346 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1347
1348 @emph{Wrong!}
1349
1350 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1351 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1352 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1353 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1354 worthless.
1355
1356 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1357 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1358 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1359 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1360
1361 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1362 @findex gnus-change-server
1363 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1364 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1365 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1366 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1367 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1368
1369 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1370 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1371 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1372 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1373 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1374
1375 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1376 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1377 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1378 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1379 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1380 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1381
1382 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1383 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1384 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1385 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1386
1387 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1388 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1389 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1390 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1391 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1392 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1393 cache for all groups).
1394
1395
1396 @node Startup Files
1397 @section Startup Files
1398 @cindex startup files
1399 @cindex .newsrc
1400 @cindex .newsrc.el
1401 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1402
1403 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1404 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1405
1406 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1407 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1408 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1409 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1410 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1411 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1412 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1413
1414 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1415 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1416 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1417 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1418 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1419 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1420
1421 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1422 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1423 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1424 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1425 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1426 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1427 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1428 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1429 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1430 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1431
1432 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1433 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1434 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1435 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1436 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1437 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1438 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1439 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1440 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1441 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1442 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1443 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1444
1445 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1446 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1447 @vindex version-control
1448 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1449 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1450 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1451 If you want version control for this file, set
1452 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1453 @code{version-control} variable.
1454
1455 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1456 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1457 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1458 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1459 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1460 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1461 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1462 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1463 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1464 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1465
1466 @lisp
1467 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1468 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1469
1470 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1471 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1472 @end lisp
1473
1474 @vindex gnus-init-file
1475 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1476 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1477 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1478 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1479 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1480 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1481 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1482 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1483 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1484 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1485
1486
1487
1488 @node Auto Save
1489 @section Auto Save
1490 @cindex dribble file
1491 @cindex auto-save
1492
1493 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1494 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1495 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1496 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1497 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1498 this file.
1499
1500 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1501 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1502 saved.
1503
1504 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1505 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1506 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1507
1508 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1509 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1510 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1511 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1512 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1513 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1514
1515 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1516 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1517 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1518
1519
1520 @node The Active File
1521 @section The Active File
1522 @cindex active file
1523 @cindex ignored groups
1524
1525 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1526 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1527 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1528
1529 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1530 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1531 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1532 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1533 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1534 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1535 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1536
1537 @c This variable is
1538 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1539 @c if you set it to anything else.
1540
1541 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1542 @c @head
1543 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1544 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1545 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1546
1547 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1548 you actually subscribe to.
1549
1550 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1551 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1552 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1553 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1554
1555 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1556 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1557 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1558 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1559 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1560 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1561
1562 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1563 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1564 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1565 variable.
1566
1567 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1568 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1569 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1570 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1571 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1572 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1573
1574 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1575 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1576
1577 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1578 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1579
1580 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1581 secondary select methods.
1582
1583
1584 @node Startup Variables
1585 @section Startup Variables
1586
1587 @table @code
1588
1589 @item gnus-load-hook
1590 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1591 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1592 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1593 times you start Gnus.
1594
1595 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1597 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1598
1599 @item gnus-startup-hook
1600 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1601 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1602
1603 @item gnus-started-hook
1604 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1605 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1606 successfully.
1607
1608 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1609 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1610 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1611 generating the group buffer.
1612
1613 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1614 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1615 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1616 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1617 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1618 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1619 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1620 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1621
1622 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1623 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1624 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1625 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1626 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1627 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1628
1629 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1630 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1631 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1632
1633 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1634 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1635 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1636
1637 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1638 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1639 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1640 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1641
1642 @end table
1643
1644
1645 @node Group Buffer
1646 @chapter Group Buffer
1647 @cindex group buffer
1648
1649 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1650 @c
1651 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1652 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1653 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1654 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1655 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1656 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1657 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1658 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1659 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1660 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1661 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1662 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1663 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1664 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1665 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1666 @c human rights at 9...
1667
1668
1669 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1670 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1671 long as Gnus is active.
1672
1673 @iftex
1674 @iflatex
1675 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1676 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1677 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1678 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1679 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1680 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1681 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1682 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1683 }
1684 @end iflatex
1685 @end iftex
1686
1687 @menu
1688 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1689 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1690 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1691 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1692 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1693 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1694 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1695 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1696 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1697 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1698 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1699 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1700 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1701 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1702 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1703 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1704 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1705 @end menu
1706
1707
1708 @node Group Buffer Format
1709 @section Group Buffer Format
1710
1711 @menu
1712 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1713 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1714 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1715 @end menu
1716
1717
1718 @node Group Line Specification
1719 @subsection Group Line Specification
1720 @cindex group buffer format
1721
1722 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1723 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1724
1725 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1726
1727 @example
1728 25: news.announce.newusers
1729 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1730 @end example
1731
1732 Quite simple, huh?
1733
1734 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1735 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1736 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1737 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1738
1739 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1740 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1741 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1742 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1743 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1744 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1745
1746 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1747
1748 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1749 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1750 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1751 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1752 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1753
1754 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1755 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1756 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1757
1758 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1759
1760 @table @samp
1761
1762 @item M
1763 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1764
1765 @item S
1766 Whether the group is subscribed.
1767
1768 @item L
1769 Level of subscribedness.
1770
1771 @item N
1772 Number of unread articles.
1773
1774 @item I
1775 Number of dormant articles.
1776
1777 @item T
1778 Number of ticked articles.
1779
1780 @item R
1781 Number of read articles.
1782
1783 @item U
1784 Number of unseen articles.
1785
1786 @item t
1787 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1788 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1789
1790 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1791 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1792 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1793 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1794 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1795 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1796 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1797 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1798
1799 @item y
1800 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1801
1802 @item i
1803 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1804
1805 @item g
1806 Full group name.
1807
1808 @item G
1809 Group name.
1810
1811 @item C
1812 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1813 comment element in the group parameters.
1814
1815 @item D
1816 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1817 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1818 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1819 command.
1820
1821 @item o
1822 @samp{m} if moderated.
1823
1824 @item O
1825 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1826
1827 @item s
1828 Select method.
1829
1830 @item B
1831 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1832
1833 @item n
1834 Select from where.
1835
1836 @item z
1837 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1838 used.
1839
1840 @item P
1841 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1842
1843 @item c
1844 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1845 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1846 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1847 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1848 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1849
1850 @item m
1851 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1852 @cindex %
1853 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1854 the group lately.
1855
1856 @item p
1857 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1858
1859 @item d
1860 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1861 Timestamp}).
1862
1863 @item u
1864 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1865 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1866 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1867 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1868 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1869 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1870 specifier.
1871 @end table
1872
1873 @cindex *
1874 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1875 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1876 group, or a bogus native group.
1877
1878
1879 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1880 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1881 @cindex group mode line
1882
1883 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1884 The mode line can be changed by setting
1885 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1886 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1887
1888 @table @samp
1889 @item S
1890 The native news server.
1891 @item M
1892 The native select method.
1893 @end table
1894
1895
1896 @node Group Highlighting
1897 @subsection Group Highlighting
1898 @cindex highlighting
1899 @cindex group highlighting
1900
1901 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1902 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1903 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1904 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1905 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1906
1907 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1908 background is dark:
1909
1910 @lisp
1911 (cond (window-system
1912 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1913 (defface my-group-face-1
1914 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-2
1916 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1917 "Second group face")
1918 (defface my-group-face-3
1919 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1920 (defface my-group-face-4
1921 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1922 (defface my-group-face-5
1923 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1924
1925 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1926 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1927 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1928 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1929 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1930 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1931 @end lisp
1932
1933 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1934
1935 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1936 include:
1937
1938 @table @code
1939 @item group
1940 The group name.
1941 @item unread
1942 The number of unread articles in the group.
1943 @item method
1944 The select method.
1945 @item mailp
1946 Whether the group is a mail group.
1947 @item level
1948 The level of the group.
1949 @item score
1950 The score of the group.
1951 @item ticked
1952 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1953 @item total
1954 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1955 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1956 @item topic
1957 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1958 topic being inserted.
1959 @end table
1960
1961 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1962 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1963 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1964
1965 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1966 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1967 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1968 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1969 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1970
1971
1972 @node Group Maneuvering
1973 @section Group Maneuvering
1974 @cindex group movement
1975
1976 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1977 expected, hopefully.
1978
1979 @table @kbd
1980
1981 @item n
1982 @kindex n (Group)
1983 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1984 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1985 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1986
1987 @item p
1988 @itemx DEL
1989 @kindex DEL (Group)
1990 @kindex p (Group)
1991 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1992 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1993 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1994
1995 @item N
1996 @kindex N (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1998 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1999
2000 @item P
2001 @kindex P (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2003 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2004
2005 @item M-n
2006 @kindex M-n (Group)
2007 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2008 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2009 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2010
2011 @item M-p
2012 @kindex M-p (Group)
2013 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2014 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2015 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2016 @end table
2017
2018 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2019
2020 @table @kbd
2021
2022 @item j
2023 @kindex j (Group)
2024 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2025 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2026 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2027 like living groups.
2028
2029 @item ,
2030 @kindex , (Group)
2031 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2032 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2033 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2034
2035 @item .
2036 @kindex . (Group)
2037 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2038 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2039 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2040 @end table
2041
2042 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2043 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2044 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2045 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2046 is @code{t}.
2047
2048
2049 @node Selecting a Group
2050 @section Selecting a Group
2051 @cindex group selection
2052
2053 @table @kbd
2054
2055 @item SPACE
2056 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2057 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2058 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2059 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2060 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2061 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2062 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2063 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2064 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2065 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2066
2067 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2068 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2069 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2070
2071 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2072 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2073 ones.
2074
2075 @item RET
2076 @kindex RET (Group)
2077 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2078 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2079 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2080 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2081 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2082 entry.
2083
2084 @item M-RET
2085 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2086 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2087 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2088 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2089 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2090 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2091 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2092 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2093 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2094 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2095
2096 @item M-SPACE
2097 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2098 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2099 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2100 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2101 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2102
2103 @item C-M-RET
2104 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2105 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2106 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2107 doing any processing of its contents
2108 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2109 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2110 manner will have no permanent effects.
2111
2112 @end table
2113
2114 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2115 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2116 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2117 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2118 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2119 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2120 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2121 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2122 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2123 most recently will be fetched.
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2126 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2127 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2128 newsgroups.
2129
2130 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2131 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2132 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2133 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2134 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2135 Which article this is is controlled by the
2136 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2137 variable is:
2138
2139 @table @code
2140
2141 @item unread
2142 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2143
2144 @item first
2145 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2146
2147 @item unseen
2148 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2149
2150 @item unseen-or-unread
2151 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2152 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2153 unread article.
2154
2155 @item best
2156 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2157
2158 @end table
2159
2160 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2161 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2162
2163 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2164 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2165 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2166 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2167 selected.
2168
2169
2170 @node Subscription Commands
2171 @section Subscription Commands
2172 @cindex subscription
2173
2174 @table @kbd
2175
2176 @item S t
2177 @itemx u
2178 @kindex S t (Group)
2179 @kindex u (Group)
2180 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2181 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2182 Toggle subscription to the current group
2183 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2184
2185 @item S s
2186 @itemx U
2187 @kindex S s (Group)
2188 @kindex U (Group)
2189 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2190 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2191 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2192 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2193
2194 @item S k
2195 @itemx C-k
2196 @kindex S k (Group)
2197 @kindex C-k (Group)
2198 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2199 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2200 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2201
2202 @item S y
2203 @itemx C-y
2204 @kindex S y (Group)
2205 @kindex C-y (Group)
2206 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2207 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2208
2209 @item C-x C-t
2210 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2211 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2212 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2213 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2214 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2215
2216 @item S w
2217 @itemx C-w
2218 @kindex S w (Group)
2219 @kindex C-w (Group)
2220 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2221 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2222
2223 @item S z
2224 @kindex S z (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2226 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2227
2228 @item S C-k
2229 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2230 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2231 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2232 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2233 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2234 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2235 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2236 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2237 @file{.newsrc} file.
2238
2239 @end table
2240
2241 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2242
2243
2244 @node Group Data
2245 @section Group Data
2246
2247 @table @kbd
2248
2249 @item c
2250 @kindex c (Group)
2251 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2252 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2253 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2254 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2255 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2256 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2257 the group buffer.
2258
2259 @item C
2260 @kindex C (Group)
2261 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2262 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2263 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2264
2265 @item M-c
2266 @kindex M-c (Group)
2267 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2268 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2269 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2270
2271 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2272 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2273 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2274 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2275 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2276 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2277 caution.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281
2282 @node Group Levels
2283 @section Group Levels
2284 @cindex group level
2285 @cindex level
2286
2287 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2288 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2289 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2290 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2291 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2292
2293 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2294
2295 @table @kbd
2296
2297 @item S l
2298 @kindex S l (Group)
2299 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2300 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2301 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2302 prompted for a level.
2303 @end table
2304
2305 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2306 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2307 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2308 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2309 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2310 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2311 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2312 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2313 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2314 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2315 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2316 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2317 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2318 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2319 reasons of efficiency.
2320
2321 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2322 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2323
2324 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2325 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2326 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2327 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2328 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2329 groups are hidden, in a way.
2330
2331 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2332 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2333 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2334 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2335 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2336 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2337
2338 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2339 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2340 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2341 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2342 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2343 list of killed groups.)
2344
2345 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2346 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2347 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2348
2349 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2350 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2351 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2352 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2353 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2354 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2355 relevant valid ranges.
2356
2357 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2358 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2359 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2360 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2361 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2362 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2363 rest.
2364
2365 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2366 one with the best level.
2367
2368 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2369 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2370 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2371 by default.
2372
2373 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2374 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2375 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2376 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2377 listed.
2378
2379 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2380 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2381 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2382 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2383
2384 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2385 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2386 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2387 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2388 to 5. The default is 6.
2389
2390
2391 @node Group Score
2392 @section Group Score
2393 @cindex group score
2394 @cindex group rank
2395 @cindex rank
2396
2397 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2398 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2399 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2400 reason?
2401
2402 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2403 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2404 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2405 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2406 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2407 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2408 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2409 least significant part.))
2410
2411 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2412 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2413 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2414 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2415 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2416 action after each summary exit, you can add
2417 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2418 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2419 slow things down somewhat.
2420
2421
2422 @node Marking Groups
2423 @section Marking Groups
2424 @cindex marking groups
2425
2426 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2427 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2428 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2429 bidding on those groups.
2430
2431 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2432 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2433 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2434
2435 @table @kbd
2436
2437 @item #
2438 @kindex # (Group)
2439 @itemx M m
2440 @kindex M m (Group)
2441 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2442 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2443
2444 @item M-#
2445 @kindex M-# (Group)
2446 @itemx M u
2447 @kindex M u (Group)
2448 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2449 Remove the mark from the current group
2450 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2451
2452 @item M U
2453 @kindex M U (Group)
2454 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2455 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2456
2457 @item M w
2458 @kindex M w (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2460 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2461
2462 @item M b
2463 @kindex M b (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2465 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2466
2467 @item M r
2468 @kindex M r (Group)
2469 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2470 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2471 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2472 @end table
2473
2474 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2475
2476 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2477 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2478 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2479 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2480 the command to be executed.
2481
2482
2483 @node Foreign Groups
2484 @section Foreign Groups
2485 @cindex foreign groups
2486
2487 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2488 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2489 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2490 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2491 consulted.
2492
2493 @table @kbd
2494
2495 @item G m
2496 @kindex G m (Group)
2497 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2498 @cindex making groups
2499 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2500 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2501 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2502
2503 @item G M
2504 @kindex G M (Group)
2505 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2506 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2507 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2508
2509 @item G r
2510 @kindex G r (Group)
2511 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2512 @cindex renaming groups
2513 Rename the current group to something else
2514 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2515 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2516 on some back ends.
2517
2518 @item G c
2519 @kindex G c (Group)
2520 @cindex customizing
2521 @findex gnus-group-customize
2522 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2523
2524 @item G e
2525 @kindex G e (Group)
2526 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2527 @cindex renaming groups
2528 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2529 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2530
2531 @item G p
2532 @kindex G p (Group)
2533 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2534 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2535 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2536
2537 @item G E
2538 @kindex G E (Group)
2539 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2540 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2541 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2542
2543 @item G d
2544 @kindex G d (Group)
2545 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2546 @cindex nndir
2547 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2548 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2549
2550 @item G h
2551 @kindex G h (Group)
2552 @cindex help group
2553 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2554 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2555
2556 @item G a
2557 @kindex G a (Group)
2558 @cindex (ding) archive
2559 @cindex archive group
2560 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2561 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2562 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2563 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2564 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2565 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2566 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2567
2568 @item G k
2569 @kindex G k (Group)
2570 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2571 @cindex nnkiboze
2572 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2573 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2574 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2575 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2576
2577 @item G D
2578 @kindex G D (Group)
2579 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2580 @cindex nneething
2581 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2582 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2583 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2584
2585 @item G f
2586 @kindex G f (Group)
2587 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2588 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2589 @cindex nndoc
2590 Make a group based on some file or other
2591 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2592 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2593 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2594 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2595 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2596 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2597 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2598 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2599 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2600
2601 @item G u
2602 @kindex G u (Group)
2603 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2604 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2605 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2606 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2607
2608 @item G w
2609 @kindex G w (Group)
2610 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2611 @cindex Google
2612 @cindex nnweb
2613 @cindex gmane
2614 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2615 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2616 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2617 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2618 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2619 @xref{Web Searches}.
2620
2621 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2622 to a particular group by using a match string like
2623 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2624
2625 @item G R
2626 @kindex G R (Group)
2627 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2628 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2629 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2630 @xref{RSS}.
2631
2632 @item G DEL
2633 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2634 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2635 This function will delete the current group
2636 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2637 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2638 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2639 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2640 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2641
2642 @item G V
2643 @kindex G V (Group)
2644 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2645 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2646 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2647
2648 @item G v
2649 @kindex G v (Group)
2650 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2651 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2652 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2653 @end table
2654
2655 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2656 methods.
2657
2658 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2659 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2660 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2661 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2662 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2663 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2664 newsgroups.
2665
2666
2667 @node Group Parameters
2668 @section Group Parameters
2669 @cindex group parameters
2670
2671 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2672 Here's an example group parameter list:
2673
2674 @example
2675 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2676 (auto-expire . t))
2677 @end example
2678
2679 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2680 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2681 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2682 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2683
2684 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2685 is an alist of regexps and values.
2686
2687 The following group parameters can be used:
2688
2689 @table @code
2690 @item to-address
2691 @cindex to-address
2692 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2693
2694 @example
2695 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2696 @end example
2697
2698 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2699 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2700 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2701 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2702 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2703
2704 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2705 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2706 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2707 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2708 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2709 list address instead.
2710
2711 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2712
2713 @item to-list
2714 @cindex to-list
2715 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2716
2717 @example
2718 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2719 @end example
2720
2721 It is totally ignored
2722 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2723 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2724
2725 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2726 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2727 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2728 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2729 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2730
2731 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2732 @cindex mail list groups
2733 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2734 entering summary buffer.
2735
2736 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2737
2738 @anchor{subscribed}
2739 @item subscribed
2740 @cindex subscribed
2741 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2742 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2743 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2744 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2745 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2746 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2747 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2748 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2749
2750 @lisp
2751 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2752 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2753 @end lisp
2754
2755 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2756 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2757
2758 @item visible
2759 @cindex visible
2760 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2761 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2762 of whether it has any unread articles.
2763
2764 @item broken-reply-to
2765 @cindex broken-reply-to
2766 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2767 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2768 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2769 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2770 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2771 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2772
2773 @item to-group
2774 @cindex to-group
2775 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2776 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2777
2778 @item newsgroup
2779 @cindex newsgroup
2780 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2781 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2782 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2783 news group.
2784
2785 @item gcc-self
2786 @cindex gcc-self
2787 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2788 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2789 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2790 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2791 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2792 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2793 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2794
2795 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2796 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2797 doesn't accept articles.
2798
2799 @item auto-expire
2800 @cindex auto-expire
2801 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2802 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2803 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2804
2805 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2806
2807 @item total-expire
2808 @cindex total-expire
2809 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2810 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2811 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2812 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2813 expiry.
2814
2815 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2816
2817 @item expiry-wait
2818 @cindex expiry-wait
2819 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2820 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2821 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2822 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2823 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2824 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2825 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2826
2827 @item expiry-target
2828 @cindex expiry-target
2829 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2830 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2831
2832 @item score-file
2833 @cindex score file group parameter
2834 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2835 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2836 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2837
2838 @item adapt-file
2839 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2840 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2841 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2842 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2843
2844 @item admin-address
2845 @cindex admin-address
2846 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2847 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2848 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2849 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2850
2851 @item display
2852 @cindex display
2853 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2854 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2855
2856 @table @code
2857 @item all
2858 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2859
2860 @item an integer
2861 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2862 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2863
2864 @item default
2865 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2866 ticked articles.
2867
2868 @item an array
2869 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2870
2871 Here are some examples:
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @item [unread]
2875 Display only unread articles.
2876
2877 @item [not expire]
2878 Display everything except expirable articles.
2879
2880 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2881 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2882 responded to.
2883 @end table
2884
2885 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2886 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2887 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2888 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2889 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2890
2891 @end table
2892
2893 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2894 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2895 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2896
2897 @item comment
2898 @cindex comment
2899 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2900 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2901 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2902
2903 @item charset
2904 @cindex charset
2905 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2906 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2907 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2908
2909 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2910
2911 @item ignored-charsets
2912 @cindex ignored-charset
2913 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2914 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2915 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2918
2919 @item posting-style
2920 @cindex posting-style
2921 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2922 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2923 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2924 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2925 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2926
2927 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2928 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2929 like this in the group parameters:
2930
2931 @example
2932 (posting-style
2933 (name "Funky Name")
2934 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2935 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2936 @end example
2937
2938 @item post-method
2939 @cindex post-method
2940 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2941 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2942
2943 @item banner
2944 @cindex banner
2945 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2946 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2947 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2948 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2949 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2950
2951 @item sieve
2952 @cindex sieve
2953 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2954 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2955 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2956 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2957
2958 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2959 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2960 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2961 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2962
2963 @example
2964 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2965 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2966 @}
2967 @end example
2968
2969 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2970 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2971
2972 @item (agent parameters)
2973 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2974 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2975 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2976 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2977 minimize the configuration effort.
2978
2979 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2980 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2981 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2982 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2983 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2984 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2985 @code{eval}ed there.
2986
2987 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2988 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2989 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2990 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2991 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2992 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2993 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2994 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2995
2996 @lisp
2997 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2998 @end lisp
2999
3000 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3001 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3002 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3003
3004 @example
3005 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3006 @end example
3007
3008 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3009 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3010 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3011 into the group parameters for the group.
3012
3013 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3014 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3015 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3016 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3017 @code{(ding)} form.
3018
3019 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3020 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3021 following is added to a group parameter
3022
3023 @lisp
3024 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3025 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3026 @end lisp
3027
3028 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3029 expired.
3030
3031 @end table
3032
3033 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3034 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3035 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3036 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3037 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3038
3039 @vindex gnus-parameters
3040 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3041 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3042 example:
3043
3044 @lisp
3045 (setq gnus-parameters
3046 '(("mail\\..*"
3047 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3048 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3049 (gnus-summary-line-format
3050 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3051 (gcc-self . t)
3052 (display . all))
3053
3054 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3055 (to-group . "\\1"))
3056
3057 ("mail\\.me"
3058 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3059
3060 ("list\\..*"
3061 (total-expire . t)
3062 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3063 @end lisp
3064
3065 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3066 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3067
3068
3069 @node Listing Groups
3070 @section Listing Groups
3071 @cindex group listing
3072
3073 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3074
3075 @table @kbd
3076
3077 @item l
3078 @itemx A s
3079 @kindex A s (Group)
3080 @kindex l (Group)
3081 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3082 List all groups that have unread articles
3083 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3084 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3085 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3086 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3087 groups).
3088
3089 @item L
3090 @itemx A u
3091 @kindex A u (Group)
3092 @kindex L (Group)
3093 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3094 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3095 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3096 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3097 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3098 unsubscribed groups).
3099
3100 @item A l
3101 @kindex A l (Group)
3102 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3103 List all unread groups on a specific level
3104 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3105 with no unread articles.
3106
3107 @item A k
3108 @kindex A k (Group)
3109 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3110 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3111 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3112 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3113 from the server.
3114
3115 @item A z
3116 @kindex A z (Group)
3117 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3118 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3119
3120 @item A m
3121 @kindex A m (Group)
3122 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3123 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3124 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3125
3126 @item A M
3127 @kindex A M (Group)
3128 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3129 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3130
3131 @item A A
3132 @kindex A A (Group)
3133 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3134 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3135 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3136 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3137 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3138 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3139 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3140 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3141
3142 @item A a
3143 @kindex A a (Group)
3144 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3145 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3146 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3147
3148 @item A d
3149 @kindex A d (Group)
3150 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3151 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3152 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3153
3154 @item A c
3155 @kindex A c (Group)
3156 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3157 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3158
3159 @item A ?
3160 @kindex A ? (Group)
3161 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3162 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3163
3164 @item A /
3165 @kindex A / (Group)
3166 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3167 List groups limited within the current selection
3168 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3169
3170 @item A f
3171 @kindex A f (Group)
3172 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3173 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3174
3175 @item A p
3176 @kindex A p (Group)
3177 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3178 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3179
3180 @end table
3181
3182 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3183 @cindex visible group parameter
3184 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3185 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3186 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3187 get the same effect.
3188
3189 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3190 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3191 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3192 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3193 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3194
3195
3196 @node Sorting Groups
3197 @section Sorting Groups
3198 @cindex sorting groups
3199
3200 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3201 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3202 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3203 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3204 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3205 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3206 include:
3207
3208 @table @code
3209
3210 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3211 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3212 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3213
3214 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3215 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3216 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3217
3218 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3219 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3220 Sort by group level.
3221
3222 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3224 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3225
3226 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3227 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3228 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3229 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3230
3231 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3232 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3233 Sort by number of unread articles.
3234
3235 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3236 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3237 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3238
3239 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3240 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3241 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3242
3243
3244 @end table
3245
3246 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3247 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3248 the last one.
3249
3250
3251 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3252 some sorting criteria:
3253
3254 @table @kbd
3255 @item G S a
3256 @kindex G S a (Group)
3257 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3258 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3259 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3260
3261 @item G S u
3262 @kindex G S u (Group)
3263 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3264 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3265 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3266
3267 @item G S l
3268 @kindex G S l (Group)
3269 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3270 Sort the group buffer by group level
3271 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3272
3273 @item G S v
3274 @kindex G S v (Group)
3275 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3276 Sort the group buffer by group score
3277 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3278
3279 @item G S r
3280 @kindex G S r (Group)
3281 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3282 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3283 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3284
3285 @item G S m
3286 @kindex G S m (Group)
3287 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3288 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3289 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3290
3291 @item G S n
3292 @kindex G S n (Group)
3293 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3294 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3295 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3296
3297 @end table
3298
3299 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3300 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3301
3302 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3303 commands will sort in reverse order.
3304
3305 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3306
3307 @table @kbd
3308 @item G P a
3309 @kindex G P a (Group)
3310 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3311 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3312 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3313
3314 @item G P u
3315 @kindex G P u (Group)
3316 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3317 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3318 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3319
3320 @item G P l
3321 @kindex G P l (Group)
3322 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3323 Sort the groups by group level
3324 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3325
3326 @item G P v
3327 @kindex G P v (Group)
3328 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3329 Sort the groups by group score
3330 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3331
3332 @item G P r
3333 @kindex G P r (Group)
3334 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3335 Sort the groups by group rank
3336 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3337
3338 @item G P m
3339 @kindex G P m (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3341 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3342 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3343
3344 @item G P n
3345 @kindex G P n (Group)
3346 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3347 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3348 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3349
3350 @item G P s
3351 @kindex G P s (Group)
3352 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3353 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3354
3355 @end table
3356
3357 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3358 move groups around.
3359
3360
3361 @node Group Maintenance
3362 @section Group Maintenance
3363 @cindex bogus groups
3364
3365 @table @kbd
3366 @item b
3367 @kindex b (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3369 Find bogus groups and delete them
3370 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3371
3372 @item F
3373 @kindex F (Group)
3374 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3375 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3376 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3377 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3378 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3379 zombies.
3380
3381 @item C-c C-x
3382 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3383 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3384 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3385 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3386 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3387 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3388
3389 @item C-c C-M-x
3390 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3391 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3392 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3393 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3394
3395 @end table
3396
3397
3398 @node Browse Foreign Server
3399 @section Browse Foreign Server
3400 @cindex foreign servers
3401 @cindex browsing servers
3402
3403 @table @kbd
3404 @item B
3405 @kindex B (Group)
3406 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3407 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3408 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3409 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3413 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3414 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3415 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3416
3417 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3418
3419 @table @kbd
3420 @item n
3421 @kindex n (Browse)
3422 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3423 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3424
3425 @item p
3426 @kindex p (Browse)
3427 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3428 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3429
3430 @item SPACE
3431 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3432 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3433 Enter the current group and display the first article
3434 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3435
3436 @item RET
3437 @kindex RET (Browse)
3438 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3439 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3440
3441 @item u
3442 @kindex u (Browse)
3443 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3444 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3445 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3446
3447 @item l
3448 @itemx q
3449 @kindex q (Browse)
3450 @kindex l (Browse)
3451 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3452 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3453
3454 @item d
3455 @kindex d (Browse)
3456 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3457 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3458
3459 @item ?
3460 @kindex ? (Browse)
3461 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3462 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3463 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3464 @end table
3465
3466
3467 @node Exiting Gnus
3468 @section Exiting Gnus
3469 @cindex exiting Gnus
3470
3471 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3472
3473 @table @kbd
3474 @item z
3475 @kindex z (Group)
3476 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3477 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3478 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3479 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3480
3481 @item q
3482 @kindex q (Group)
3483 @findex gnus-group-exit
3484 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3485 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3486
3487 @item Q
3488 @kindex Q (Group)
3489 @findex gnus-group-quit
3490 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3491 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3492 @end table
3493
3494 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3495 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3496 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3497 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3498 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3499 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3500 exiting Gnus.
3501
3502 Note:
3503
3504 @quotation
3505 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3506 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3507 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3508 plastic chair.
3509 @end quotation
3510
3511
3512 @node Group Topics
3513 @section Group Topics
3514 @cindex topics
3515
3516 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3517 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3518 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3519 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3520 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3521 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3522
3523 @iftex
3524 @iflatex
3525 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3526 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3527 }
3528 @end iflatex
3529 @end iftex
3530
3531 Here's an example:
3532
3533 @example
3534 Gnus
3535 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3536 3: comp.emacs
3537 2: alt.religion.emacs
3538 Naughty Emacs
3539 452: alt.sex.emacs
3540 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3541 Misc
3542 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3543 13: comp.sources.unix
3544 @end example
3545
3546 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3547 @kindex t (Group)
3548 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3549 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3550 is a toggling command.)
3551
3552 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3553 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3554 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3555 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3556 Hot and bothered?
3557
3558 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3559 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3560 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3561
3562 @lisp
3563 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3564 @end lisp
3565
3566 @menu
3567 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3568 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3569 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3570 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3571 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3572 @end menu
3573
3574
3575 @node Topic Commands
3576 @subsection Topic Commands
3577 @cindex topic commands
3578
3579 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3580 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3581 definitions slightly.
3582
3583 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3584 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3585 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3586 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3587 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3588 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3589
3590 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3591 the way you like.
3592
3593 @table @kbd
3594
3595 @item T n
3596 @kindex T n (Topic)
3597 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3598 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3599 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3600
3601 @item T TAB
3602 @itemx TAB
3603 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3604 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3605 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3606 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3607 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3608 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3609
3610 @item M-TAB
3611 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3612 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3613 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3614 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3615
3616 @end table
3617
3618 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3619 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3620 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3621 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3622
3623 @table @kbd
3624
3625 @item C-k
3626 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3627 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3628 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3629 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3630
3631 @item C-y
3632 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3633 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3634 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3635 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3636 before all groups.
3637
3638 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3639 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3640 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3641 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3642 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3643
3644 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3645 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3646
3647 @end table
3648
3649 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3650 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3651 key.
3652
3653 @table @kbd
3654
3655 @item RET
3656 @kindex RET (Topic)
3657 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3658 @itemx SPACE
3659 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3660 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3661 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3662 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3663 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3664 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3665
3666 @end table
3667
3668 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3669
3670 @table @kbd
3671
3672 @item T m
3673 @kindex T m (Topic)
3674 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3675 Move the current group to some other topic
3676 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3677 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3678
3679 @item T j
3680 @kindex T j (Topic)
3681 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3682 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3683
3684 @item T c
3685 @kindex T c (Topic)
3686 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3687 Copy the current group to some other topic
3688 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3689 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3690
3691 @item T h
3692 @kindex T h (Topic)
3693 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3694 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3695 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3696
3697 @item T s
3698 @kindex T s (Topic)
3699 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3700 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3701 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3702
3703 @item T D
3704 @kindex T D (Topic)
3705 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3706 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3707 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3708 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3709 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3710 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3711 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3712 topic.
3713
3714 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3715 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3716
3717 @item T M
3718 @kindex T M (Topic)
3719 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3720 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3721 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3722
3723 @item T C
3724 @kindex T C (Topic)
3725 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3726 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3727 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3728
3729 @item T H
3730 @kindex T H (Topic)
3731 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3732 Toggle hiding empty topics
3733 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3734
3735 @item T #
3736 @kindex T # (Topic)
3737 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3738 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3739 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3740 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3741
3742 @item T M-#
3743 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3744 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3745 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3746 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3747 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3748
3749 @item C-c C-x
3750 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3751 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3752 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3753 expiry process (if any)
3754 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3755
3756 @item T r
3757 @kindex T r (Topic)
3758 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3759 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3760
3761 @item T DEL
3762 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3763 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3764 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3765
3766 @item A T
3767 @kindex A T (Topic)
3768 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3769 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3770 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3771
3772 @item T M-n
3773 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3774 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3775 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3776
3777 @item T M-p
3778 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3779 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3780 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3781
3782 @item G p
3783 @kindex G p (Topic)
3784 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3785 @cindex group parameters
3786 @cindex topic parameters
3787 @cindex parameters
3788 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3789 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3790
3791 @end table
3792
3793
3794 @node Topic Variables
3795 @subsection Topic Variables
3796 @cindex topic variables
3797
3798 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3799 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3800
3801 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3802 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3803 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3804 Valid elements are:
3805
3806 @table @samp
3807 @item i
3808 Indentation.
3809 @item n
3810 Topic name.
3811 @item v
3812 Visibility.
3813 @item l
3814 Level.
3815 @item g
3816 Number of groups in the topic.
3817 @item a
3818 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3819 @item A
3820 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3821 @end table
3822
3823 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3824 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3825 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3826 The default is 2.
3827
3828 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3829 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3830
3831 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3832 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3833 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3834
3835
3836 @node Topic Sorting
3837 @subsection Topic Sorting
3838 @cindex topic sorting
3839
3840 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3841 commands:
3842
3843
3844 @table @kbd
3845 @item T S a
3846 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3847 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3848 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3849 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3850
3851 @item T S u
3852 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3853 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3854 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3855 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3856
3857 @item T S l
3858 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3859 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3860 Sort the current topic by group level
3861 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3862
3863 @item T S v
3864 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3865 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3866 Sort the current topic by group score
3867 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3868
3869 @item T S r
3870 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3871 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3872 Sort the current topic by group rank
3873 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3874
3875 @item T S m
3876 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3877 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3878 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3879 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3880
3881 @item T S e
3882 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3883 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3884 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3885 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3886
3887 @item T S s
3888 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3889 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3890 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3891 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3892 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3893
3894 @end table
3895
3896 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3897 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3898 sorting.
3899
3900
3901 @node Topic Topology
3902 @subsection Topic Topology
3903 @cindex topic topology
3904 @cindex topology
3905
3906 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3907
3908 @example
3909 @group
3910 Gnus
3911 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3912 3: comp.emacs
3913 2: alt.religion.emacs
3914 Naughty Emacs
3915 452: alt.sex.emacs
3916 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3917 Misc
3918 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3919 13: comp.sources.unix
3920 @end group
3921 @end example
3922
3923 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3924 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3925 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3926 follows:
3927
3928 @lisp
3929 (("Gnus" visible)
3930 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3931 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3932 (("Misc" visible)))
3933 @end lisp
3934
3935 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3936 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3937 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3938 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3939 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3940 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3941
3942 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3943 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3944 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3945
3946
3947 @node Topic Parameters
3948 @subsection Topic Parameters
3949 @cindex topic parameters
3950
3951 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3952 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3953 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3954 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3955 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3956
3957 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3958 parameters:
3959
3960 @table @code
3961 @item subscribe
3962 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3963 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3964 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3965 topic.
3966
3967 @item subscribe-level
3968 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3969 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3970 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3971
3972 @end table
3973
3974 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3975 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3976 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3977 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3978
3979 @example
3980 @group
3981 Gnus
3982 Emacs
3983 3: comp.emacs
3984 2: alt.religion.emacs
3985 452: alt.sex.emacs
3986 Relief
3987 452: alt.sex.emacs
3988 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3989 Misc
3990 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3991 13: comp.sources.unix
3992 452: alt.sex.emacs
3993 @end group
3994 @end example
3995
3996 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3997 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3998 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3999 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4000 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4001 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4002
4003 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4004 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4005 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4006 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4007 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4008
4009 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4010 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4011 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4012 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4013 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4014 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4015 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4016 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4017
4018
4019 @node Misc Group Stuff
4020 @section Misc Group Stuff
4021
4022 @menu
4023 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4024 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4025 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4026 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4027 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4028 @end menu
4029
4030 @table @kbd
4031
4032 @item ^
4033 @kindex ^ (Group)
4034 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4035 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4036 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4037
4038 @item a
4039 @kindex a (Group)
4040 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4041 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4042 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4043 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4044 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4045 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4046 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4047
4048 @item m
4049 @kindex m (Group)
4050 @findex gnus-group-mail
4051 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4052 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4053 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4054 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4055
4056 @item i
4057 @kindex i (Group)
4058 @findex gnus-group-news
4059 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4060 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4061 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4062
4063 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4064 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4065 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4066 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4067 for this to work though.
4068
4069 @end table
4070
4071 Variables for the group buffer:
4072
4073 @table @code
4074
4075 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4076 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4077 is called after the group buffer has been
4078 created.
4079
4080 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4081 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4082 is called after the group buffer is
4083 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4084 unnatural way.
4085
4086 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4087 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4088 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4089 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4090
4091 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4092 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4093 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4094 whether they are empty or not.
4095
4096 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4097 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4098 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4099 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4100
4101 For example:
4102 @lisp
4103 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4104 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4105 @end lisp
4106
4107 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4108 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4109 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4110 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4111 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4112 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4113 default is @code{nil}.
4114
4115 For example:
4116 @lisp
4117 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4118 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4119 @end lisp
4120
4121 @end table
4122
4123 @node Scanning New Messages
4124 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4125 @cindex new messages
4126 @cindex scanning new news
4127
4128 @table @kbd
4129
4130 @item g
4131 @kindex g (Group)
4132 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4133 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4134 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4135 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4136 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4137 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4138 back end(s).
4139
4140 @item M-g
4141 @kindex M-g (Group)
4142 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4143 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4144 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4145 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4146 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4147 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4148 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4149
4150 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4151 @cindex activating groups
4152 @item C-c M-g
4153 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4154 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4155
4156 @item R
4157 @kindex R (Group)
4158 @cindex restarting
4159 @findex gnus-group-restart
4160 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4161 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4162 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4163
4164 @end table
4165
4166 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4167 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4168
4169 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4170 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4171 news.
4172
4173
4174 @node Group Information
4175 @subsection Group Information
4176 @cindex group information
4177 @cindex information on groups
4178
4179 @table @kbd
4180
4181
4182 @item H f
4183 @kindex H f (Group)
4184 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4185 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4186 @cindex FAQ
4187 @cindex ange-ftp
4188 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4189 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4190 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4191 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4192 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4193 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4194 used for fetching the file.
4195
4196 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4197 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4198
4199 @item H c
4200 @kindex H c (Group)
4201 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4202 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4203 @cindex charter
4204 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4205 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4206 prefix argument.
4207
4208 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4209 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4210 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4211
4212 @item H C
4213 @kindex H C (Group)
4214 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4215 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4216 @cindex control message
4217 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4218 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4219 group if given a prefix argument.
4220
4221 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4222 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4223 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4224 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4225
4226 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4227 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4228 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4229
4230 @item H d
4231 @itemx C-c C-d
4232 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4233 @kindex H d (Group)
4234 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4235 @cindex describing groups
4236 @cindex group description
4237 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4238 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4239 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4240
4241 @item M-d
4242 @kindex M-d (Group)
4243 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4244 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4245 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4246
4247 @item H v
4248 @itemx V
4249 @kindex V (Group)
4250 @kindex H v (Group)
4251 @cindex version
4252 @findex gnus-version
4253 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4254
4255 @item ?
4256 @kindex ? (Group)
4257 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4258 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4259
4260 @item C-c C-i
4261 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4262 @cindex info
4263 @cindex manual
4264 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4265 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4266 @end table
4267
4268
4269 @node Group Timestamp
4270 @subsection Group Timestamp
4271 @cindex timestamps
4272 @cindex group timestamps
4273
4274 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4275 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4276 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4277
4278 @lisp
4279 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4280 @end lisp
4281
4282 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4283
4284 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4285 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4286
4287 @lisp
4288 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4289 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4290 @end lisp
4291
4292 This will result in lines looking like:
4293
4294 @example
4295 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4296 0: custom 19961002T012713
4297 @end example
4298
4299 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4300 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4301 something like:
4302
4303 @lisp
4304 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4305 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4306 @end lisp
4307
4308 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4309 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4310 trick:
4311
4312 @lisp
4313 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4314 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4315 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4316 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4317 (if time
4318 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4319 "")))
4320 @end lisp
4321
4322
4323 @node File Commands
4324 @subsection File Commands
4325 @cindex file commands
4326
4327 @table @kbd
4328
4329 @item r
4330 @kindex r (Group)
4331 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4332 @vindex gnus-init-file
4333 @cindex reading init file
4334 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4335 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4336
4337 @item s
4338 @kindex s (Group)
4339 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4340 @cindex saving .newsrc
4341 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4342 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4343 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4344
4345 @c @item Z
4346 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4347 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4348 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4349
4350 @end table
4351
4352
4353 @node Sieve Commands
4354 @subsection Sieve Commands
4355 @cindex group sieve commands
4356
4357 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4358 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4359 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4360 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4361 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4362
4363 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4364 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4365 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4366 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4367 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4368 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4369 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4370 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4371 regenerate the Sieve script.
4372
4373 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4374 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4375 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4376 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4377 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4378 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4379 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4380 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4381 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4382 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4383
4384 @example
4385 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4386 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4387 stop;
4388 @}
4389 @end example
4390
4391 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4392
4393 @table @kbd
4394
4395 @item D g
4396 @kindex D g (Group)
4397 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4398 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4399 @cindex generating sieve script
4400 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4401 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4402
4403 @item D u
4404 @kindex D u (Group)
4405 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4406 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4407 @cindex updating sieve script
4408 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4409 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4410 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4411
4412 @end table
4413
4414
4415 @node Summary Buffer
4416 @chapter Summary Buffer
4417 @cindex summary buffer
4418
4419 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4420 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4421
4422 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4423 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4424
4425 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4426
4427 @menu
4428 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4429 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4430 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4431 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4432 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4433 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4434 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4435 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4436 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4437 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4438 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4439 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4440 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4441 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4442 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4443 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4444 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4445 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4446 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4447 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4448 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4449 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4450 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4451 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4452 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4453 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4454 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4455 or reselecting the current group.
4456 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4457 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4458 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4459 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4460 @end menu
4461
4462
4463 @node Summary Buffer Format
4464 @section Summary Buffer Format
4465 @cindex summary buffer format
4466
4467 @iftex
4468 @iflatex
4469 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4470 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4471 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4472 }
4473 @end iflatex
4474 @end iftex
4475
4476 @menu
4477 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4478 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4479 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4480 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4481 @end menu
4482
4483 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4484 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4485 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4486 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4487 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4488 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4489 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4490 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4491 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4492 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4493 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4494
4495 @lisp
4496 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4497 'mail-extract-address-components)
4498 @end lisp
4499
4500 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4501 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4502 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4503 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4504
4505
4506 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4507 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4508
4509 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4510 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4511 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4512 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4513 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4514
4515 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4516 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4517 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4518 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4519 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4520 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4521
4522 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4523
4524 The following format specification characters and extended format
4525 specification(s) are understood:
4526
4527 @table @samp
4528 @item N
4529 Article number.
4530 @item S
4531 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4532 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4533 @item s
4534 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4535 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4536 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4537 @item F
4538 Full @code{From} header.
4539 @item n
4540 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4541 @item f
4542 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4543 From Newsgroups}).
4544 @item a
4545 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4546 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4547 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4548 may be more thorough.
4549 @item A
4550 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4551 the @code{a} spec.
4552 @item L
4553 Number of lines in the article.
4554 @item c
4555 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4556 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4557 @item k
4558 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4559 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4560 @item I
4561 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4562 @item B
4563 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4564 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4565
4566 @example
4567 >
4568 +->
4569 | +->
4570 | | \->
4571 | | \->
4572 | \->
4573 +->
4574 \->
4575 @end example
4576
4577 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4578 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4579 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4580 line-drawing glyphs.
4581 @table @code
4582 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4583 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4584 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4585 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4586
4587 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4588 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4589 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4590 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4591
4592 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4593 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4594 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4595 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4596
4597 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4598 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4599 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4600
4601 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4602 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4603 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4604
4605 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4606 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4607 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4608
4609 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4610 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4611 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4612
4613 @end table
4614
4615 @item T
4616 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4617 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4618 @item [
4619 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4620 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4621 @item ]
4622 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4623 for adopted articles.
4624 @item >
4625 One space for each thread level.
4626 @item <
4627 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4628 @item U
4629 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4630
4631 @item R
4632 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4633 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4634 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4635
4636 @item i
4637 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4638 @item z
4639 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4640 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4641 default level. If the difference between
4642 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4643 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4644 @item V
4645 Total thread score.
4646 @item x
4647 @code{Xref}.
4648 @item D
4649 @code{Date}.
4650 @item d
4651 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4652 @item o
4653 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4654 @item M
4655 @code{Message-ID}.
4656 @item r
4657 @code{References}.
4658 @item t
4659 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4660 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4661 @item e
4662 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4663 article has any children.
4664 @item P
4665 The line number.
4666 @item O
4667 Download mark.
4668 @item &user-date;
4669 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4670 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4671 @item u
4672 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4673 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4674 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4675 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4676 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4677 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4678 @end table
4679
4680 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4681 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4682 There can only be one such area.
4683
4684 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4685 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4686 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4687 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4688 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4689 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4690
4691 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4692 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4693
4694 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4695
4696
4697 @node To From Newsgroups
4698 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4699 @cindex To
4700 @cindex Newsgroups
4701
4702 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4703 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4704 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4705 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4706 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4707
4708 @enumerate
4709 @item
4710 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4711 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4712 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4713 instance:
4714
4715 @lisp
4716 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4717 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4718 @end lisp
4719
4720 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4721 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4722
4723 @item
4724 @findex gnus-extra-header
4725 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4726 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4727 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4728
4729 @example
4730 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4731 @end example
4732
4733 @item
4734 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4735 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4736 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4737 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4738 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4739 headers are used instead.
4740
4741 @end enumerate
4742
4743 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4744 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4745 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4746 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4747 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4748 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4749 regeneration.
4750
4751 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4752 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4753 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4754 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4755
4756 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4757 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4758
4759 @lisp
4760 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4761 '(To Newsgroups))
4762 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4763 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4764 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4765 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4766 "Your Name Here")
4767 @end lisp
4768
4769 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4770 to fit your needs.)
4771
4772 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4773 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4774 support:
4775
4776 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4777 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4778 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4779
4780 @example
4781 Newsgroups:full
4782 @end example
4783
4784 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4785 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4786
4787
4788 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4789 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4790
4791 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4792 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4793 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4794 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4795
4796 Here are the elements you can play with:
4797
4798 @table @samp
4799 @item G
4800 Group name.
4801 @item p
4802 Unprefixed group name.
4803 @item A
4804 Current article number.
4805 @item z
4806 Current article score.
4807 @item V
4808 Gnus version.
4809 @item U
4810 Number of unread articles in this group.
4811 @item e
4812 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4813 summary buffer.
4814 @item Z
4815 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4816 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4817 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4818 and no unselected ones.
4819 @item g
4820 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4821 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4822 @item S
4823 Subject of the current article.
4824 @item u
4825 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4826 @item s
4827 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4828 @item d
4829 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4830 @item t
4831 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4832 @item r
4833 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4834 @item E
4835 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4836 @end table
4837
4838
4839 @node Summary Highlighting
4840 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4841
4842 @table @code
4843
4844 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4845 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4846 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4847 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4848 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4849
4850 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4851 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4852 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4853 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4854
4855 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4856 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4857 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4858 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4859
4860 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4861 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4862 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4863 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4864 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4865 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4866 to something like
4867 @lisp
4868 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4869 ((> score default) . bold))
4870 @end lisp
4871 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4872 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4873 @end table
4874
4875
4876 @node Summary Maneuvering
4877 @section Summary Maneuvering
4878 @cindex summary movement
4879
4880 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4881 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4882
4883 None of these commands select articles.
4884
4885 @table @kbd
4886 @item G M-n
4887 @itemx M-n
4888 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4889 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4890 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4891 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4892 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4893
4894 @item G M-p
4895 @itemx M-p
4896 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4897 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4898 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4899 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4900 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4901
4902 @item G g
4903 @kindex G g (Summary)
4904 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4905 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4906 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4907 @end table
4908
4909 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4910 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4911 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4912 to the group buffer.
4913
4914 Variables related to summary movement:
4915
4916 @table @code
4917
4918 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4919 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4920 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4921 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4922 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4923 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4924 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4925 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4926 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4927 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4928 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4929 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4930 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4931 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4932
4933 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4934 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4935 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4936 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4937 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4938 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4939 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4940
4941 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4942
4943 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4944 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4945 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4946 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4947 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4948
4949 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4950 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4951 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4952 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4953 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4954 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4955 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4956 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4957 threads.
4958
4959 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4960 the given number of lines from the top.
4961
4962 @end table
4963
4964
4965 @node Choosing Articles
4966 @section Choosing Articles
4967 @cindex selecting articles
4968
4969 @menu
4970 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4971 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4972 @end menu
4973
4974
4975 @node Choosing Commands
4976 @subsection Choosing Commands
4977
4978 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4979 and they all select and display an article.
4980
4981 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4982 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4983
4984 @table @kbd
4985 @item SPACE
4986 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4987 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4988 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4989 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4990
4991 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
4992 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
4993 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4994
4995 @item G n
4996 @itemx n
4997 @kindex n (Summary)
4998 @kindex G n (Summary)
4999 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5000 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5001 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5002
5003 @item G p
5004 @itemx p
5005 @kindex p (Summary)
5006 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5007 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5008 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5009
5010 @item G N
5011 @itemx N
5012 @kindex N (Summary)
5013 @kindex G N (Summary)
5014 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5015 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5016
5017 @item G P
5018 @itemx P
5019 @kindex P (Summary)
5020 @kindex G P (Summary)
5021 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5022 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5023
5024 @item G C-n
5025 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5026 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5027 Go to the next article with the same subject
5028 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5029
5030 @item G C-p
5031 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5032 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5033 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5034 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5035
5036 @item G f
5037 @itemx .
5038 @kindex G f (Summary)
5039 @kindex . (Summary)
5040 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5041 Go to the first unread article
5042 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5043
5044 @item G b
5045 @itemx ,
5046 @kindex G b (Summary)
5047 @kindex , (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5049 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5051 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5052
5053 @item G l
5054 @itemx l
5055 @kindex l (Summary)
5056 @kindex G l (Summary)
5057 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5058 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5059
5060 @item G o
5061 @kindex G o (Summary)
5062 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5063 @cindex history
5064 @cindex article history
5065 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5066 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5067 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5068 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5069 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5070 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5071
5072 @item G j
5073 @itemx j
5074 @kindex j (Summary)
5075 @kindex G j (Summary)
5076 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5077 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5078 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5079
5080 @end table
5081
5082
5083 @node Choosing Variables
5084 @subsection Choosing Variables
5085
5086 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5087
5088 @table @code
5089 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5090 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5091 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5092 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5093 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5094 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5095
5096 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5097 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5098 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
5099 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article. If you would
5100 like each article to be saved in the Agent as you read it, putting
5101 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this hook will do so.
5102
5103 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5104 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5105 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5106 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5107 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5108 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5109 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5110 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5111 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
5112 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5113 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5114 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5115 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5116 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5117
5118 @end table
5119
5120
5121 @node Paging the Article
5122 @section Scrolling the Article
5123 @cindex article scrolling
5124
5125 @table @kbd
5126
5127 @item SPACE
5128 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5129 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5130 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5131 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5132 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5133
5134 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5135 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5136 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5137 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5138 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5139 what is considered uninteresting with
5140 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5141 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5142
5143 @item DEL
5144 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5145 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5146 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5147
5148 @item RET
5149 @kindex RET (Summary)
5150 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5151 Scroll the current article one line forward
5152 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5153
5154 @item M-RET
5155 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5156 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5157 Scroll the current article one line backward
5158 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5159
5160 @item A g
5161 @itemx g
5162 @kindex A g (Summary)
5163 @kindex g (Summary)
5164 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5165 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5166 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5167 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5168 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5169 the way it came from the server.
5170
5171 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5172 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5173 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5174
5175 @lisp
5176 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5177 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5178 (2 . big5)))
5179 @end lisp
5180
5181 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5182
5183 @item A <
5184 @itemx <
5185 @kindex < (Summary)
5186 @kindex A < (Summary)
5187 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5188 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5189 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5190
5191 @item A >
5192 @itemx >
5193 @kindex > (Summary)
5194 @kindex A > (Summary)
5195 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5196 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5197
5198 @item A s
5199 @itemx s
5200 @kindex A s (Summary)
5201 @kindex s (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5203 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5204 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5205
5206 @item h
5207 @kindex h (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5209 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5210
5211 @end table
5212
5213
5214 @node Reply Followup and Post
5215 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5216
5217 @menu
5218 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5219 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5220 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5221 * Canceling and Superseding::
5222 @end menu
5223
5224
5225 @node Summary Mail Commands
5226 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5227 @cindex mail
5228 @cindex composing mail
5229
5230 Commands for composing a mail message:
5231
5232 @table @kbd
5233
5234 @item S r
5235 @itemx r
5236 @kindex S r (Summary)
5237 @kindex r (Summary)
5238 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5239 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5240 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5241 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5242 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5243
5244 @item S R
5245 @itemx R
5246 @kindex R (Summary)
5247 @kindex S R (Summary)
5248 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5249 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5250 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5251 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5252 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5253
5254 @item S w
5255 @kindex S w (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5257 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5258 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5259 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5260 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5261 present, that's used instead.
5262
5263 @item S W
5264 @kindex S W (Summary)
5265 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5266 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5267 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5268 the process/prefix convention.
5269
5270 @item S v
5271 @kindex S v (Summary)
5272 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5273 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5274 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5275 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5276 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5277 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5278
5279 @item S V
5280 @kindex S V (Summary)
5281 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5282 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5283 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5284 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5285
5286 @item S B r
5287 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5288 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5289 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5290 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5291 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5292 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5293 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5294 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5295
5296 @item S B R
5297 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5298 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5299 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5300 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5301 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5302
5303 @item S o m
5304 @itemx C-c C-f
5305 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5306 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5307 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5309 Forward the current article to some other person
5310 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5311 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5312 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5313 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5314 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5315 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5316 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5317 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5318 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5319 section.
5320
5321 @item S m
5322 @itemx m
5323 @kindex m (Summary)
5324 @kindex S m (Summary)
5325 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5326 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5327 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5328 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5329 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5330
5331 @item S i
5332 @itemx i
5333 @kindex i (Summary)
5334 @kindex S i (Summary)
5335 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5336 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5337 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5338 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5339
5340 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5341 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5342 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5343 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5344 for this to work though.
5345
5346 @item S D b
5347 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5348 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5349 @cindex bouncing mail
5350 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5351 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5352 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5353 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5354 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5355 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5356 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5357 very well fail, though.
5358
5359 @item S D r
5360 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5361 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5362 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5363 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5364 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5365 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5366 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5367 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5368 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5369 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5370
5371 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5372 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5373 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5374 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5375 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5376
5377 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5378 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5379
5380 @item S D e
5381 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5382 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5383
5384 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5385 if it were a new message before resending.
5386
5387 @item S O m
5388 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5389 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5390 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5391 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5392 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5393
5394 @item S M-c
5395 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5396 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5397 @cindex crossposting
5398 @cindex excessive crossposting
5399 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5400 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5401
5402 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5403 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5404 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5405 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5406 command understands the process/prefix convention
5407 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5408
5409 @end table
5410
5411 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5412 Manual}, for more information.
5413
5414
5415 @node Summary Post Commands
5416 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5417 @cindex post
5418 @cindex composing news
5419
5420 Commands for posting a news article:
5421
5422 @table @kbd
5423 @item S p
5424 @itemx a
5425 @kindex a (Summary)
5426 @kindex S p (Summary)
5427 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5428 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5429 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5430 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5431 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5432
5433 @item S f
5434 @itemx f
5435 @kindex f (Summary)
5436 @kindex S f (Summary)
5437 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5438 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5439 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5440
5441 @item S F
5442 @itemx F
5443 @kindex S F (Summary)
5444 @kindex F (Summary)
5445 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5446 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5447 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5448 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5449 process/prefix convention.
5450
5451 @item S n
5452 @kindex S n (Summary)
5453 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5454 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5455 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5456
5457 @item S N
5458 @kindex S N (Summary)
5459 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5460 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5461 message through mail and include the original message
5462 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5463 the process/prefix convention.
5464
5465 @item S o p
5466 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5467 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5468 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5469 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5470 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5471 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5472 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5473 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5474 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5475 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5476 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5477 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5478 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5479
5480 @item S O p
5481 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5482 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5483 @cindex digests
5484 @cindex making digests
5485 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5486 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
5487 process/prefix convention.
5488
5489 @item S u
5490 @kindex S u (Summary)
5491 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5492 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5493 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5494 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5495 @end table
5496
5497 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5498 Manual}, for more information.
5499
5500
5501 @node Summary Message Commands
5502 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5503
5504 @table @kbd
5505 @item S y
5506 @kindex S y (Summary)
5507 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5508 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5509 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5510 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5511 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5512
5513 @end table
5514
5515
5516 @node Canceling and Superseding
5517 @subsection Canceling Articles
5518 @cindex canceling articles
5519 @cindex superseding articles
5520
5521 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5522 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5523
5524 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5525
5526 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5527 @kindex C (Summary)
5528 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5529 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5530 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5531 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5532 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5533 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5534
5535 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5536 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5537 question.
5538
5539 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5540 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5541 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5542
5543 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5544 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5545 message, Message Manual}).
5546
5547 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5548 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5549 your original article.
5550
5551 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5552 @kindex S (Summary)
5553 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5554 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5555 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5556 usual way.
5557
5558 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5559 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5560 have posted almost the same article twice.
5561
5562 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5563 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5564 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5565 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5566 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5567 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5568 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5569 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5570 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5571 canceled/superseded.
5572
5573 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5574
5575 @node Delayed Articles
5576 @section Delayed Articles
5577 @cindex delayed sending
5578 @cindex send delayed
5579
5580 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5581 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5582 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5583 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5584
5585 @lisp
5586 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5587 @end lisp
5588
5589 @findex gnus-delay-article
5590 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5591 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5592 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5593 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5594
5595 @itemize @bullet
5596 @item
5597 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5598 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5599 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5600 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5601
5602 @item
5603 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5604 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5605 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5606
5607 @item
5608 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5609 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5610 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5611 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5612 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5613 that means a time tomorrow.
5614 @end itemize
5615
5616 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5617 couple of variables:
5618
5619 @table @code
5620 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5621 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5622 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5623 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5624
5625 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5626 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5627 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5628 formats described above.
5629
5630 @item gnus-delay-group
5631 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5632 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5633 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5634 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5635
5636 @item gnus-delay-header
5637 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5638 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5639 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5640 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5641 @end table
5642
5643 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5644 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5645 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5646 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5647 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5648
5649 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5650 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5651 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5652 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5653 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5654 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5655 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5656
5657 @table @code
5658 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5659 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5660 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5661 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5662 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5663 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5664 argument is ignored.
5665
5666 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5667 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5668 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5669 @end table
5670
5671
5672 @node Marking Articles
5673 @section Marking Articles
5674 @cindex article marking
5675 @cindex article ticking
5676 @cindex marks
5677
5678 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5679
5680 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5681 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5682 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5683
5684 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5685
5686 @ifinfo
5687 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5688 @end ifinfo
5689
5690 @menu
5691 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5692 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5693 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5694 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5695 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5696 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5697 @end menu
5698
5699
5700 @node Unread Articles
5701 @subsection Unread Articles
5702
5703 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5704 other.
5705
5706 @table @samp
5707 @item !
5708 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5709 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5710
5711 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5712 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5713 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5714 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5715 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5716 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5717 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5718
5719 @item ?
5720 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5721 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5722
5723 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5724 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5725 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5726 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5727 messages.
5728
5729 @item SPACE
5730 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5731 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5732
5733 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5734 @end table
5735
5736
5737 @node Read Articles
5738 @subsection Read Articles
5739 @cindex expirable mark
5740
5741 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5742
5743 @table @samp
5744
5745 @item r
5746 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5747 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5748 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5749
5750 @item R
5751 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5752 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5753
5754 @item O
5755 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5756 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5757 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5758
5759 @item K
5760 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5761 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5762
5763 @item X
5764 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5765 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5766
5767 @item Y
5768 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5769 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5770
5771 @item C
5772 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5773 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5774
5775 @item G
5776 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5777 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5778
5779 @item F
5780 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5781 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5782
5783 @item Q
5784 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5785 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5786 Threading}.
5787
5788 @item M
5789 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5790 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5791 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5792
5793 @end table
5794
5795 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5796 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5797
5798 One more special mark, though:
5799
5800 @table @samp
5801 @item E
5802 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5803 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5804
5805 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5806 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5807 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5808 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5809 any time.
5810 @end table
5811
5812
5813 @node Other Marks
5814 @subsection Other Marks
5815 @cindex process mark
5816 @cindex bookmarks
5817
5818 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5819 read or not.
5820
5821 @itemize @bullet
5822
5823 @item
5824 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5825 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5826 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5827 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5828 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5829
5830 @item
5831 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5832 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5833 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5834 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5835
5836 @item
5837 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5838 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5839 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5840
5841 @item
5842 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5843 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5844 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5845
5846 @item
5847 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5848 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5849 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5850 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5851
5852 @item
5853 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5854 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5855 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5856 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5857 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5858 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5859
5860 @item
5861 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5862 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5863 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5864 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5865
5866 @item
5867 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5868 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5869 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5870 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5871 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5872 use.)
5873
5874 @item
5875 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5876 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5877 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5878 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5879 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5880 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5881
5882 @item
5883 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5884 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5885 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5886 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5887 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5888 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5889 use.)
5890
5891 @item
5892 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5893 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5894 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5895 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5896 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5897
5898 @item
5899 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5900 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5901 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5902 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5903 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5904 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5905
5906 @end itemize
5907
5908 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5909 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5910 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5911
5912 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5913 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5914 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5915
5916
5917 @node Setting Marks
5918 @subsection Setting Marks
5919 @cindex setting marks
5920
5921 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5922
5923 @table @kbd
5924 @item M c
5925 @itemx M-u
5926 @kindex M c (Summary)
5927 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5928 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5929 @cindex mark as unread
5930 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5931 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5932 article as unread.
5933
5934 @item M t
5935 @itemx !
5936 @kindex ! (Summary)
5937 @kindex M t (Summary)
5938 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5939 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5940 @xref{Article Caching}.
5941
5942 @item M ?
5943 @itemx ?
5944 @kindex ? (Summary)
5945 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5946 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5947 Mark the current article as dormant
5948 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5949
5950 @item M d
5951 @itemx d
5952 @kindex M d (Summary)
5953 @kindex d (Summary)
5954 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5955 Mark the current article as read
5956 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5957
5958 @item D
5959 @kindex D (Summary)
5960 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5961 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5962 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5963
5964 @item M k
5965 @itemx k
5966 @kindex k (Summary)
5967 @kindex M k (Summary)
5968 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5969 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5970 and then select the next unread article
5971 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5972
5973 @item M K
5974 @itemx C-k
5975 @kindex M K (Summary)
5976 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5977 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5978 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5979 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5980
5981 @item M C
5982 @kindex M C (Summary)
5983 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5984 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5985 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5986
5987 @item M C-c
5988 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5989 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5990 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5991 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5992
5993 @item M H
5994 @kindex M H (Summary)
5995 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5996 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
5997 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5998
5999 @item M h
6000 @kindex M h (Summary)
6001 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6002 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6003 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6004
6005 @item C-w
6006 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6007 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6008 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6009 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6010
6011 @item M V k
6012 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6013 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6014 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6015 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6016
6017 @item M e
6018 @itemx E
6019 @kindex M e (Summary)
6020 @kindex E (Summary)
6021 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6022 Mark the current article as expirable
6023 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6024
6025 @item M b
6026 @kindex M b (Summary)
6027 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6028 Set a bookmark in the current article
6029 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6030
6031 @item M B
6032 @kindex M B (Summary)
6033 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6034 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6035 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6036
6037 @item M V c
6038 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6039 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6040 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6041 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6042
6043 @item M V u
6044 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6045 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6046 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6047 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6048
6049 @item M V m
6050 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6051 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6052 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6053 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6054 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6055 @end table
6056
6057 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6058 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6059 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6060 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6061 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6062 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6063 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6064 The default is @code{t}.
6065
6066
6067 @node Generic Marking Commands
6068 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6069
6070 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6071 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6072 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6073 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6074 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6075 well.
6076
6077 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6078 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6079 command should do.
6080
6081 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6082 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6083 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6084 to list in this manual.
6085
6086 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6087 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6088 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6089 article, you could say something like:
6090
6091 @lisp
6092 @group
6093 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6094 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6095 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6096 @end group
6097 @end lisp
6098
6099 @noindent
6100 or
6101
6102 @lisp
6103 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6104 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6105 @end lisp
6106
6107
6108 @node Setting Process Marks
6109 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6110 @cindex setting process marks
6111
6112 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6113 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6114 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6115 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6116 commands into the cache. For more information,
6117 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6118
6119 @table @kbd
6120
6121 @item M P p
6122 @itemx #
6123 @kindex # (Summary)
6124 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6125 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6126 Mark the current article with the process mark
6127 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6128 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6129
6130 @item M P u
6131 @itemx M-#
6132 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6133 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6134 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6135 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6136
6137 @item M P U
6138 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6139 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6140 Remove the process mark from all articles
6141 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6142
6143 @item M P i
6144 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6145 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6146 Invert the list of process marked articles
6147 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6148
6149 @item M P R
6150 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6151 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6152 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6153 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6154
6155 @item M P G
6156 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6157 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6158 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6159 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6160
6161 @item M P r
6162 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6163 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6164 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6165
6166 @item M P g
6167 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6168 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6169 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6170
6171 @item M P t
6172 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6173 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6174 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6175 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6176
6177 @item M P T
6178 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6179 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6180 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6181 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6182
6183 @item M P v
6184 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6185 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6186 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6187 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6188
6189 @item M P s
6190 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6191 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6192 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6193
6194 @item M P S
6195 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6196 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6197 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6198 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6199
6200 @item M P a
6201 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6202 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6203 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6204
6205 @item M P b
6206 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6207 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6208 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6209 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6210
6211 @item M P k
6212 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6213 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6214 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6215 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6216
6217 @item M P y
6218 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6219 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6220 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6221 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6222
6223 @item M P w
6224 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6225 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6226 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6227 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6228
6229 @end table
6230
6231 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6232 set process marks based on article body contents.
6233
6234
6235 @node Limiting
6236 @section Limiting
6237 @cindex limiting
6238
6239 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6240 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6241 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6242 buffer.
6243
6244 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6245 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6246 additional articles.
6247
6248 @table @kbd
6249
6250 @item / /
6251 @itemx / s
6252 @kindex / / (Summary)
6253 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6254 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6255 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6256 matching articles.
6257
6258 @item / a
6259 @kindex / a (Summary)
6260 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6261 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6262 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6263 matching articles.
6264
6265 @item / x
6266 @kindex / x (Summary)
6267 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6268 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6269 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6270 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6271 matching articles.
6272
6273 @item / u
6274 @itemx x
6275 @kindex / u (Summary)
6276 @kindex x (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6278 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6279 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6280 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6281 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6282
6283 @item / m
6284 @kindex / m (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6286 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6287 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6288
6289 @item / t
6290 @kindex / t (Summary)
6291 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6292 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6293 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6294 articles younger than that number of days.
6295
6296 @item / n
6297 @kindex / n (Summary)
6298 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6299 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6300 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6301 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6302
6303 @item / w
6304 @kindex / w (Summary)
6305 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6306 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6307 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6308 the stack.
6309
6310 @item / .
6311 @kindex / . (Summary)
6312 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6313 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6314 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6315
6316 @item / v
6317 @kindex / v (Summary)
6318 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6319 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6320 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6321
6322 @item / p
6323 @kindex / p (Summary)
6324 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6325 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6326 group parameter predicate
6327 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6328 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6329
6330 @item / E
6331 @itemx M S
6332 @kindex M S (Summary)
6333 @kindex / E (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6335 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6336 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6337
6338 @item / D
6339 @kindex / D (Summary)
6340 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6341 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6342 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6343
6344 @item / *
6345 @kindex / * (Summary)
6346 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6347 Include all cached articles in the limit
6348 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6349
6350 @item / d
6351 @kindex / d (Summary)
6352 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6353 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6354 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6355
6356 @item / M
6357 @kindex / M (Summary)
6358 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6359 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6360
6361 @item / T
6362 @kindex / T (Summary)
6363 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6364 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6365
6366 @item / c
6367 @kindex / c (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6369 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6370 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6371
6372 @item / C
6373 @kindex / C (Summary)
6374 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6375 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6376 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6377 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6378
6379 @item / N
6380 @kindex / N (Summary)
6381 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6382 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6383 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6384
6385 @item / o
6386 @kindex / o (Summary)
6387 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6388 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6389 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6390
6391 @end table
6392
6393
6394 @node Threading
6395 @section Threading
6396 @cindex threading
6397 @cindex article threading
6398
6399 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6400 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6401 hierarchical fashion.
6402
6403 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6404 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6405 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6406 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6407 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6408 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6409 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6410
6411 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6412
6413 @table @dfn
6414 @item root
6415 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6416
6417 @item thread
6418 A tree-like article structure.
6419
6420 @item sub-thread
6421 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6422
6423 @item loose threads
6424 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6425 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6426 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6427 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6428 called loose threads.
6429
6430 @item thread gathering
6431 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6432
6433 @item sparse threads
6434 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6435 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6436
6437 @end table
6438
6439
6440 @menu
6441 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6442 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6443 @end menu
6444
6445
6446 @node Customizing Threading
6447 @subsection Customizing Threading
6448 @cindex customizing threading
6449
6450 @menu
6451 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6452 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6453 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6454 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6455 @end menu
6456
6457
6458 @node Loose Threads
6459 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6460 @cindex <
6461 @cindex >
6462 @cindex loose threads
6463
6464 @table @code
6465 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6466 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6467 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6468 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6469 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6470 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6471
6472 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6473 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6474 There are four possible values:
6475
6476 @iftex
6477 @iflatex
6478 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6479 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6480 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6481 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6482 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6483 }
6484 @end iflatex
6485 @end iftex
6486
6487 @cindex adopting articles
6488
6489 @table @code
6490
6491 @item adopt
6492 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6493 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6494 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6495 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6496
6497 @item dummy
6498 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6499 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6500 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6501 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6502 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6503 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6504 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6505 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6506 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6507 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6508
6509 @item empty
6510 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6511 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6512 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6513 Buffer Format}).)
6514
6515 @item none
6516 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6517 display them after one another.
6518
6519 @item nil
6520 Don't gather loose threads.
6521 @end table
6522
6523 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6524 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6525 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6526 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6527 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6528 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6529 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6530 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6531 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6532 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6533 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6534
6535 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6536 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6537 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6538 Matching}).
6539
6540 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6541 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6542 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6543 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6544 simplification is used.
6545
6546 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6547 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6548 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6549 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6550
6551 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6552 @lisp
6553 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6554 (concat
6555 "\\`\\[?\\("
6556 (mapconcat
6557 'identity
6558 '("looking"
6559 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6560 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6561 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6562 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6563 ;; ...
6564 )
6565 "\\|")
6566 "\\)\\s *\\("
6567 (mapconcat 'identity
6568 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6569 "\\|")
6570 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6571 @end lisp
6572
6573 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6574 subjects.
6575
6576 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6577 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6578 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6579 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6580 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6581 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6582
6583 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6584
6585 @table @code
6586 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6587 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6588 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6589
6590 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6591 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6592 Simplify fuzzily.
6593
6594 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6595 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6596 Remove excessive whitespace.
6597
6598 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6599 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6600 Remove all whitespace.
6601 @end table
6602
6603 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6604
6605
6606 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6607 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6608 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6609 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6610 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6611 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6612 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6613 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6614
6615 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6616 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6617 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6618 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6619 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6620 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6621 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6622 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6623 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6624 cholera:
6625
6626 @table @code
6627 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6628 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6629 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6630 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6631
6632 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6633 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6634 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6635 @end table
6636
6637 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6638 something like:
6639
6640 @lisp
6641 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6642 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6643 @end lisp
6644
6645 @end table
6646
6647
6648 @node Filling In Threads
6649 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6650
6651 @table @code
6652 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6653 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6654 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6655 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6656 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6657 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6658 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6659 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6660 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6661 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6662 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6663 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6664 do about that.
6665
6666 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6667 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6668 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6669
6670 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6671 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6672 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6673 newsgroups.
6674
6675 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6676 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6677 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6678 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6679 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6680 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6681 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6682 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6683 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6684 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6685 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6686 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6687 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6688 @code{nil} by default.
6689
6690 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6691 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6692 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6693 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6694 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6695 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6696 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6697
6698 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6699 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6700 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6701
6702 @end table
6703
6704
6705 @node More Threading
6706 @subsubsection More Threading
6707
6708 @table @code
6709 @item gnus-show-threads
6710 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6711 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6712 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6713 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6714 slower and more awkward.
6715
6716 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6717 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6718 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6719 generated.
6720
6721 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6722 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6723 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6724
6725 Here's an example:
6726
6727 @lisp
6728 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6729 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6730 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6731 @end lisp
6732
6733 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6734 unread, but you get my drift.)
6735
6736
6737 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6738 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6739 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6740 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6741 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6742 threads are expunged.
6743
6744 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6745 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6746 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6747 will be hidden.
6748
6749 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6750 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6751 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6752 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6753 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6754 result in a new thread.
6755
6756 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6757 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6758 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6759 The default is 4.
6760
6761 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6762 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6763 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6764 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6765 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6766 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6767 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6768 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6769 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6770 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6771 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6772
6773 @end table
6774
6775
6776 @node Low-Level Threading
6777 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6778
6779 @table @code
6780
6781 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6782 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6783 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6784
6785 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6786 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6787 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6788 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6789 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6790 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6791 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6792 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6793 meaningful. Here's one example:
6794
6795 @lisp
6796 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6797
6798 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6799 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6800 (when (string-match
6801 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6802 (mail-header-set-id
6803 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6804 header))))
6805 @end lisp
6806
6807 @end table
6808
6809
6810 @node Thread Commands
6811 @subsection Thread Commands
6812 @cindex thread commands
6813
6814 @table @kbd
6815
6816 @item T k
6817 @itemx C-M-k
6818 @kindex T k (Summary)
6819 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6820 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6821 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6822 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6823 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6824 articles instead.
6825
6826 @item T l
6827 @itemx C-M-l
6828 @kindex T l (Summary)
6829 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6830 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6831 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6832 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6833
6834 @item T i
6835 @kindex T i (Summary)
6836 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6837 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6838 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6839
6840 @item T #
6841 @kindex T # (Summary)
6842 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6843 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6844 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6845
6846 @item T M-#
6847 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6848 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6849 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6850 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6851
6852 @item T T
6853 @kindex T T (Summary)
6854 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6855 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6856
6857 @item T s
6858 @kindex T s (Summary)
6859 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6860 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6861 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6862
6863 @item T h
6864 @kindex T h (Summary)
6865 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6866 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6867
6868 @item T S
6869 @kindex T S (Summary)
6870 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6871 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6872
6873 @item T H
6874 @kindex T H (Summary)
6875 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6876 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6877
6878 @item T t
6879 @kindex T t (Summary)
6880 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6881 Re-thread the current article's thread
6882 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6883 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6884
6885 @item T ^
6886 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6887 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6888 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6889 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6890
6891 @end table
6892
6893 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6894 understand the numeric prefix.
6895
6896 @table @kbd
6897
6898 @item T n
6899 @kindex T n (Summary)
6900 @itemx C-M-f
6901 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6902 @itemx M-down
6903 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6904 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6905 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6906
6907 @item T p
6908 @kindex T p (Summary)
6909 @itemx C-M-b
6910 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6911 @itemx M-up
6912 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6913 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6914 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6915
6916 @item T d
6917 @kindex T d (Summary)
6918 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6919 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6920
6921 @item T u
6922 @kindex T u (Summary)
6923 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6924 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6925
6926 @item T o
6927 @kindex T o (Summary)
6928 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6929 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6930 @end table
6931
6932 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6933 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6934 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6935 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6936 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6937 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6938 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6939 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6940 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6941 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6942 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6943 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6944 Matching}).
6945
6946
6947 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6948 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6949
6950 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6951 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6952 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6953 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6954 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6955 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6956 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6957 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6958 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6959 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6960 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6961 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6962 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6963 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6964
6965 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6966 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6967 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6968 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6969 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6970 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6971 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6972 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6973
6974 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6975 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6976 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6977
6978 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6979 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6980 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6981 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6982 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6983 ascending article order.
6984
6985 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6986 by number, you could do something like:
6987
6988 @lisp
6989 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6990 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6991 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6992 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6993 @end lisp
6994
6995 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6996 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6997 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6998 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6999 which the articles arrived.
7000
7001 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7002 say something like:
7003
7004 @lisp
7005 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7006 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7007 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7008 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7009 @end lisp
7010
7011 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7012 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7013 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7014 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7015 tickles your fancy.
7016
7017 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7018 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7019 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7020 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7021 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7022 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7023 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7024 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7025 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7026 variable. It is very similar to the
7027 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7028 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7029 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7030 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7031 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7032 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7033 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7034
7035 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7036 say something like:
7037
7038 @lisp
7039 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7040 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7041 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7042 @end lisp
7043
7044
7045
7046 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7047 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7048 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7049 @cindex article pre-fetch
7050 @cindex pre-fetch
7051
7052 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7053 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7054 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7055 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7056 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7057
7058 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7059 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7060
7061 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7062 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7063 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7064 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7065 connection is blocked.
7066
7067 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7068 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7069 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7070 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7071
7072 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7073 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7074 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7075 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7076 extra connection.
7077
7078 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7079 you really want to.
7080
7081 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7082 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7083 happen automatically.
7084
7085 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7086 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7087 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7088 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7089 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7090 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7091 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7092
7093 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7094 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7095 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7096 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7097 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7098 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7099 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7100 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7101 article data structure as the only parameter.
7102
7103 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7104 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7105
7106 @lisp
7107 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7108 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7109 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7110 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7111 100)))
7112
7113 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7114 @end lisp
7115
7116 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7117 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7118 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7119
7120 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7121 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7122 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7123 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7124
7125 @table @code
7126 @item read
7127 Remove articles when they are read.
7128
7129 @item exit
7130 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7131 @end table
7132
7133 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7134
7135 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7136 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7137 @c from the next group.
7138
7139
7140 @node Article Caching
7141 @section Article Caching
7142 @cindex article caching
7143 @cindex caching
7144
7145 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7146 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7147 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7148 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7149 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7150
7151 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7152
7153 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7154 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7155 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7156 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7157 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7158 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7159 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7160 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7161
7162 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7163 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7164 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7165 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7166 as dormant, and don't worry.
7167
7168 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7169
7170 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7171 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7172 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7173 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7174 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7175 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7176 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7177 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7178 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7179 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7180
7181 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7182 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7183 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7184 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7185 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7186 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7187 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7188 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7189 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7190 not then be downloaded by this command.
7191
7192 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7193 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7194 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7195 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7196 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7197 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7198
7199 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7200 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7201 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7202 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7203 variables, the group is not cached.
7204
7205 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7206 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7207 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7208 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7209 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7210 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7211 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7212 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7213 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7214 file.
7215
7216 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7217 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7218 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7219 where, isn't that cool?
7220
7221 @node Persistent Articles
7222 @section Persistent Articles
7223 @cindex persistent articles
7224
7225 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7226 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7227 useful in my opinion.
7228
7229 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7230 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7231 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7232 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7233 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7234 the expiry going on at the news server.
7235
7236 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7237 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7238 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7239
7240 @table @kbd
7241
7242 @item *
7243 @kindex * (Summary)
7244 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7245 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7246
7247 @item M-*
7248 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7249 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7250 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7251 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7252 article.
7253 @end table
7254
7255 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7256
7257 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7258 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7259 interested in persistent articles:
7260
7261 @lisp
7262 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7263 @end lisp
7264
7265
7266 @node Article Backlog
7267 @section Article Backlog
7268 @cindex backlog
7269 @cindex article backlog
7270
7271 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7272 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7273 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7274 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7275 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7276 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7277 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7278 increase memory usage some.
7279
7280 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7281 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7282 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7283 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7284 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7285 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7286 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7287
7288 The default value is 20.
7289
7290
7291 @node Saving Articles
7292 @section Saving Articles
7293 @cindex saving articles
7294
7295 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7296 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7297 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7298 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7299 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7300
7301 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7302 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7303 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7304
7305 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7306 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7307 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7308
7309 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7310 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7311 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7312 deleted before saving.
7313
7314 @table @kbd
7315
7316 @item O o
7317 @itemx o
7318 @kindex O o (Summary)
7319 @kindex o (Summary)
7320 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7321 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7322 Save the current article using the default article saver
7323 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7324
7325 @item O m
7326 @kindex O m (Summary)
7327 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7328 Save the current article in mail format
7329 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7330
7331 @item O r
7332 @kindex O r (Summary)
7333 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7334 Save the current article in Rmail format
7335 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7336
7337 @item O f
7338 @kindex O f (Summary)
7339 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7340 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7341 Save the current article in plain file format
7342 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7343
7344 @item O F
7345 @kindex O F (Summary)
7346 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7347 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7348 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7349
7350 @item O b
7351 @kindex O b (Summary)
7352 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7353 Save the current article body in plain file format
7354 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7355
7356 @item O h
7357 @kindex O h (Summary)
7358 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7359 Save the current article in mh folder format
7360 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7361
7362 @item O v
7363 @kindex O v (Summary)
7364 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7365 Save the current article in a VM folder
7366 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7367
7368 @item O p
7369 @itemx |
7370 @kindex O p (Summary)
7371 @kindex | (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7373 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7374 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7375 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7376 complete headers in the piped output.
7377
7378 @item O P
7379 @kindex O P (Summary)
7380 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7381 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7382 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7383 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7384 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7385 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7386 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7387
7388 @end table
7389
7390 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7391 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7392 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7393 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7394 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7395 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7396 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7397 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7398 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7399 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7400 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7401 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7402 files.
7403
7404
7405 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7406 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7407 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7408 functions below, or you can create your own.
7409
7410 @table @code
7411
7412 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7413 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7414 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7415 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7416 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7417 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7418 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7419
7420 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7421 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7422 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7423 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7424 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7425 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7426
7427 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7428 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7429 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7430 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7431 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7432 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7433 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7434
7435 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7436 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7437 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7438 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7439 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7440 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7441
7442 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7443 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7444 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7445 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7446 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7447
7448 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7449 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7450 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7451 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7452 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7453 @cindex rcvstore
7454 @cindex MH folders
7455 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7456 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7457 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7458 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7459 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7460
7461 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7462 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7463 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7464 reader to use this setting.
7465 @end table
7466
7467 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7468 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7469 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7470 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7471 default.
7472
7473 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7474 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7475 available functions that generate names:
7476
7477 @table @code
7478
7479 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7480 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7481 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7482
7483 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7484 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7485 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7486
7487 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7488 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7489 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7490
7491 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7492 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7493 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7494
7495 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7496 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7497 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7498 @end table
7499
7500 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7501 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7502 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7503 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7504 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7505 like:
7506
7507 @lisp
7508 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7509 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7510 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7511 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7512 @end lisp
7513
7514 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7515 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7516 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7517 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7518 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7519 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7520 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7521 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7522 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7523
7524 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7525 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7526 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7527 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7528
7529 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7530 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7531 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7532 name.
7533
7534 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7535 lots of mail groups called things like
7536 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7537 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7538 following will do just that:
7539
7540 @lisp
7541 (defun my-save-name (group)
7542 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7543 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7544
7545 (setq gnus-split-methods
7546 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7547 (my-save-name)))
7548 @end lisp
7549
7550
7551 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7552 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7553 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7554 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7555 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7556 all the files in the top level directory
7557 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7558 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7559 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7560 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7561
7562 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7563 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7564 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7565 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7566 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7567 for kill files.
7568
7569 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7570 a spool, you could
7571
7572 @lisp
7573 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7574 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7575 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7576 @end lisp
7577
7578 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7579 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7580 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7581 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7582
7583
7584 @node Decoding Articles
7585 @section Decoding Articles
7586 @cindex decoding articles
7587
7588 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7589 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7590
7591 @menu
7592 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7593 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7594 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7595 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7596 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7597 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7598 @end menu
7599
7600 @cindex series
7601 @cindex article series
7602 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7603 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7604 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7605 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7606 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7607
7608 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7609 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7610 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7611
7612 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7613 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7614 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7615
7616 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7617 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7618 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7619
7620
7621 @node Uuencoded Articles
7622 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7623 @cindex uudecode
7624 @cindex uuencoded articles
7625
7626 @table @kbd
7627
7628 @item X u
7629 @kindex X u (Summary)
7630 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7631 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7632 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7633
7634 @item X U
7635 @kindex X U (Summary)
7636 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7637 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7638 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7639
7640 @item X v u
7641 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7642 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7643 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7644
7645 @item X v U
7646 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7647 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7648 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7649 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7650
7651 @end table
7652
7653 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7654 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7655 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7656 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7657 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7658
7659 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7660 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7661 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7662 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7663 @kbd{X u}.
7664
7665 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7666 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7667 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7668 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7669 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7670 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7671 off.
7672
7673
7674 @node Shell Archives
7675 @subsection Shell Archives
7676 @cindex unshar
7677 @cindex shell archives
7678 @cindex shared articles
7679
7680 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7681 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7682 some commands to deal with these:
7683
7684 @table @kbd
7685
7686 @item X s
7687 @kindex X s (Summary)
7688 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7689 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7690
7691 @item X S
7692 @kindex X S (Summary)
7693 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7694 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7695
7696 @item X v s
7697 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7698 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7699 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7700
7701 @item X v S
7702 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7703 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7704 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7705 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7706 @end table
7707
7708
7709 @node PostScript Files
7710 @subsection PostScript Files
7711 @cindex PostScript
7712
7713 @table @kbd
7714
7715 @item X p
7716 @kindex X p (Summary)
7717 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7718 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7719
7720 @item X P
7721 @kindex X P (Summary)
7722 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7723 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7724 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7725
7726 @item X v p
7727 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7728 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7729 View the current PostScript series
7730 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7731
7732 @item X v P
7733 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7734 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7735 View and save the current PostScript series
7736 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7737 @end table
7738
7739
7740 @node Other Files
7741 @subsection Other Files
7742
7743 @table @kbd
7744 @item X o
7745 @kindex X o (Summary)
7746 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7747 Save the current series
7748 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7749
7750 @item X b
7751 @kindex X b (Summary)
7752 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7753 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7754 doesn't really work yet.
7755 @end table
7756
7757
7758 @node Decoding Variables
7759 @subsection Decoding Variables
7760
7761 Adjective, not verb.
7762
7763 @menu
7764 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7765 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7766 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7767 @end menu
7768
7769
7770 @node Rule Variables
7771 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7772 @cindex rule variables
7773
7774 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7775 variables are of the form
7776
7777 @lisp
7778 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7779 '(regexp2 command2)
7780 ...)
7781 @end lisp
7782
7783 @table @code
7784
7785 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7786 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7787 @cindex sox
7788 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7789 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7790 say something like:
7791 @lisp
7792 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7793 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7794 @end lisp
7795
7796 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7797 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7798 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7799 user and default view rules.
7800
7801 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7802 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7803 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7804 archives.
7805 @end table
7806
7807
7808 @node Other Decode Variables
7809 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7810
7811 @table @code
7812 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7813
7814 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7815 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7816 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7817 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7818 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7819
7820 @table @code
7821
7822 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7823 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7824 View the file.
7825
7826 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7827 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7828 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7829 @end table
7830
7831 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7832 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7833 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7834 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7835 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7836 time.
7837
7838 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7839 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7840 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7841
7842 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7843 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7844 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7845 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7846 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7847 kludgey.
7848
7849 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7850 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7851 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7852
7853 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7854 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7855 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7856 looking for files to display.
7857
7858 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7859 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7860 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7861 after viewing it.
7862
7863 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7864 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7865 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7866 rules.
7867
7868 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7869 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7870 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7871 unpacking commands.
7872
7873 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7874 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7875 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7876 from articles.
7877
7878 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7879 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7880 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7881 decoded articles as unread.
7882
7883 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7884 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7885 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7886 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7887
7888 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7889 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7890 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7891
7892 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7893 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7894 @cindex metamail
7895 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7896 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7897 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7898 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7899
7900 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7901 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7902 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7903 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7904 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7905 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7906 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7907 simply dropped them.
7908
7909 @end table
7910
7911
7912 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7913 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7914
7915 @table @code
7916
7917 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7918 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7919 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7920 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7921 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7922 for you when you post the article.
7923
7924 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7925 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7926 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7927 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7928
7929 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7930 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7931 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7932 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7933 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7934 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7935 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7936
7937 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7938 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7939 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7940 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7941 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7942 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7943 Default is @code{t}.
7944
7945 @end table
7946
7947
7948 @node Viewing Files
7949 @subsection Viewing Files
7950 @cindex viewing files
7951 @cindex pseudo-articles
7952
7953 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7954 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7955 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7956 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7957 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7958 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7959 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7960
7961 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7962 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7963 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7964 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7965
7966 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7967 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7968 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7969
7970 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7971 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7972 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7973 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7974 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7975
7976 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7977 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7978 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7979 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7980 a list of parameters to that command.
7981
7982 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7983 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7984 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7985
7986 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7987 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7988 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7989
7990
7991 @node Article Treatment
7992 @section Article Treatment
7993
7994 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
7995 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
7996 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
7997 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
7998 these articles easier.
7999
8000 @menu
8001 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8002 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8003 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8004 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8005 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8006 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8007 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8008 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8009 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8010 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8011 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8012 @end menu
8013
8014
8015 @node Article Highlighting
8016 @subsection Article Highlighting
8017 @cindex highlighting
8018
8019 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8020 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8021
8022 @table @kbd
8023
8024 @item W H a
8025 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8026 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8027 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8028 Do much highlighting of the current article
8029 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8030 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8031
8032 @item W H h
8033 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8034 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8035 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8036 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8037 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8038 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8039 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8040 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8041 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8042 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8043 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8044 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8045
8046 @item W H c
8047 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8048 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8049 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8050
8051 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8052
8053 @table @code
8054 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8055
8056 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8057 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8058 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8059
8060 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8061 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8062 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8063
8064 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8065 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8066 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8067 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8068 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8069 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8070
8071 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8072 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8073 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8074
8075 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8076 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8077 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8078
8079 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8080 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8081 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8082 that it's a citation.
8083
8084 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8085 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8086 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8087
8088 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8089 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8090 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8091
8092 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8093 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8094 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8095 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8096
8097 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8098 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8099 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8100 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8101 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8102 is @code{t}.
8103
8104 @end table
8105
8106
8107 @item W H s
8108 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8109 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8110 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8111 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8112 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8113 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8114 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8115 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8116 default.
8117
8118 @end table
8119
8120 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8121
8122
8123 @node Article Fontisizing
8124 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8125 @cindex emphasis
8126 @cindex article emphasis
8127
8128 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8129 @kindex W e (Summary)
8130 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8131 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8132 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8133 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8134
8135 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8136 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8137 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8138 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8139 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8140 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8141 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8142 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8143 highlighting.
8144
8145 @lisp
8146 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8147 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8148 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8149 @end lisp
8150
8151 @cindex slash
8152 @cindex asterisk
8153 @cindex underline
8154 @cindex /
8155 @cindex *
8156
8157 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8158 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8159 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8160 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8161 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8162 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8163 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8164 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8165 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8166 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8167 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8168 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8169 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8170
8171 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8172 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8173 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8174 say something like:
8175
8176 @lisp
8177 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8178 @end lisp
8179
8180 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8181
8182 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8183 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8184 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8185 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8186
8187 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8188
8189
8190 @node Article Hiding
8191 @subsection Article Hiding
8192 @cindex article hiding
8193
8194 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8195 too much cruft in most articles.
8196
8197 @table @kbd
8198
8199 @item W W a
8200 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8201 @findex gnus-article-hide
8202 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8203 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8204 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8205
8206 @item W W h
8207 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8208 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8209 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8210 Headers}.
8211
8212 @item W W b
8213 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8214 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8215 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8216 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8217
8218 @item W W s
8219 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8220 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8221 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8222 Signature}.
8223
8224 @item W W l
8225 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8226 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8227 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8228 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8229 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8230 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8231 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8232 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8233
8234 @table @code
8235
8236 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8237 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8238 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8239 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8240
8241 @end table
8242
8243 @item W W P
8244 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8245 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8246 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8247 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8248
8249 @item W W B
8250 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8251 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8252 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8253 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8254 @cindex banner
8255 @cindex OneList
8256 @cindex stripping advertisements
8257 @cindex advertisements
8258 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8259 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8260 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8261 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8262 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8263 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8264 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8265 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8266 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8267 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8268 used.
8269
8270 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8271 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8272 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8273
8274 @table @code
8275
8276 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8277 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8278 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8279 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8280 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8281 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8282 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8283 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8284 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8285 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8286 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8287
8288 @lisp
8289 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8290 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8291 @end lisp
8292
8293 @end table
8294
8295 @item W W c
8296 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8297 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8298 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8299 customizing the hiding:
8300
8301 @table @code
8302
8303 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8304 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8305 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8306 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8307 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8308 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8309 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8310 specs are valid:
8311
8312 @table @samp
8313 @item b
8314 Starting point of the hidden text.
8315 @item e
8316 Ending point of the hidden text.
8317 @item l
8318 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8319 @item n
8320 Number of lines of hidden text.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8324 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8325 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8326 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8327 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8328
8329 @end table
8330
8331 @item W W C-c
8332 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8333 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8334
8335 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8336 following two variables:
8337
8338 @table @code
8339 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8340 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8341 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8342 50), hide the cited text.
8343
8344 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8345 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8346 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8347 is hidden.
8348 @end table
8349
8350 @item W W C
8351 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8352 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8353 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8354 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8355 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8356 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8357
8358 @end table
8359
8360 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8361 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8362 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8363
8364 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8365 citation customization.
8366
8367 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8368 automatically.
8369
8370
8371 @node Article Washing
8372 @subsection Article Washing
8373 @cindex washing
8374 @cindex article washing
8375
8376 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8377 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8378
8379 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8380 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8381 Cleaner, perhaps.
8382
8383 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8384 articles by default.
8385
8386 @table @kbd
8387
8388 @item C-u g
8389 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8390 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8391 the server.
8392
8393 @item g
8394 Force redisplaying of the current article
8395 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8396 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8397 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8398 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8399
8400 @item W l
8401 @kindex W l (Summary)
8402 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8403 Remove page breaks from the current article
8404 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8405 delimiters.
8406
8407 @item W r
8408 @kindex W r (Summary)
8409 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8410 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8411 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8412 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8413 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8414 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8415
8416 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8417 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8418 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8419 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8420
8421 @item W m
8422 @kindex W m (Summary)
8423 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8424 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8425
8426 @item W t
8427 @item t
8428 @kindex W t (Summary)
8429 @kindex t (Summary)
8430 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8431 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8432 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8433
8434 @item W v
8435 @kindex W v (Summary)
8436 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8437 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8438 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8439
8440 @item W o
8441 @kindex W o (Summary)
8442 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8443 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8444
8445 @item W d
8446 @kindex W d (Summary)
8447 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8448 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8449 @cindex Smartquotes
8450 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8451 @cindex Latin 1
8452 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8453 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8454 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8455 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8456 interactively.
8457
8458 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8459 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8460 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8461 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8462
8463 @item W Y f
8464 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8465 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8466 @cindex Outlook Express
8467 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8468 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8469 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8470
8471 @item W Y u
8472 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8473 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8474 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8475 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8476 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8477 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8478 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8479 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8480 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8481 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8482
8483 @item W Y a
8484 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8485 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8486 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8487 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8488
8489 @item W Y c
8490 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8491 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8492 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8493 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8494
8495 @item W w
8496 @kindex W w (Summary)
8497 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8498 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8499
8500 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8501 when filling.
8502
8503 @item W Q
8504 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8505 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8506 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8507
8508 @item W C
8509 @kindex W C (Summary)
8510 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8511 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8512 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8513
8514 @item W c
8515 @kindex W c (Summary)
8516 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8517 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8518 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8519 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8520 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8521
8522 @item W q
8523 @kindex W q (Summary)
8524 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8525 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8526 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8527 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8528 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8529 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8530 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8531 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8532 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8533
8534 @item W 6
8535 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8536 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8537 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8538 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8539 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8540 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8541 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8542 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8543
8544 @item W Z
8545 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8546 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8547 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8548 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8549 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8550
8551 @item W u
8552 @kindex W u (Summary)
8553 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8554 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8555 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8556 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8557 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8558
8559 @item W h
8560 @kindex W h (Summary)
8561 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8562 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8563 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8564 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8565
8566 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8567
8568 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8569 The default is to use the function specified by
8570 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8571 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8572 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8573 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8574 can use include:
8575
8576 @table @code
8577 @item w3
8578 Use Emacs/w3.
8579
8580 @item w3m
8581 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8582
8583 @item links
8584 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8585
8586 @item lynx
8587 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8588
8589 @item html2text
8590 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8591
8592 @end table
8593
8594 @item W b
8595 @kindex W b (Summary)
8596 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8597 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8598 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8599
8600 @item W B
8601 @kindex W B (Summary)
8602 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8603 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8604 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8605
8606 @item W p
8607 @kindex W p (Summary)
8608 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8609 Verify a signed control message
8610 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8611 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8612 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8613 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8614 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8615 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8616
8617 @item W s
8618 @kindex W s (Summary)
8619 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8620 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8621 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8622 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8623
8624 @item W a
8625 @kindex W a (Summary)
8626 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8627 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8628 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8629
8630 @item W E l
8631 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8633 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8634 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8635
8636 @item W E m
8637 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8638 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8639 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8640 lines with a single empty line.
8641 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8642
8643 @item W E t
8644 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8645 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8646 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8647 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8648
8649 @item W E a
8650 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8651 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8652 Do all the three commands above
8653 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8654
8655 @item W E A
8656 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8657 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8658 Remove all blank lines
8659 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8660
8661 @item W E s
8662 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8663 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8664 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8665 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8666
8667 @item W E e
8668 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8669 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8670 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8671 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8672
8673 @end table
8674
8675 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8676
8677
8678 @node Article Header
8679 @subsection Article Header
8680
8681 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8682
8683 @table @kbd
8684
8685 @item W G u
8686 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8687 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8688 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8689
8690 @item W G n
8691 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8692 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8693 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8694 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8695
8696 @item W G f
8697 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8698 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8699 Fold all the message headers
8700 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8701
8702 @item W E w
8703 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8704 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8705 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8706 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8707
8708 @end table
8709
8710
8711 @node Article Buttons
8712 @subsection Article Buttons
8713 @cindex buttons
8714
8715 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8716 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8717 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8718 button on these references.
8719
8720 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8721 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8722 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8723 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8724 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8725
8726 @table @code
8727
8728 @item gnus-button-alist
8729 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8730 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8731
8732 @lisp
8733 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8734 @end lisp
8735
8736 @table @var
8737
8738 @item regexp
8739 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8740 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8741 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8742 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8743 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8744
8745 @item button-par
8746 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8747 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8748 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8749
8750 @item use-p
8751 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8752 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8753 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8754 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8755 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8756
8757 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8758
8759 @item function
8760 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8761
8762 @item data-par
8763 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8764 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8765
8766 @end table
8767
8768 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8769
8770 @lisp
8771 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8772 @end lisp
8773
8774 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8775 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8776 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8777 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8778 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8779
8780 @lisp
8781 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8782 @end lisp
8783
8784 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8785 @end table
8786
8787 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8788
8789 @table @code
8790 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8791 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8792
8793 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8794
8795 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8796 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8797 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8798 default values of the variables above.
8799
8800 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8801
8802 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8803 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8804 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8805 argument with a string naming the man page.
8806
8807 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8808
8809 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8810 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8811 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8812
8813 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8814 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8815 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8816 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8817 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8818 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8819 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8820 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8821 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8822 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8823 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8824 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8825
8826 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8827 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8828 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8829 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8830 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8831 string is invalid.
8832
8833 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8834 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8835 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8836 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8837
8838 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8839
8840 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8841 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8842 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8843 argument, the string naming the URL.
8844
8845 @item gnus-ctan-url
8846 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8847 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8848 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8849
8850 @c Misc stuff
8851
8852 @item gnus-article-button-face
8853 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8854 Face used on buttons.
8855
8856 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8857 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8858 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8859
8860 @end table
8861
8862 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8863
8864
8865 @node Article Button Levels
8866 @subsection Article button levels
8867 @cindex button levels
8868 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8869 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8870 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8871 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8872 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8873 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8874 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8875 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8876
8877 @lisp
8878 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8879 (setq gnus-parameters
8880 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8881 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8882 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8883 @end lisp
8884
8885 @table @code
8886
8887 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8888 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8889 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8890 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8891 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8892 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8893
8894 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8895 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8896 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8897 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8898 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8899 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8900 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8901 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8902 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8903 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8904 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8905 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8906 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8907
8908 @item gnus-button-man-level
8909 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8910 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8911 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8912
8913 @item gnus-button-message-level
8914 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8915 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8916 Related variables and functions include
8917 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8918 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8919 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8920 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8921
8922 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8923 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8924 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8925 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8926 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8927 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8928 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8929
8930 @end table
8931
8932
8933 @node Article Date
8934 @subsection Article Date
8935
8936 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8937 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8938 when the article was sent.
8939
8940 @table @kbd
8941
8942 @item W T u
8943 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8944 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8945 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8946 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8947
8948 @item W T i
8949 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8950 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8951 @cindex ISO 8601
8952 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8953 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8954
8955 @item W T l
8956 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8957 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8958 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8959
8960 @item W T p
8961 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8962 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8963 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8964 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8965
8966 @item W T s
8967 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8968 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8969 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8970 @findex format-time-string
8971 Display the date using a user-defined format
8972 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8973 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8974 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8975 for a list of possible format specs.
8976
8977 @item W T e
8978 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8979 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8980 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8981 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8982 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8983 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8984
8985 @example
8986 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8987 @end example
8988
8989 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
8990 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8991 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
8992 replace it.
8993
8994 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
8995 into wonderful absurdities.
8996
8997 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
8998
8999 @lisp
9000 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9001 @end lisp
9002
9003 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9004 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9005 command.
9006
9007 @item W T o
9008 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9009 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9010 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9011 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9012 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9013 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9014 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9015
9016 @end table
9017
9018 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9019 preferred format automatically.
9020
9021
9022 @node Article Display
9023 @subsection Article Display
9024 @cindex picons
9025 @cindex x-face
9026 @cindex smileys
9027
9028 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9029 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9030
9031 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9032 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9033
9034 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9035 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9036
9037 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9038 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9039
9040 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9041 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9042
9043 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9044 they'll be removed.
9045
9046 @table @kbd
9047 @item W D x
9048 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9049 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9050 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9051 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9052
9053 @item W D d
9054 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9055 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9056 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9057 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9058
9059 @item W D s
9060 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9061 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9062 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9063
9064 @item W D f
9065 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9066 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9067 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9068
9069 @item W D m
9070 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9071 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9072 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9073 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9074
9075 @item W D n
9076 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9077 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9078 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9079 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9080
9081 @item W D D
9082 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9083 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9084 Remove all images from the article buffer
9085 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9086
9087 @end table
9088
9089
9090
9091 @node Article Signature
9092 @subsection Article Signature
9093 @cindex signatures
9094 @cindex article signature
9095
9096 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9097 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9098 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9099 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9100 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9101 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9102 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9103 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9104 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9105
9106 @lisp
9107 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9108 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9109 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9110 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9111 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9112 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9113 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9114 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9115 @end lisp
9116
9117 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9118 positives.
9119
9120 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9121 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9122 signature when displaying articles.
9123
9124 @enumerate
9125 @item
9126 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9127 that integer.
9128 @item
9129 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9130 than that number.
9131 @item
9132 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9133 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9134 @item
9135 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9136 in question is not a signature.
9137 @end enumerate
9138
9139 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9140 listed above. Here's an example:
9141
9142 @lisp
9143 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9144 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9145 @end lisp
9146
9147 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9148 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9149 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9150 signature after all.
9151
9152
9153 @node Article Miscellanea
9154 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9155
9156 @table @kbd
9157 @item A t
9158 @kindex A t (Summary)
9159 @findex gnus-article-babel
9160 Translate the article from one language to another
9161 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9162
9163 @end table
9164
9165
9166 @node MIME Commands
9167 @section MIME Commands
9168 @cindex MIME decoding
9169 @cindex attachments
9170 @cindex viewing attachments
9171
9172 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9173 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9174
9175 @table @kbd
9176 @item b
9177 @itemx K v
9178 @kindex b (Summary)
9179 @kindex K v (Summary)
9180 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9181
9182 @item K o
9183 @kindex K o (Summary)
9184 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9185
9186 @item K c
9187 @kindex K c (Summary)
9188 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9189
9190 @item K e
9191 @kindex K e (Summary)
9192 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9193
9194 @item K i
9195 @kindex K i (Summary)
9196 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9197
9198 @item K |
9199 @kindex K | (Summary)
9200 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9201 @end table
9202
9203 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9204 the same manner:
9205
9206 @table @kbd
9207 @item K b
9208 @kindex K b (Summary)
9209 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9210 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9211 parts.
9212
9213 @item K m
9214 @kindex K m (Summary)
9215 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9216 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9217 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9218 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9219 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9220
9221 @item X m
9222 @kindex X m (Summary)
9223 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9224 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9225 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9226 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9227
9228 @item M-t
9229 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9230 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9231 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9232 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9233
9234 @item W M w
9235 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9236 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9237 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9238 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9239
9240 @item W M c
9241 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9242 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9243 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9244 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9245
9246 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9247 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9248 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9249 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9250 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9251 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9252
9253 @item W M v
9254 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9255 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9256 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9257 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9258
9259 @end table
9260
9261 Relevant variables:
9262
9263 @table @code
9264 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9265 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9266 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9267 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9268 @code{nil}.
9269
9270 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9271
9272 @lisp
9273 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9274 '("text/x-vcard"))
9275 @end lisp
9276
9277 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9278 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9279 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9280 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9281 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9282 default is @code{nil}.
9283
9284 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9285 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9286 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9287 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9288 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9289 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9290 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9291
9292 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9293 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9294 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9295 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9296 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9297 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9298 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9299 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9300
9301 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9302 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9303 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9304 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9305 displayed. This variable overrides
9306 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9307 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9308 is @code{nil}.
9309
9310 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9311 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9312 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9313
9314 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9315 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9316 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9317 default value is @code{nil}.
9318
9319 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9320 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9321 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9322 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9323 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9324 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9325 save all jpegs into some directory).
9326
9327 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9328
9329 @lisp
9330 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9331 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9332 (with-temp-buffer
9333 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9334 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9335 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9336 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9337 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9338 @end lisp
9339
9340 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9341 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9342 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9343
9344 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9345 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9346 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9347
9348 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9349 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9350 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9351
9352 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9353 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} in @ref{Display Customization,
9354 Display Customization, , emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}. Images or
9355 other material inside a "multipart/related" part might be overlooked
9356 when this variable is nil.
9357
9358 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9359 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9360 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If t, it overrides nil
9361 values of @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9362 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9363
9364 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9365 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9366 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9367 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9368
9369 Ready-made functions include@*
9370 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9371 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9372 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9373 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9374 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9375 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9376 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9377 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9378 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9379 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9380 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9381 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9382
9383 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9384 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9385
9386 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9387 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9388 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9389
9390 @lisp
9391 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9392 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9393 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9394 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9395 @end lisp
9396
9397 @noindent
9398 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9399
9400 @end table
9401
9402
9403 @node Charsets
9404 @section Charsets
9405 @cindex charsets
9406
9407 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9408 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9409 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9410 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9411 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9412 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9413 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
9414
9415 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9416 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9417 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9418 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9419
9420 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9421 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9422 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9423 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9424 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9425 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9426 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9427 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9428 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9429
9430 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9431 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9432 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9433 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9434 quoted-printable header encoding.
9435
9436 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9437 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9438 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9439
9440 @table @var
9441 @item test
9442 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9443 variable to query,
9444 @item header
9445 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9446 means encode all charsets),
9447 @item body-list
9448 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9449 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9450 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9451 @end table
9452
9453 @cindex Russian
9454 @cindex koi8-r
9455 @cindex koi8-u
9456 @cindex iso-8859-5
9457 @cindex coding system aliases
9458 @cindex preferred charset
9459
9460 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9461 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9462 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9463
9464 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9465
9466 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9467 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9468
9469 @lisp
9470 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9471 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9472 @end lisp
9473
9474 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9475 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9476
9477 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9478
9479 @lisp
9480 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9481 @end lisp
9482
9483 This will almost do the right thing.
9484
9485 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9486 something like
9487
9488 @lisp
9489 (codepage-setup 1251)
9490 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9491 @end lisp
9492
9493
9494 @node Article Commands
9495 @section Article Commands
9496
9497 @table @kbd
9498
9499 @item A P
9500 @cindex PostScript
9501 @cindex printing
9502 @kindex A P (Summary)
9503 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9504 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9505 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9506 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9507 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9508 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9509
9510 @end table
9511
9512
9513 @node Summary Sorting
9514 @section Summary Sorting
9515 @cindex summary sorting
9516
9517 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9518 can't really see why you'd want that.
9519
9520 @table @kbd
9521
9522 @item C-c C-s C-n
9523 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9524 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9525 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9526
9527 @item C-c C-s C-a
9528 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9529 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9530 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9531
9532 @item C-c C-s C-s
9533 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9534 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9535 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9536
9537 @item C-c C-s C-d
9538 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9539 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9540 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9541
9542 @item C-c C-s C-l
9543 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9544 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9545 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9546
9547 @item C-c C-s C-c
9548 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9549 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9550 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9551
9552 @item C-c C-s C-i
9553 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9554 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9555 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9556
9557 @item C-c C-s C-r
9558 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9559 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9560 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9561
9562 @item C-c C-s C-o
9563 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9564 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9565 Sort using the default sorting method
9566 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9567 @end table
9568
9569 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9570 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9571 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9572 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9573 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9574 Commands}).
9575
9576
9577 @node Finding the Parent
9578 @section Finding the Parent
9579 @cindex parent articles
9580 @cindex referring articles
9581
9582 @table @kbd
9583 @item ^
9584 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9585 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9586 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9587 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9588 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9589 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9590 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9591 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9592 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9593 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9594
9595 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9596 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9597 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9598 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9599 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9600 article.
9601
9602 @item A R (Summary)
9603 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9604 @kindex A R (Summary)
9605 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9606 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9607
9608 @item A T (Summary)
9609 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9610 @kindex A T (Summary)
9611 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9612 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9613 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9614 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9615 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9616 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9617 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9618
9619 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9620 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9621 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9622 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9623 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9624 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9625
9626 @item M-^ (Summary)
9627 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9628 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9629 @cindex Message-ID
9630 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9631 You can also ask the @acronym{NNTP} server for an arbitrary article, no
9632 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
9633 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
9634 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
9635 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
9636 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9637 @end table
9638
9639 The current select method will be used when fetching by
9640 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
9641 by giving this command a prefix.
9642
9643 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9644 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9645 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9646 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9647 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9648 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9649 necessary.
9650
9651 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9652 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9653 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9654 match.
9655
9656 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9657 then ask Google if that fails:
9658
9659 @lisp
9660 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9661 '(current
9662 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9663 @end lisp
9664
9665 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9666 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9667 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9668 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9669 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9670 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9671 not support this at all.
9672
9673
9674 @node Alternative Approaches
9675 @section Alternative Approaches
9676
9677 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9678 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9679
9680 @menu
9681 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9682 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9683 @end menu
9684
9685
9686 @node Pick and Read
9687 @subsection Pick and Read
9688 @cindex pick and read
9689
9690 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9691 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9692 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9693 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9694
9695 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9696 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9697 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9698 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9699 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9700 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9701
9702 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9703
9704 @table @kbd
9705 @item .
9706 @kindex . (Pick)
9707 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9708 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9709 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9710 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9711 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9712 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9713 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9714 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9715
9716 @item SPACE
9717 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9718 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9719 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9720 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9721
9722 @item u
9723 @kindex u (Pick)
9724 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9725 Unpick the thread or article
9726 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9727 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9728 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9729 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9730 the thread or article at that line.
9731
9732 @item RET
9733 @kindex RET (Pick)
9734 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9735 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9736 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9737 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9738 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9739 will still be visible when you are reading.
9740
9741 @end table
9742
9743 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9744 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9745 which is mapped to the same function
9746 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9747
9748 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9749
9750 @lisp
9751 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9752 @end lisp
9753
9754 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9755 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9756
9757 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9758 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9759 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9760
9761 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9762 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9763 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9764 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9765 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9766 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9767 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9768
9769
9770 @node Binary Groups
9771 @subsection Binary Groups
9772 @cindex binary groups
9773
9774 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9775 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9776 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9777 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9778 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9779 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9780 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9781
9782 @kindex g (Binary)
9783 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9784 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9785 command, when you have turned on this mode
9786 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9787
9788 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9789 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9790
9791
9792 @node Tree Display
9793 @section Tree Display
9794 @cindex trees
9795
9796 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9797 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9798 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9799 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9800 in the tree buffer.
9801
9802 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9803
9804 @table @code
9805 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9806 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9807 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9808
9809 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9810 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9811 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9812 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9813 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9814
9815 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9816 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9817 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9818 default is @code{modeline}.
9819
9820 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9821 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9822 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9823 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9824 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9825 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9826 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9827
9828 Valid specs are:
9829
9830 @table @samp
9831 @item n
9832 The name of the poster.
9833 @item f
9834 The @code{From} header.
9835 @item N
9836 The number of the article.
9837 @item [
9838 The opening bracket.
9839 @item ]
9840 The closing bracket.
9841 @item s
9842 The subject.
9843 @end table
9844
9845 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9846
9847 Variables related to the display are:
9848
9849 @table @code
9850 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9851 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9852 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9853 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9854 @example
9855 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9856 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9857 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9858 @end example
9859 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9860
9861 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9862 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9863 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9864 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9865
9866 @end table
9867
9868 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9869 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9870 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9871 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9872 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9873 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9874 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9875 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9876 other windows displayed next to it.
9877
9878 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9879 at all times:
9880
9881 @lisp
9882 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9883 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9884 @end lisp
9885
9886 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9887 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9888 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9889 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9890 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9891 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9892 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9893
9894 @end table
9895
9896 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9897
9898 @example
9899 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9900 | \[Jan]
9901 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9902 | \(***)-[Eri]
9903 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9904 \[Bjo]
9905 \[Gun]
9906 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9907 @end example
9908
9909 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9910
9911 @example
9912 @group
9913 @{***@}
9914 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9915 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9916 |--\-----\-----\ |
9917 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9918 | | |--\
9919 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9920 |
9921 [Paa]
9922 @end group
9923 @end example
9924
9925 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9926 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9927 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9928
9929 @lisp
9930 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9931 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9932 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9933 (gnus-add-configuration
9934 '(article
9935 (vertical 1.0
9936 (horizontal 0.25
9937 (summary 0.75 point)
9938 (tree 1.0))
9939 (article 1.0))))
9940 @end lisp
9941
9942 @xref{Window Layout}.
9943
9944
9945 @node Mail Group Commands
9946 @section Mail Group Commands
9947 @cindex mail group commands
9948
9949 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9950 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9951
9952 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9953 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9954
9955 @table @kbd
9956
9957 @item B e
9958 @kindex B e (Summary)
9959 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9960 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9961 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9962 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9963 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9964
9965 @item B C-M-e
9966 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9967 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9968 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9969 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9970 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9971 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9972
9973 @item B DEL
9974 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9975 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9976 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9977 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9978 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9979 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9980
9981 @item B m
9982 @kindex B m (Summary)
9983 @cindex move mail
9984 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9985 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
9986 Move the article from one mail group to another
9987 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9988 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9989
9990 @item B c
9991 @kindex B c (Summary)
9992 @cindex copy mail
9993 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
9994 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
9995 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
9996 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9997 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9998
9999 @item B B
10000 @kindex B B (Summary)
10001 @cindex crosspost mail
10002 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10003 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10004 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10005 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10006 be properly updated.
10007
10008 @item B i
10009 @kindex B i (Summary)
10010 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10011 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10012 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10013 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10014
10015 @item B I
10016 @kindex B I (Summary)
10017 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10018 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10019 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10020 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10021
10022 @item B r
10023 @kindex B r (Summary)
10024 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10025 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10026 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10027 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10028 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10029 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10030 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10031 (which is the default).
10032
10033 @item B w
10034 @itemx e
10035 @kindex B w (Summary)
10036 @kindex e (Summary)
10037 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10038 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10039 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10040 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10041 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10042 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10043 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10044
10045 @item B q
10046 @kindex B q (Summary)
10047 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10048 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10049 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10050 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10051
10052 @item B t
10053 @kindex B t (Summary)
10054 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10055 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10056 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10057
10058 @item B p
10059 @kindex B p (Summary)
10060 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10061 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10062 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10063 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10064 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10065 article from your news server (or rather, from
10066 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10067 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10068 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10069 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10070 just not have arrived yet.
10071
10072 @item K E
10073 @kindex K E (Summary)
10074 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10075 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10076 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10077 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10078 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10079
10080 @end table
10081
10082 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10083 @cindex moving articles
10084 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10085 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10086 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10087 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10088 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10089 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10090 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10091
10092 @lisp
10093 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10094 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10095 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10096 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10097 @end lisp
10098
10099
10100 @node Various Summary Stuff
10101 @section Various Summary Stuff
10102
10103 @menu
10104 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10105 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10106 * Summary Generation Commands::
10107 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10108 @end menu
10109
10110 @table @code
10111 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10112 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10113 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10114 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10115 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10116 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10117
10118 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10119 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10120 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10121 current article.
10122
10123 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10124 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10125 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10126
10127 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10128 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10129 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10130 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10131 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10132 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10133 have been set.
10134
10135 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10136 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10137 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10138 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10139 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10140
10141 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10142 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10143 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10144 generated.
10145
10146 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10147 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10148 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10149 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10150 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10151 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10152 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10153 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10154 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10155 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10156
10157 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10158 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10159 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10160 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10161 list of articles to be selected.
10162
10163 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10164 the list in one particular group:
10165
10166 @lisp
10167 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10168 (if (string= group "some.group")
10169 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10170 articles))
10171 @end lisp
10172
10173 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10174 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10175 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10176 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10177 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10178 buffer is active.
10179
10180 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10181 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10182 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10183 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10184 variable will be used instead.
10185
10186 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10187 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10188 buffers. For example:
10189
10190 @lisp
10191 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10192 '(message-use-followup-to
10193 (gnus-visible-headers .
10194 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10195 @end lisp
10196
10197 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10198 @end table
10199
10200
10201 @node Summary Group Information
10202 @subsection Summary Group Information
10203
10204 @table @kbd
10205
10206 @item H f
10207 @kindex H f (Summary)
10208 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10209 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10210 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10211 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10212 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10213 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10214 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10215 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10216 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10217
10218 @item H d
10219 @kindex H d (Summary)
10220 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10221 Give a brief description of the current group
10222 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10223 rereading the description from the server.
10224
10225 @item H h
10226 @kindex H h (Summary)
10227 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10228 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10229 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10230
10231 @item H i
10232 @kindex H i (Summary)
10233 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10234 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10235 @end table
10236
10237
10238 @node Searching for Articles
10239 @subsection Searching for Articles
10240
10241 @table @kbd
10242
10243 @item M-s
10244 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10245 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10246 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10247 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10248
10249 @item M-r
10250 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10251 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10252 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10253 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10254
10255 @item &
10256 @kindex & (Summary)
10257 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10258 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10259 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10260 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10261 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10262 search backward instead.
10263
10264 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10265 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10266
10267 @item M-&
10268 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10269 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10270 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10271 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10272 @end table
10273
10274 @node Summary Generation Commands
10275 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10276
10277 @table @kbd
10278
10279 @item Y g
10280 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10281 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10282 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10283
10284 @item Y c
10285 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10286 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10287 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10288 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10289
10290 @item Y d
10291 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10292 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10293 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10294 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10295
10296 @end table
10297
10298
10299 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10300 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10301
10302 @table @kbd
10303
10304 @item A D
10305 @itemx C-d
10306 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10307 @kindex A D (Summary)
10308 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10309 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10310 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10311 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10312 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10313 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10314 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10315 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10316 fashion.
10317
10318 @item C-M-d
10319 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10320 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10321 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10322 several documents into one biiig group
10323 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10324 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10325 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10326 command understands the process/prefix convention
10327 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10328
10329 @item C-t
10330 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10331 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10332 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10333 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10334 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10335 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10336
10337 @item =
10338 @kindex = (Summary)
10339 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10340 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10341 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10342
10343 @item C-M-e
10344 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10345 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10346 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10347 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10348
10349 @item C-M-a
10350 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10351 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10352 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10353 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10354
10355 @end table
10356
10357
10358 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10359 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10360 @cindex summary exit
10361 @cindex exiting groups
10362
10363 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10364 group and return you to the group buffer.
10365
10366 @table @kbd
10367
10368 @item Z Z
10369 @itemx Z Q
10370 @itemx q
10371 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10372 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10373 @kindex q (Summary)
10374 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10375 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10376 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10377 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10378 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10379 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10380 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10381 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10382 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10383 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10384 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10385 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10386
10387 @item Z E
10388 @itemx Q
10389 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10390 @kindex Q (Summary)
10391 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10392 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10393 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10394
10395 @item Z c
10396 @itemx c
10397 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10398 @kindex c (Summary)
10399 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10400 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10401 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10402 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10403
10404 @item Z C
10405 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10406 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10407 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10408 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10409
10410 @item Z n
10411 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10412 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10413 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10414 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10415
10416 @item Z R
10417 @itemx C-x C-s
10418 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10419 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10420 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10421 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10422 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10423 all articles, both read and unread.
10424
10425 @item Z G
10426 @itemx M-g
10427 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10428 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10429 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10430 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10431 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10432 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10433 articles, both read and unread.
10434
10435 @item Z N
10436 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10437 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10438 Exit the group and go to the next group
10439 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10440
10441 @item Z P
10442 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10443 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10444 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10445 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10446
10447 @item Z s
10448 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10449 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10450 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10451 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10452 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10453 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10454 @end table
10455
10456 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10457 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10458 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10459 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10460
10461 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10462 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10463 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10464 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10465 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10466 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10467 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10468 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10469 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10470 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10471 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10472 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10473
10474 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10475
10476 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10477 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10478 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10479 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10480 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10481 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10482 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10483 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10484 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10485
10486
10487 @node Crosspost Handling
10488 @section Crosspost Handling
10489
10490 @cindex velveeta
10491 @cindex spamming
10492 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10493 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10494 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10495 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10496 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10497 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10498 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10499
10500 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10501 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10502 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10503 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10504 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10505
10506 @cindex cross-posting
10507 @cindex Xref
10508 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10509 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10510 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10511 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10512 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10513 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10514 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10515 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10516 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10517 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10518 the cross reference mechanism.
10519
10520 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10521 @cindex overview.fmt
10522 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10523 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10524 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10525 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10526 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10527 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10528 overview files.
10529
10530 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10531 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10532 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10533 considerably.
10534
10535 C'est la vie.
10536
10537 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10538
10539
10540 @node Duplicate Suppression
10541 @section Duplicate Suppression
10542
10543 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10544 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10545 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10546 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10547 reasons.
10548
10549 @enumerate
10550 @item
10551 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10552 is evil and not very common.
10553
10554 @item
10555 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10556 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10557
10558 @item
10559 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10560 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10561
10562 @item
10563 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10564 @end enumerate
10565
10566 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10567 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10568
10569 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10570 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10571 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10572 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10573 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10574 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10575 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10576 once.
10577
10578 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10579 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10580 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10581 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10582 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10583 saw the article in.
10584
10585 @table @code
10586 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10587 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10588 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10589
10590 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10591 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10592 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10593 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10594 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10595 session are suppressed.
10596
10597 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10598 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10599 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10600 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10601
10602 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10603 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10604 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10605 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10606 @end table
10607
10608 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10609 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10610 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10611 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10612 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10613 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10614 to you to figure out, I think.
10615
10616 @node Security
10617 @section Security
10618
10619 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10620 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10621 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10622 things to work:
10623
10624 @enumerate
10625 @item
10626 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10627 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10628 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10629 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10630
10631 @item
10632 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10633 or newer is recommended.
10634
10635 @end enumerate
10636
10637 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10638 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10639
10640 @table @code
10641 @item mm-verify-option
10642 @vindex mm-verify-option
10643 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10644 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10645 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10646
10647 @item mm-decrypt-option
10648 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10649 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10650 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10651 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10652
10653 @item mml1991-use
10654 @vindex mml1991-use
10655 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10656 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10657 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10658 deprecated.
10659
10660 @item mml2015-use
10661 @vindex mml2015-use
10662 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10663 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10664 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10665 deprecated.
10666
10667 @end table
10668
10669 @cindex snarfing keys
10670 @cindex importing PGP keys
10671 @cindex PGP key ring import
10672 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10673 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10674 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10675 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10676 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10677 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10678 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10679 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10680 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10681
10682 @example
10683 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10684 @end example
10685 @noindent
10686 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10687 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10688
10689 @node Mailing List
10690 @section Mailing List
10691 @cindex mailing list
10692 @cindex RFC 2396
10693
10694 @kindex A M (summary)
10695 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10696 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10697 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10698 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10699 summary buffer.
10700
10701 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10702
10703 @table @kbd
10704
10705 @item C-c C-n h
10706 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10707 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10708 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10709
10710 @item C-c C-n s
10711 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10712 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10713 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10714
10715 @item C-c C-n u
10716 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10717 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10718 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10719 field exists.
10720
10721 @item C-c C-n p
10722 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10723 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10724 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10725
10726 @item C-c C-n o
10727 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10728 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10729 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10730
10731 @item C-c C-n a
10732 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10733 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10734 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10735
10736 @end table
10737
10738
10739 @node Article Buffer
10740 @chapter Article Buffer
10741 @cindex article buffer
10742
10743 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10744 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10745 tell Gnus otherwise.
10746
10747 @menu
10748 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10749 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10750 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10751 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10752 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10753 @end menu
10754
10755
10756 @node Hiding Headers
10757 @section Hiding Headers
10758 @cindex hiding headers
10759 @cindex deleting headers
10760
10761 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10762 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10763
10764 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10765 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10766 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10767 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10768 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10769 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10770 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10771 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10772 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10773
10774 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10775
10776 @table @code
10777
10778 @item gnus-visible-headers
10779 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10780 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10781 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10782 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10783
10784 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10785 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10786
10787 @lisp
10788 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10789 @end lisp
10790
10791 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10792 remain visible.
10793
10794 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10795 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10796 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10797 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10798 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10799 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10800
10801 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10802 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10803
10804 @lisp
10805 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10806 @end lisp
10807
10808 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10809 be removed.
10810
10811 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10812 variable will have no effect.
10813
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10817 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10818 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10819 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10820 the headers are to be displayed.
10821
10822 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10823 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10824
10825 @lisp
10826 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10827 @end lisp
10828
10829 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10830 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10831
10832 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10833 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10834 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10835 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10836 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10837 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10838 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10839 from sight.
10840
10841 These conditions are:
10842 @table @code
10843 @item empty
10844 Remove all empty headers.
10845 @item followup-to
10846 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10847 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10848 @item reply-to
10849 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10850 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10851 parameter is set.
10852 @item newsgroups
10853 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10854 name.
10855 @item to-address
10856 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10857 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10858 @item to-list
10859 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10860 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10861 @item cc-list
10862 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10863 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10864 @item date
10865 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10866 old.
10867 @item long-to
10868 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10869 @item many-to
10870 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10871 @end table
10872
10873 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10874
10875 @lisp
10876 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10877 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10878 @end lisp
10879
10880 This is also the default value for this variable.
10881
10882
10883 @node Using MIME
10884 @section Using MIME
10885 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10886
10887 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10888 while people stand around yawning.
10889
10890 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10891 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10892
10893 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10894 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10895 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10896
10897 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10898 @findex gnus-display-mime
10899 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10900 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10901 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10902 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10903
10904 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10905 @acronym{MIME} button:
10906
10907 @table @kbd
10908 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10909 @item RET (Article)
10910 @kindex RET (Article)
10911 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10912 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10913 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10914 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10915 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10916 object is displayed inline.
10917
10918 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10919 @item M-RET (Article)
10920 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10921 @itemx v (Article)
10922 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10923 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10924
10925 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10926 @item t (Article)
10927 @kindex t (Article)
10928 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10929 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10930
10931 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10932 @item C (Article)
10933 @kindex C (Article)
10934 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10935 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10936
10937 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10938 @item o (Article)
10939 @kindex o (Article)
10940 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10941 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10942
10943 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10944 @item C-o (Article)
10945 @kindex C-o (Article)
10946 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10947 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10948 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10949 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10950 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10951 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10952
10953 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10954 @item d (Article)
10955 @kindex d (Article)
10956 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10957 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10958 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10959
10960 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10961 @item c (Article)
10962 @kindex c (Article)
10963 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10964 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10965 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10966 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10967 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10968
10969 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10970 @item p (Article)
10971 @kindex p (Article)
10972 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10973 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10974 @file{.mailcap} file.
10975
10976 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10977 @item i (Article)
10978 @kindex i (Article)
10979 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10980 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
10981 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
10982 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
10983 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
10984 Article}).
10985
10986 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
10987 @item E (Article)
10988 @kindex E (Article)
10989 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
10990 viewer is available, use an external viewer
10991 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
10992
10993 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
10994 @item e (Article)
10995 @kindex e (Article)
10996 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
10997 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
10998
10999 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11000 @item | (Article)
11001 @kindex | (Article)
11002 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11003
11004 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11005 @item . (Article)
11006 @kindex . (Article)
11007 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11008 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11009
11010 @end table
11011
11012 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11013 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11014 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11015
11016 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11017 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11018 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11019 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11020 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11021 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11022 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11023 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11024 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11025
11026 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11027
11028 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11029
11030
11031 @node Customizing Articles
11032 @section Customizing Articles
11033 @cindex article customization
11034
11035 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11036 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11037 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11038 called automatically when you select the articles.
11039
11040 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11041 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11042 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11043 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11044
11045 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11046 for sensible values.
11047
11048 @enumerate
11049 @item
11050 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11051
11052 @item
11053 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11054
11055 @item
11056 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11057
11058 @item
11059 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11060
11061 @item
11062 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11063 than this number.
11064
11065 @item
11066 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11067 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11068 regexps in the list.
11069
11070 @item
11071 A list where the first element is not a string:
11072
11073 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11074 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11075 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11076
11077 @lisp
11078 (or last
11079 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11080 @end lisp
11081
11082 @end enumerate
11083
11084 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11085 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11086 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11087 considered to contain just a single part.
11088
11089 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11090 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11091 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11092 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11093 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11094 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11095 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11096
11097 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11098 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11099 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11100 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11101
11102 @table @code
11103 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11104 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11105
11106 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11107
11108 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11109 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11110 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11111 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11112 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11113 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11114 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11115 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11116 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11117 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11118
11119 @xref{Article Washing}.
11120
11121 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11122 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11123 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11124 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11125 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11126 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11127 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11128
11129 @xref{Article Date}.
11130
11131 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11132 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11133 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11134
11135 @xref{Picons}.
11136
11137 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11138
11139 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11140
11141 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11142 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11143 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11144
11145 @xref{Smileys}.
11146
11147 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11148
11149 @xref{X-Face}.
11150
11151 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11152
11153 @xref{Face}.
11154
11155 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11156 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11157 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11158 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11159 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11160 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11161 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11162 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11163 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11164 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11165
11166 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11167
11168 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11169 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11170 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11171
11172 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11173
11174 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11175 @item gnus-treat-translate
11176 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11177
11178 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11179 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11180 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11181 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11182
11183 @xref{Article Header}.
11184
11185
11186 @end table
11187
11188 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11189 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11190 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11191 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11192 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11193 everything.
11194
11195
11196 @node Article Keymap
11197 @section Article Keymap
11198
11199 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11200 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11201 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11202 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11203 buffer.
11204
11205 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11206
11207 @table @kbd
11208
11209 @item SPACE
11210 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11211 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11212 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11213 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11214
11215 @item DEL
11216 @kindex DEL (Article)
11217 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11218 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11219 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11220
11221 @item C-c ^
11222 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11223 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11224 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11225 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11226 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11227
11228 @item C-c C-m
11229 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11230 @findex gnus-article-mail
11231 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11232 given a prefix, include the mail.
11233
11234 @item s
11235 @kindex s (Article)
11236 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11237 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11238 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11239
11240 @item ?
11241 @kindex ? (Article)
11242 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11243 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11244 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11245
11246 @item TAB
11247 @kindex TAB (Article)
11248 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11249 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11250 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11251
11252 @item M-TAB
11253 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11254 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11255 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11256
11257 @item R
11258 @kindex R (Article)
11259 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11260 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11261 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11262 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11263 region.
11264
11265 @item F
11266 @kindex F (Article)
11267 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11268 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11269 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11270 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11271 region.
11272
11273
11274 @end table
11275
11276
11277 @node Misc Article
11278 @section Misc Article
11279
11280 @table @code
11281
11282 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11283 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11284 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11285 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11286 article buffer.
11287
11288 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11289 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11290 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11291 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11292 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11293
11294 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11295 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11296 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11297 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11298 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11299 the contents of the article buffer.
11300
11301 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11302 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11303 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11304
11305 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11306 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11307 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11308 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11309
11310 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11311 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11312 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11313 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11314
11315 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11316 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11317 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11318 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11319 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11320 with two extensions:
11321
11322 @table @samp
11323
11324 @item w
11325 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11326 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11327 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11328
11329 @table @samp
11330
11331 @item c
11332 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11333
11334 @item h
11335 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11336
11337 @item p
11338 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11339 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11340 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11341
11342 @item s
11343 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11344
11345 @item o
11346 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11347
11348 @item e
11349 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11350
11351 @end table
11352
11353 @item m
11354 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11355
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11359
11360 @item gnus-break-pages
11361 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11362 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11363 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11364 paging will not be done.
11365
11366 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11367 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11368 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11369 (formfeed).
11370
11371 @cindex IDNA
11372 @cindex internationalized domain names
11373 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11374 @item gnus-use-idna
11375 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11376 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11377 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11378 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11379 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11380
11381 @end table
11382
11383
11384 @node Composing Messages
11385 @chapter Composing Messages
11386 @cindex composing messages
11387 @cindex messages
11388 @cindex mail
11389 @cindex sending mail
11390 @cindex reply
11391 @cindex followup
11392 @cindex post
11393 @cindex using gpg
11394 @cindex using s/mime
11395 @cindex using smime
11396
11397 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11398 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11399 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11400 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11401 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11402 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11403
11404 @menu
11405 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11406 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11407 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11408 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11409 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11410 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11411 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11412 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11413 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11414 @end menu
11415
11416 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11417 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11418
11419
11420 @node Mail
11421 @section Mail
11422
11423 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11424
11425 @table @code
11426 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11427 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11428 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11429 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11430 @code{nil} include all headers.
11431
11432 @item gnus-add-to-list
11433 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11434 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11435 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11436
11437 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11438 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11439 This can also be a function receiving the group name as the only
11440 parameter which should return non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is
11441 needed, or a regular expression matching group names, where
11442 confirmation is should be asked for.
11443
11444 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11445 press R anyway, this variable might be for you.
11446
11447 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11448 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11449 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11450 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11451 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11452
11453 @end table
11454
11455
11456 @node Posting Server
11457 @section Posting Server
11458
11459 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11460 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11461
11462 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11463
11464 It can be quite complicated.
11465
11466 @vindex gnus-post-method
11467 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11468 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11469 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11470 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11471 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11472 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11473 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11474 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11475 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11476
11477 @lisp
11478 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11479 @end lisp
11480
11481 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11482 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11483 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11484 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11485
11486 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11487 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11488
11489 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11490 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11491 for posting.
11492
11493 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11494 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11495
11496 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11497 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11498 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11499 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11500 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11501 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11502 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11503 package correctly. An example:
11504
11505 @lisp
11506 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11507 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11508 @end lisp
11509
11510 To the thing similar to this, there is
11511 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11512 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11513 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11514
11515 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11516 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11517 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11518
11519 @node POP before SMTP
11520 @section POP before SMTP
11521 @cindex pop before smtp
11522 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11523 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11524
11525 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11526 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11527 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11528 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11529 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11530
11531 @lisp
11532 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11533 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11534 @end lisp
11535
11536 @noindent
11537 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11538 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11539 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11540 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11541 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11542 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11543 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11544 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11545
11546 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11547 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11548 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11549 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11550 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11551 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11552
11553 @lisp
11554 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11555 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11556 :password "secret"))
11557 @end lisp
11558
11559 @noindent
11560 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11561 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11562
11563 @lisp
11564 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11565 (lambda ()
11566 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11567 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11568 :password "secret")))
11569 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11570 @end lisp
11571
11572 @node Mail and Post
11573 @section Mail and Post
11574
11575 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11576 posting:
11577
11578 @table @code
11579 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11580 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11581 @cindex mailing lists
11582
11583 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11584 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11585 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11586 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11587 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11588 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11589 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11590 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11591 still a pain, though.
11592
11593 @item gnus-user-agent
11594 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11595 @cindex User-Agent
11596
11597 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11598 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11599 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11600 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11601 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11602 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11603 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11604
11605 @end table
11606
11607 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11608 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11609 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11610
11611 @cindex ispell
11612 @findex ispell-message
11613 @lisp
11614 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11615 @end lisp
11616
11617 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11618 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11619
11620 @lisp
11621 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11622 (lambda ()
11623 (cond
11624 ((string-match
11625 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11626 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11627 (t
11628 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11629 @end lisp
11630
11631 Modify to suit your needs.
11632
11633
11634 @node Archived Messages
11635 @section Archived Messages
11636 @cindex archived messages
11637 @cindex sent messages
11638
11639 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11640 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11641 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11642 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11643 is the default.
11644
11645 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11646 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11647 Group Commands}).
11648
11649 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11650 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11651 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11652
11653 @lisp
11654 (nnfolder "archive"
11655 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11656 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11657 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11658 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11659 @end lisp
11660
11661 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11662 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11663 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11664 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11665
11666 @lisp
11667 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11668 '(nnfolder "archive"
11669 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11670 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11671 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11672 @end lisp
11673
11674 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11675 @cindex Gcc
11676 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11677 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11678 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11679
11680 This variable can be used to do the following:
11681
11682 @table @asis
11683 @item a string
11684 Messages will be saved in that group.
11685
11686 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11687 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11688 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11689 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11690 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11691 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11692 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11693 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11694 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11695
11696 @item a list of strings
11697 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11698
11699 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11700 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11701
11702 @item @code{nil}
11703 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11704 @end table
11705
11706 Let's illustrate:
11707
11708 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11709 @lisp
11710 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11711 @end lisp
11712
11713 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11714 @lisp
11715 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11716 @end lisp
11717
11718 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11719 @lisp
11720 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11721 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11722 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11723 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11724 @end lisp
11725
11726 More complex stuff:
11727 @lisp
11728 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11729 '((if (message-news-p)
11730 "misc-news"
11731 "misc-mail")))
11732 @end lisp
11733
11734 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11735 messages in one file per month:
11736
11737 @lisp
11738 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11739 '((if (message-news-p)
11740 "misc-news"
11741 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11742 @end lisp
11743
11744 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11745 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11746
11747 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11748 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11749 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11750 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11751 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11752 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11753 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11754 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11755 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11756 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11757
11758 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11759 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11760 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11761 this will disable archiving.
11762
11763 @table @code
11764 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11765 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11766 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11767 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11768 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11769 group names.
11770
11771 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11772 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11773 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11774 of names).
11775
11776 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11777 but the latter is the preferred method.
11778
11779 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11780 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11781 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11782
11783 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11784 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11785 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11786 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11787 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11788 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11789 changed in the future.
11790
11791 @end table
11792
11793
11794 @node Posting Styles
11795 @section Posting Styles
11796 @cindex posting styles
11797 @cindex styles
11798
11799 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11800
11801 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11802 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11803 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11804 on?
11805
11806 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11807 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11808 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11809 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11810 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11811 variable:
11812
11813 @lisp
11814 ((".*"
11815 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11816 (organization "What me?"))
11817 ("^comp"
11818 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11819 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11820 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11821 @end lisp
11822
11823 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11824 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11825 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11826 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11827 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11828 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11829 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11830 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11831
11832 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11833 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11834 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11835 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11836 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11837 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11838 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11839 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11840 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11841 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11842 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11843 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11844 said to @dfn{match}.
11845
11846 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11847 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11848 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11849 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11850 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11851 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11852 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11853 name can be one of:
11854
11855 @itemize @bullet
11856 @item @code{signature}
11857 @item @code{signature-file}
11858 @item @code{x-face-file}
11859 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11860 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11861 @item @code{body}
11862 @end itemize
11863
11864 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11865 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11866 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11867 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11868 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11869
11870 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11871 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11872 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11873 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11874 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11875 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11876 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11877 references chars lines xref extra.
11878
11879 @vindex message-reply-headers
11880
11881 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11882 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11883 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11884
11885 @findex message-mail-p
11886 @findex message-news-p
11887
11888 So here's a new example:
11889
11890 @lisp
11891 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11892 '((".*"
11893 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11894 (name "User Name")
11895 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11896 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11897 ("^rec.humor"
11898 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11899 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11900 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11901 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11902 (signature my-news-signature))
11903 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11904 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11905 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11906 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11907 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11908 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11909 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11910 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11911 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11912 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11913 ("nnml:.*"
11914 (From (save-excursion
11915 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11916 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11917 ("^nn.+:"
11918 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11919 @end lisp
11920
11921 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11922 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11923 if you fill many roles.
11924
11925
11926 @node Drafts
11927 @section Drafts
11928 @cindex drafts
11929
11930 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11931 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11932 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11933 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11934 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11935
11936 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11937 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11938 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11939 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11940 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11941 group.)
11942
11943 @cindex nndraft
11944 @vindex nndraft-directory
11945 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11946 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11947 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11948 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11949 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11950 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11951
11952 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11953 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11954 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11955 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11956 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11957 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11958 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11959 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11960 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11961
11962 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11963 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11964 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11965 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11966 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11967 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11968 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11969 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11970 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11971 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11972 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11973 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11974 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11975 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11976 @c
11977 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11978 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11979 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11980
11981 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11982 @kindex D e (Draft)
11983 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
11984 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
11985 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
11986
11987 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
11988 Articles}).
11989
11990 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
11991 @kindex D s (Draft)
11992 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
11993 @kindex D S (Draft)
11994 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
11995 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
11996 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
11997 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
11998 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
11999 in the buffer.
12000
12001 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12002 @kindex D t (Draft)
12003 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12004 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12005 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12006
12007
12008 @node Rejected Articles
12009 @section Rejected Articles
12010 @cindex rejected articles
12011
12012 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12013 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12014 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12015 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12016
12017 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12018 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12019 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12020 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12021 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12022
12023 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12024 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12025 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12026
12027 @node Signing and encrypting
12028 @section Signing and encrypting
12029 @cindex using gpg
12030 @cindex using s/mime
12031 @cindex using smime
12032
12033 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12034 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12035 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12036 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12037
12038 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12039 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12040 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12041 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12042 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12043 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12044 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12045 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12046 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12047 automatically encrypted messages.
12048
12049 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12050 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12051 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12052
12053 @table @kbd
12054
12055 @item C-c C-m s s
12056 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12057 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12058
12059 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12060
12061 @item C-c C-m s o
12062 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12063 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12064
12065 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12066
12067 @item C-c C-m s p
12068 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12069 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12070
12071 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12072
12073 @item C-c C-m c s
12074 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12075 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12076
12077 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12078
12079 @item C-c C-m c o
12080 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12081 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12082
12083 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12084
12085 @item C-c C-m c p
12086 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12087 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12088
12089 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12090
12091 @item C-c C-m C-n
12092 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12093 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12094 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12095
12096 @end table
12097
12098 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12099
12100 @node Select Methods
12101 @chapter Select Methods
12102 @cindex foreign groups
12103 @cindex select methods
12104
12105 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12106 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12107 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12108 personal mail group.
12109
12110 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12111 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12112 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12113 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12114 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12115 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12116
12117 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12118 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12119
12120 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12121 group as.
12122
12123 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12124 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12125 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12126 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12127 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12128
12129 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12130
12131 @menu
12132 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12133 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12134 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12135 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12136 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12137 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12138 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12139 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12140 @end menu
12141
12142
12143 @node Server Buffer
12144 @section Server Buffer
12145
12146 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12147 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12148 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12149 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12150 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12151 back end represents a virtual server.
12152
12153 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12154 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12155 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12156 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12157
12158 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12159 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12160 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12161 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12162 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12163 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12164 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12165
12166 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12167 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12168
12169 @menu
12170 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12171 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12172 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12173 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12174 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12175 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12176 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12177 @end menu
12178
12179 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12180 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12181
12182
12183 @node Server Buffer Format
12184 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12185 @cindex server buffer format
12186
12187 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12188 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12189 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12190 variable, with some simple extensions:
12191
12192 @table @samp
12193
12194 @item h
12195 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12196
12197 @item n
12198 The name of this server.
12199
12200 @item w
12201 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12202
12203 @item s
12204 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12205 @end table
12206
12207 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12208 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12209 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12210 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12211
12212 @table @samp
12213 @item S
12214 Server name.
12215
12216 @item M
12217 Server method.
12218 @end table
12219
12220 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12221
12222
12223 @node Server Commands
12224 @subsection Server Commands
12225 @cindex server commands
12226
12227 @table @kbd
12228
12229 @item a
12230 @kindex a (Server)
12231 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12232 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12233
12234 @item e
12235 @kindex e (Server)
12236 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12237 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12238
12239 @item SPACE
12240 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12241 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12242 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12243
12244 @item q
12245 @kindex q (Server)
12246 @findex gnus-server-exit
12247 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12248
12249 @item k
12250 @kindex k (Server)
12251 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12252 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12253
12254 @item y
12255 @kindex y (Server)
12256 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12257 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12258
12259 @item c
12260 @kindex c (Server)
12261 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12262 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12263
12264 @item l
12265 @kindex l (Server)
12266 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12267 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12268
12269 @item s
12270 @kindex s (Server)
12271 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12272 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12273 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12274 servers.
12275
12276 @item g
12277 @kindex g (Server)
12278 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12279 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12280 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12281 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12282
12283 @end table
12284
12285
12286 @node Example Methods
12287 @subsection Example Methods
12288
12289 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12290
12291 @lisp
12292 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12293 @end lisp
12294
12295 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12296
12297 @lisp
12298 (nnspool "")
12299 @end lisp
12300
12301 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12302 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12303 will.
12304
12305 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12306 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12307
12308 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12309 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12310 look like then:
12311
12312 @lisp
12313 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12314 @end lisp
12315
12316 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12317 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12318
12319 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12320 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12321 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12322 your private mail:
12323
12324 @lisp
12325 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12326 @end lisp
12327
12328 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12329 that.)
12330
12331 Here's the method for a public spool:
12332
12333 @lisp
12334 (nnmh "public"
12335 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12336 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12337 @end lisp
12338
12339 @cindex proxy
12340 @cindex firewall
12341
12342 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12343 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12344 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12345 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12346 should probably look something like this:
12347
12348 @lisp
12349 (nntp "firewall"
12350 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12351 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12352 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12353 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12354 @end lisp
12355
12356 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12357 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12358 configuration to the example above:
12359
12360 @lisp
12361 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12362 @end lisp
12363
12364 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12365
12366 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12367 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12368 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12369
12370 @lisp
12371 (nntp "outside"
12372 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12373 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12374 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12375 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12376 @end lisp
12377
12378 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12379 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12380 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12381 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12382
12383
12384 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12385 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12386
12387 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12388 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12389
12390 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12391 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12392 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12393
12394 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12395
12396 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12397 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12398 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12399 will contain the following:
12400
12401 @lisp
12402 (nnml "cache")
12403 @end lisp
12404
12405 Change that to:
12406
12407 @lisp
12408 (nnml "cache"
12409 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12410 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12411 @end lisp
12412
12413 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12414 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12415 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12416
12417
12418 @node Server Variables
12419 @subsection Server Variables
12420 @cindex server variables
12421 @cindex server parameters
12422
12423 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12424 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12425 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12426 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12427 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12428
12429 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12430 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12431 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12432 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12433 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12434 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12435 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12436 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12437 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12438
12439 @lisp
12440 (nnml "public"
12441 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12442 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12443 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12444 @end lisp
12445
12446 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12447
12448 @node Servers and Methods
12449 @subsection Servers and Methods
12450
12451 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12452 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12453 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12454 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12455 over.
12456
12457
12458 @node Unavailable Servers
12459 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12460
12461 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12462 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12463 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12464 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12465 actually the case or not.
12466
12467 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12468 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12469 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12470 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12471 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12472 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12473 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12474 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12475
12476 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12477 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12478
12479 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12480 with the following commands:
12481
12482 @table @kbd
12483
12484 @item O
12485 @kindex O (Server)
12486 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12487 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12488 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12489
12490 @item C
12491 @kindex C (Server)
12492 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12493 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12494 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12495
12496 @item D
12497 @kindex D (Server)
12498 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12499 Mark the current server as unreachable
12500 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12501
12502 @item M-o
12503 @kindex M-o (Server)
12504 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12505 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12506 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12507
12508 @item M-c
12509 @kindex M-c (Server)
12510 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12511 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12512 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12513
12514 @item R
12515 @kindex R (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12517 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12518 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12519
12520 @item L
12521 @kindex L (Server)
12522 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12523 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12524
12525 @end table
12526
12527
12528 @node Getting News
12529 @section Getting News
12530 @cindex reading news
12531 @cindex news back ends
12532
12533 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12534 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12535 or it can read from a local spool.
12536
12537 @menu
12538 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12539 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12540 @end menu
12541
12542
12543 @node NNTP
12544 @subsection NNTP
12545 @cindex nntp
12546
12547 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12548 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12549 server as the, uhm, address.
12550
12551 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12552 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12553 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12554 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12555
12556 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12557 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12558 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12559
12560 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12561 server:
12562
12563 @table @code
12564
12565 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12566 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12567 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12568 @cindex authinfo
12569 @cindex authentification
12570 @cindex nntp authentification
12571 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12572 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12573 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12574 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12575 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12576 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12577 present in this hook.
12578
12579 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12580 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12581 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12582 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12583 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12584 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12585 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12586 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12587 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12588 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12589 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12590 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12591
12592 @enumerate
12593 @item
12594 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12595
12596 @item
12597 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12598
12599 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12600 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12601 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12602 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12603 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12604 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12605 @samp{force} is explained below.
12606
12607 @end enumerate
12608
12609 Here's an example file:
12610
12611 @example
12612 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12613 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12614 @end example
12615
12616 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12617 have to be first, for instance.
12618
12619 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12620 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12621 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12622 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12623 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12624 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12625 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12626
12627 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12628 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12629
12630 @example
12631 default force yes
12632 @end example
12633
12634 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12635 previously mentioned.
12636
12637 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12638
12639 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12640 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12641 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12642 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12643 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12644
12645 @lisp
12646 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12647 '(("innd" (ding))))
12648 @end lisp
12649
12650 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12651
12652 The default value is
12653
12654 @lisp
12655 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12656 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12657 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12658 @end lisp
12659
12660 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12661 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12662
12663 @item nntp-maximum-request
12664 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12665 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12666 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12667 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12668 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12669 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12670 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12671
12672 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12673 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12674 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12675 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12676 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12677 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12678 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12679 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12680 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12681 no timeouts are done.
12682
12683 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
12684 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
12685 @c @cindex PPP connections
12686 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
12687 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
12688 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
12689 @c changes after connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will simply sit
12690 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
12691 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
12692 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
12693 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
12694 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
12695 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
12696 @c
12697 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
12698 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
12699 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
12700 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
12701 @c described above.
12702
12703 @item nntp-server-hook
12704 @vindex nntp-server-hook
12705 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @acronym{NNTP}
12706 server.
12707
12708 @item nntp-buggy-select
12709 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
12710 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
12711
12712 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12713 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12714 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12715 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12716 can be used.
12717
12718 @item nntp-xover-commands
12719 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12720 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12721 @cindex XOVER
12722 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12723 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12724 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12725
12726 @item nntp-nov-gap
12727 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12728 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12729 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12730 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12731 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12732 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12733 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12734 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12735 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12736 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12737 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12738
12739 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12740 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12741 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12742
12743 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12744 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12745 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
12746 server closes connection.
12747
12748 @item nntp-record-commands
12749 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12750 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12751 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12752 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12753 that doesn't seem to work.
12754
12755 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12756 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12757 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12758 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12759 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12760 Five pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12761 two categories: direct connection functions (three pre-made), and
12762 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12763
12764 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12765 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12766 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12767 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12768 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12769 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12770 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12771
12772 @lisp
12773 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12774 @end lisp
12775
12776 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12777 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12778
12779 @item nntp-read-timeout
12780 @vindex nntp-read-timeout
12781 How long nntp should wait between checking for the end of output.
12782 Shorter values mean quicker response, but is more CPU intensive. The
12783 default is 0.1 seconds. If you have a slow line to the server (and
12784 don't like to see Emacs eat your available CPU power), you might set
12785 this to, say, 1.
12786
12787 @end table
12788
12789 @menu
12790 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12791 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12792 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12793 @end menu
12794
12795
12796 @node Direct Functions
12797 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12798 @cindex direct connection functions
12799
12800 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12801 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12802 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12803 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12804
12805 @table @code
12806 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12807 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12808 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12809 remote system.
12810
12811 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12812 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12813 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12814 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12815 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12816
12817 @lisp
12818 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12819 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12820 ;;
12821 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12822 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12823 (nntp-port-number )
12824 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12825 @end lisp
12826
12827 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12828 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12829 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12830 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12831 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12832 then define a server as follows:
12833
12834 @lisp
12835 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12836 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12837 ;;
12838 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12839 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12840 (nntp-port-number 563)
12841 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12842 @end lisp
12843
12844 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12845 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12846 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12847 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12848 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12849 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12850 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12851 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12852
12853 @lisp
12854 (nntp "socksified"
12855 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12856 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12857 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12858 @end lisp
12859
12860 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12861 session, which is not a good idea.
12862 @end table
12863
12864
12865 @node Indirect Functions
12866 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12867 @cindex indirect connection functions
12868
12869 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12870 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12871 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12872 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12873 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12874 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12875
12876 @table @code
12877 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12878 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12879 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12880 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12881 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12882
12883 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12884
12885 @table @code
12886 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12887 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12888 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12889 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12890
12891 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12892 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12893 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12894 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12895 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12896 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12897 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12898 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12899 host.
12900 @end table
12901
12902 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12903 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12904 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12905 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12906
12907 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12908
12909 @table @code
12910 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12911 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12912 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12913 @samp{telnet}.
12914
12915 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12916 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12917 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12918 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12919
12920 @item nntp-via-user-password
12921 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12922 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12923
12924 @item nntp-via-envuser
12925 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12926 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12927 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12928 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12929
12930 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12931 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12932 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12933 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12934
12935 @end table
12936
12937 @end table
12938
12939
12940 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12941 functions:
12942
12943 @table @code
12944
12945 @item nntp-via-user-name
12946 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12947 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12948
12949 @item nntp-via-address
12950 @vindex nntp-via-address
12951 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12952
12953 @end table
12954
12955
12956 @node Common Variables
12957 @subsubsection Common Variables
12958
12959 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12960 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12961 affected.
12962
12963 @table @code
12964
12965 @item nntp-pre-command
12966 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12967 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12968 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12969 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}. This is
12970 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12971
12972 @item nntp-address
12973 @vindex nntp-address
12974 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12975
12976 @item nntp-port-number
12977 @vindex nntp-port-number
12978 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12979 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12980 @acronym{tls}/@acronym{ssl}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12981 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12982 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12983 not work with named ports.
12984
12985 @item nntp-end-of-line
12986 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12987 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12988 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12989 using a non native connection function.
12990
12991 @item nntp-telnet-command
12992 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12993 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12994 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12995 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12996 @samp{telnet}.
12997
12998 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12999 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13000 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13001 is @samp{("-8")}.
13002
13003 @end table
13004
13005
13006 @node News Spool
13007 @subsection News Spool
13008 @cindex nnspool
13009 @cindex news spool
13010
13011 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13012 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13013 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13014 instance.
13015
13016 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13017 anything else) as the address.
13018
13019 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13020 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13021 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13022 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13023
13024 @table @code
13025
13026 @item nnspool-inews-program
13027 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13028 Program used to post an article.
13029
13030 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13031 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13032 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13033
13034 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13035 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13036 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13037 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13038
13039 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13040 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13041 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13042 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13043
13044 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13045 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13046 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13047
13048 @item nnspool-active-file
13049 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13050 The name of the active file.
13051
13052 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13053 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13054 The name of the group descriptions file.
13055
13056 @item nnspool-history-file
13057 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13058 The name of the news history file.
13059
13060 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13061 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13062 The name of the active date file.
13063
13064 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13065 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13066 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13067 that it finds.
13068
13069 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13070 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13071 @cindex sed
13072 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13073 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13074 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13075 there.
13076
13077 @end table
13078
13079
13080 @node Getting Mail
13081 @section Getting Mail
13082 @cindex reading mail
13083 @cindex mail
13084
13085 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13086 course.
13087
13088 @menu
13089 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13090 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13091 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13092 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13093 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13094 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13095 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13096 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13097 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13098 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13099 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13100 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13101 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13102 @end menu
13103
13104
13105 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13106 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13107
13108 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13109 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13110 of a culture shock.
13111
13112 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13113 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13114
13115 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13116 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13117 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13118 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13119
13120 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13121
13122 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13123 deleted? How awful!
13124
13125 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13126 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13127 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13128 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13129 Mail}.
13130
13131 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13132 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13133 they want to treat a message.
13134
13135 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13136 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13137 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13138 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13139 archived somewhere else.
13140
13141 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13142 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13143 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13144 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13145 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13146
13147 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13148 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13149 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13150
13151 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13152 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13153 differently.
13154
13155 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13156 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13157 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13158 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13159 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13160
13161 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13162 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13163 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13164 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13165 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13166 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13167 You Do.)
13168
13169
13170 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13171 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13172
13173 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13174 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13175 and things will happen automatically.
13176
13177 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13178 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13179
13180 @lisp
13181 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13182 @end lisp
13183
13184 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13185 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13186 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13187 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13188 like any other group.
13189
13190 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13191
13192 @lisp
13193 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13194 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13195 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13196 ("other" "")))
13197 @end lisp
13198
13199 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13200 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13201 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13202 last group.
13203
13204 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13205 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13206 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13207
13208
13209 @node Splitting Mail
13210 @subsection Splitting Mail
13211 @cindex splitting mail
13212 @cindex mail splitting
13213 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13214
13215 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13216 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13217 to be split into groups.
13218
13219 @lisp
13220 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13221 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13222 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13223 ("mail.other" "")))
13224 @end lisp
13225
13226 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13227 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13228 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13229 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13230 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13231 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13232 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13233
13234 @lisp
13235 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13236 @end lisp
13237
13238 @noindent
13239 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13240 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13241
13242 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13243 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13244 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13245 mail belongs in that group.
13246
13247 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13248 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{*} so that it matches any mails
13249 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13250 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
13251 rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled.
13252 In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) When new groups are
13253 created by splitting mail, you may want to run
13254 @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to see the new groups.
13255
13256 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13257 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13258 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13259 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13260 thinks should carry this mail message.
13261
13262 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13263 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13264 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13265 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13266
13267 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13268 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13269 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13270 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13271 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{*}) group.
13272
13273 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13274 @cindex crosspost
13275 @cindex links
13276 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13277 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13278 links. If that's the case for you, set
13279 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13280 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13281
13282 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13283 @findex nnmail-split-history
13284 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13285 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13286 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13287 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13288 Group Commands}).
13289
13290 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13291 Header lines longer than the value of
13292 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13293 function.
13294
13295 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13296 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13297 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13298 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13299 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13300 charset for decoding. The behaviour can be turned off completely by
13301 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13302 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13303
13304 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13305 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13306 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13307 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13308 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13309 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13310 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13311 other kinds of entries.)
13312
13313 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13314 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13315 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13316 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13317 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13318 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13319 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13320 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13321 month's rent money.
13322
13323
13324 @node Mail Sources
13325 @subsection Mail Sources
13326
13327 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13328 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13329 maildir, for instance.
13330
13331 @menu
13332 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13333 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13334 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13335 @end menu
13336
13337
13338 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13339 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13340 @cindex POP
13341 @cindex mail server
13342 @cindex procmail
13343 @cindex mail spool
13344 @cindex mail source
13345
13346 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13347 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13348
13349 Here's an example:
13350
13351 @lisp
13352 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13353 @end lisp
13354
13355 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13356 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13357 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13358 default values.
13359
13360 The following mail source types are available:
13361
13362 @table @code
13363 @item file
13364 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13365
13366 Keywords:
13367
13368 @table @code
13369 @item :path
13370 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13371 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13372 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13373
13374 @item :prescript
13375 @itemx :postscript
13376 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13377 @end table
13378
13379 An example file mail source:
13380
13381 @lisp
13382 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13383 @end lisp
13384
13385 Or using the default file name:
13386
13387 @lisp
13388 (file)
13389 @end lisp
13390
13391 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13392 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13393 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13394 mail spool while moving the mail.
13395
13396 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13397
13398 @lisp
13399 (setq mail-sources
13400 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13401 @end lisp
13402
13403 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13404
13405 @example
13406 #!/bin/sh
13407 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13408 # flu@@iki.fi
13409
13410 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13411 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13412 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13413 @end example
13414
13415 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13416
13417
13418 @item directory
13419 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13420 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13421 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13422 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13423 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13424 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13425 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13426 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13427 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13428 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13429
13430 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13431 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13432 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13433 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13434
13435 Keywords:
13436
13437 @table @code
13438 @item :path
13439 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13440 value.
13441
13442 @item :suffix
13443 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13444 @samp{.spool}.
13445
13446 @item :predicate
13447 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13448 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13449 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13450 predicate are considered.
13451
13452 @item :prescript
13453 @itemx :postscript
13454 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13455
13456 @end table
13457
13458 An example directory mail source:
13459
13460 @lisp
13461 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13462 :suffix ".prcml")
13463 @end lisp
13464
13465 @item pop
13466 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13467
13468 Keywords:
13469
13470 @table @code
13471 @item :server
13472 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13473 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13474
13475 @item :port
13476 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13477 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13478 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13479 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13480 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13481
13482 @item :user
13483 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13484 name.
13485
13486 @item :password
13487 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13488 the user is prompted.
13489
13490 @item :program
13491 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13492 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13493
13494 @example
13495 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13496 @end example
13497
13498 The valid format specifier characters are:
13499
13500 @table @samp
13501 @item t
13502 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13503 included in this string.
13504
13505 @item s
13506 The name of the server.
13507
13508 @item P
13509 The port number of the server.
13510
13511 @item u
13512 The user name to use.
13513
13514 @item p
13515 The password to use.
13516 @end table
13517
13518 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13519 corresponding keywords.
13520
13521 @item :prescript
13522 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13523 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13524
13525 @item :postscript
13526 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13527 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13528
13529 @item :function
13530 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13531 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13532 mail should be moved to.
13533
13534 @item :authentication
13535 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13536 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13537 @code{password}.
13538
13539 @end table
13540
13541 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13542 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13543 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13544 left on the POP server after fetching.
13545
13546 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13547 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13548
13549 @lisp
13550 (pop)
13551 @end lisp
13552
13553 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13554
13555 @lisp
13556 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13557 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13558 @end lisp
13559
13560 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13561
13562 @lisp
13563 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13564 @end lisp
13565
13566 @item maildir
13567 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13568 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13569 contains exactly one mail.
13570
13571 Keywords:
13572
13573 @table @code
13574 @item :path
13575 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13576 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13577 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13578 @item :subdirs
13579 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13580 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13581
13582 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13583 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13584 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13585 @c below.
13586
13587 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13588 from locking problems).
13589
13590 @end table
13591
13592 Two example maildir mail sources:
13593
13594 @lisp
13595 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13596 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13597 @end lisp
13598
13599 @lisp
13600 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13601 :subdirs ("new"))
13602 @end lisp
13603
13604 @item imap
13605 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13606 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13607 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13608 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13609 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13610
13611 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13612 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13613
13614 Keywords:
13615
13616 @table @code
13617 @item :server
13618 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13619 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13620
13621 @item :port
13622 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13623 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13624
13625 @item :user
13626 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13627 name.
13628
13629 @item :password
13630 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13631 prompted.
13632
13633 @item :stream
13634 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13635 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13636 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13637 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13638
13639 @item :authentication
13640 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13641 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13642 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13643 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13644
13645 @item :program
13646 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13647 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13648 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13649
13650 @example
13651 ssh %s imapd
13652 @end example
13653
13654 The valid format specifier characters are:
13655
13656 @table @samp
13657 @item s
13658 The name of the server.
13659
13660 @item l
13661 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13662
13663 @item p
13664 The port number of the server.
13665 @end table
13666
13667 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13668 corresponding keywords.
13669
13670 @item :mailbox
13671 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13672 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13673
13674 @item :predicate
13675 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13676 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13677 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13678 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13679 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13680 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13681
13682 @item :fetchflag
13683 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13684 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13685 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13686 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13687
13688 @item :dontexpunge
13689 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13690 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13691
13692 @end table
13693
13694 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13695
13696 @lisp
13697 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13698 :stream kerberos4
13699 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13700 @end lisp
13701
13702 @item webmail
13703 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13704 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13705 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13706
13707 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13708 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13709
13710 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13711
13712 Keywords:
13713
13714 @table @code
13715 @item :subtype
13716 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13717 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13718
13719 @item :user
13720 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13721 name.
13722
13723 @item :password
13724 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13725 prompted.
13726
13727 @item :dontexpunge
13728 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13729 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13730
13731 @end table
13732
13733 An example webmail source:
13734
13735 @lisp
13736 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13737 :user "user-name"
13738 :password "secret")
13739 @end lisp
13740 @end table
13741
13742 @table @dfn
13743 @item Common Keywords
13744 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13745
13746 Keywords:
13747
13748 @table @code
13749 @item :plugged
13750 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13751 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13752 example:
13753
13754 @lisp
13755 (setq mail-sources
13756 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13757 :suffix ""
13758 :plugged t)))
13759 @end lisp
13760
13761 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13762 useful when you use local mail and news.
13763
13764 @end table
13765 @end table
13766
13767 @subsubsection Function Interface
13768
13769 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13770 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13771 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13772 consider the following mail-source setting:
13773
13774 @lisp
13775 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13776 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13777 @end lisp
13778
13779 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13780 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13781 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13782 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13783 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13784
13785 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13786
13787
13788 @node Mail Source Customization
13789 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13790
13791 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13792 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13793 variables.
13794
13795 @table @code
13796 @item mail-source-crash-box
13797 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13798 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13799 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13800
13801 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13802 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13803 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13804 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13805 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13806 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13807 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13808 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13809
13810 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13811 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13812 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13813 files. This variable only applies when
13814 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13815
13816 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13817 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13818 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13819
13820 @item mail-source-directory
13821 @vindex mail-source-directory
13822 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13823 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13824 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13825 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13826
13827 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13828 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13829 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13830 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13831 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13832 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
13833
13834 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13835 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13836 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13837
13838 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13839 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13840 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13841 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13842
13843 @end table
13844
13845
13846 @node Fetching Mail
13847 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13848
13849 @vindex mail-sources
13850 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13851 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13852 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13853 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13854
13855 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13856 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13857 themselves.
13858
13859 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13860 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13861
13862 @lisp
13863 (setq mail-sources
13864 '((file)
13865 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13866 :password "secret")))
13867 @end lisp
13868
13869 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13870
13871 @lisp
13872 (setq mail-sources
13873 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13874 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13875 :user "user-name"
13876 :port "pop3"
13877 :password "secret")))
13878 @end lisp
13879
13880
13881 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13882 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13883 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13884 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13885 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13886 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13887
13888
13889
13890 @node Mail Back End Variables
13891 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13892
13893 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13894 mail back ends.
13895
13896 @table @code
13897 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13898 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13899 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13900 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13901
13902 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13903 @item nnmail-split-hook
13904 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13905 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13906 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13907 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13908 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13909 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13910 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13911 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13912 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13913 to this hook.
13914
13915 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13916 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13917 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13918 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13919 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13920 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13921 starting to handle the new mail) and
13922 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13923 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13924 default file modes the new mail files get:
13925
13926 @lisp
13927 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13928 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13929
13930 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13931 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13932 @end lisp
13933
13934 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13935 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13936 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13937 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13938 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13939 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13940 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13941
13942 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13943 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13944 @findex delete-file
13945 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13946
13947 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13948 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13949 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13950 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13951 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13952
13953 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13954 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13955 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13956 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13957 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13958
13959 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13960 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13961 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13962
13963 @end table
13964
13965
13966 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13967 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13968 @cindex mail splitting
13969 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13970
13971 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13972 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13973 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13974 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13975 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13976 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13977
13978 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13979
13980 @lisp
13981 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13982 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13983 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13984 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13985 "mail.misc"))
13986 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13987 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13988 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13989 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13990 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13991 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13992 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13993 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13994 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13995 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13996 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13997 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
13998 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13999 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14000 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14001 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14002 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14003 "misc.misc")
14004 @end lisp
14005
14006 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14007 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14008 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14009
14010 @table @code
14011
14012 @item group
14013 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14014 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14015
14016 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
14017 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
14018 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
14019 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
14020 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
14021 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
14022 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
14023
14024 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14025 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14026 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14027 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14028 stored in one or more groups.
14029
14030 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14031 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14032 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14033
14034 @item junk
14035 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14036 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14037
14038 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14039 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14040 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14041 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14042
14043 @cindex body split
14044 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14045 body of the messages:
14046
14047 @lisp
14048 (defun split-on-body ()
14049 (save-excursion
14050 (save-restriction
14051 (widen)
14052 (goto-char (point-min))
14053 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14054 "string.group"))))
14055 @end lisp
14056
14057 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14058 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14059 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14060 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14061 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14062 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14063 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14064
14065 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14066 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14067 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14068 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14069 should return a split.
14070
14071 @item nil
14072 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14073
14074 @end table
14075
14076 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14077 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14078 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14079 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14080 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14081
14082 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14083 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14084 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14085 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14086 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14087 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14088 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14089
14090 @table @code
14091 @item from
14092 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14093 @item to
14094 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14095 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14096 @item any
14097 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14098 @end table
14099
14100 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14101 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14102 when all this splitting is performed.
14103
14104 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14105 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14106 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14107
14108 @example
14109 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14110 @end example
14111
14112 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14113 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14114
14115 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14116 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14117 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14118 groupings 1 through 9.
14119
14120 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14121 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14122 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14123 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14124 groups when users send to an address using different case
14125 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14126 is @code{t}.
14127
14128 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14129 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14130 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14131
14132 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14133 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14134 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14135 surrounded by anything.
14136
14137 @example
14138 (any "joe" "joemail")
14139 @end example
14140
14141 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14142 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14143 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to t, however, the
14144 match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word boundary is
14145 removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14146
14147 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14148 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14149 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14150 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14151 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14152 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14153 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14154 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14155 it once per thread.
14156
14157 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14158 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14159 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14160 using the colon feature, like so:
14161 @lisp
14162 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14163 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14164 nnmail-split-fancy
14165 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14166 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14167 ))
14168 @end lisp
14169
14170 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14171 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14172 in the file specified by the variable
14173 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14174 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14175 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14176 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14177 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14178 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14179 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14180 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14181 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14182 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14183 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14184 300 kBytes in size.)
14185 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14186 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14187 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14188 messages goes into the new group.
14189
14190 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14191 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14192 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14193 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14194 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14195 ``outgoing'' group.
14196
14197
14198 @node Group Mail Splitting
14199 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14200 @cindex mail splitting
14201 @cindex group mail splitting
14202
14203 @findex gnus-group-split
14204 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14205 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14206 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14207 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14208 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14209 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14210 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14211 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14212
14213 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14214 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14215 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14216 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14217
14218 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14219 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14220 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14221 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14222 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14223 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14224 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14225
14226 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14227 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14228 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14229 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14230 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14231 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14232 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14233
14234 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14235 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14236 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14237 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14238 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14239 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14240 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14241 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14242 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14243 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14244 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14245 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14246 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14247
14248 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14249 been defined:
14250
14251 @example
14252 nnml:mail.bar:
14253 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14254 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14255 nnml:mail.foo:
14256 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14257 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14258 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14259 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14260 nnml:mail.others:
14261 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14262 @end example
14263
14264 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14265 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14266 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14267
14268 @lisp
14269 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14270 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14271 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14272 "mail.others")
14273 @end lisp
14274
14275 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14276 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14277 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14278 splits like this:
14279
14280 @lisp
14281 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14282 @end lisp
14283
14284 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14285 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14286 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14287 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14288 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14289 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14290 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14291 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14292 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14293
14294 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14295 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14296 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14297 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14298 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14299 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14300 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14301 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14302 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14303
14304 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14305 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14306 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14307 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14308 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14309 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14310
14311 @lisp
14312 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14313 @end lisp
14314
14315 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14316 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14317 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14318 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14319 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14320 value.
14321
14322 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14323 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14324 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14325 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14326
14327 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14328 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14329 @cindex incorporating old mail
14330 @cindex import old mail
14331
14332 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14333 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14334 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14335 your mail groups.
14336
14337 Doing so can be quite easy.
14338
14339 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14340 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14341 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14342 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14343 your @code{nnml} groups.
14344
14345 Here's how:
14346
14347 @enumerate
14348 @item
14349 Go to the group buffer.
14350
14351 @item
14352 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14353 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14354
14355 @item
14356 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14357
14358 @item
14359 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14360 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14361
14362 @item
14363 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14364 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14365 @end enumerate
14366
14367 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14368 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14369 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14370 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14371 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14372
14373 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14374 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14375 using the new mail back end.
14376
14377
14378 @node Expiring Mail
14379 @subsection Expiring Mail
14380 @cindex article expiry
14381
14382 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14383 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14384 different approach to mail reading.
14385
14386 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14387 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14388 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14389 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14390 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14391 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14392 course.
14393
14394 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14395 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14396 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14397 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14398 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14399 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14400 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14401 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14402 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14403
14404 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14405 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14406 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14407 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14408 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14409 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14410 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14411 expirable.
14412
14413 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14414 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14415 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14416 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14417 into its own group.)
14418
14419 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14420 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14421 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14422 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14423 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14424 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14425 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14426 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14427 scoring.
14428
14429 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14430 Groups that match the regular expression
14431 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14432 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14433 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14434
14435 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14436 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14437 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14438 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14439 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14440
14441 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14442 @lisp
14443 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14444 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14445 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14446 @end lisp
14447
14448 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14449 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14450 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14451 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14452 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14453
14454 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14455 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14456
14457 @lisp
14458 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14459 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14460 @end lisp
14461
14462 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14463 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14464
14465 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14466 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14467 don't really mix very well.
14468
14469 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14470 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14471 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14472 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14473 days.
14474
14475 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14476 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14477 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14478 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14479 everywhere else:
14480
14481 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14482 @lisp
14483 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14484 (lambda (group)
14485 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14486 31)
14487 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14488 1)
14489 ((string= group "important")
14490 'never)
14491 (t
14492 6))))
14493 @end lisp
14494
14495 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14496 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14497
14498 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14499 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14500 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14501 @code{never}.
14502
14503 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14504 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14505
14506 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14507 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14508 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14509 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14510 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14511 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14512 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14513 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14514 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14515 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14516 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14517 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14518 name or @code{delete}.
14519
14520 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14521 @lisp
14522 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14523 @end lisp
14524
14525 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14526 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14527 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14528 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14529 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14530
14531 @lisp
14532 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14533 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14534 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14535 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14536 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14537 @end lisp
14538
14539 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14540 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14541 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14542 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14543 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14544 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14545
14546 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14547 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14548 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14549 easier for procmail users.
14550
14551 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14552 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14553 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14554 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14555 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14556 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14557 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14558 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14559 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14560 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14561 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14562 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14563 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14564 with! So there!
14565
14566 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14567
14568 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14569 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14570 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14571 auto-expire turned on.
14572
14573
14574 @node Washing Mail
14575 @subsection Washing Mail
14576 @cindex mail washing
14577 @cindex list server brain damage
14578 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14579
14580 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14581 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14582 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14583 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14584 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14585 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14586
14587 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14588 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14589 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14590 laugh.
14591
14592 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14593 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14594 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14595 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14596
14597 @table @code
14598 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14599 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14600 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14601 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14602 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14603
14604 @table @code
14605 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14606 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14607 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14608 Emacs running on MS machines.
14609
14610 @end table
14611
14612 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14613 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14614 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14615 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14616
14617 @table @code
14618 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14619 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14620 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14621 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14622
14623 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14624 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14625 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14626 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14627 into a feature by documenting it.)
14628
14629 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14630 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14631 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14632 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14633 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14634 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14635 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14636 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14637
14638 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14639 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14640
14641 @lisp
14642 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14643 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14644 @end lisp
14645
14646 This can also be done non-destructively with
14647 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14648
14649 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14650 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14651 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14652
14653 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14654 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14655 @cindex Eudora
14656 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14657 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14658 @code{References} headers.
14659
14660 @end table
14661
14662 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14663 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14664 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14665 include:
14666
14667 @table @code
14668 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14669 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14670 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14671
14672 @end table
14673 @end table
14674
14675
14676 @node Duplicates
14677 @subsection Duplicates
14678
14679 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14680 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14681 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14682 @cindex duplicate mails
14683 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14684 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14685 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14686 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14687 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14688 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14689 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14690 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14691 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14692 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14693 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14694 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14695 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14696
14697 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14698 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14699 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14700 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14701
14702 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14703 @code{nil}.
14704
14705 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14706 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14707 methods:
14708
14709 @lisp
14710 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14711 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14712 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14713 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14714 (any mail "mail.misc")
14715 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14716 [...] ))
14717 @end lisp
14718 @noindent
14719 Or something like:
14720 @lisp
14721 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14722 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14723 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14724 [...]))
14725 @end lisp
14726
14727 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14728 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14729 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14730 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14731 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14732
14733
14734 @node Not Reading Mail
14735 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14736
14737 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14738 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14739 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14740
14741 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14742 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14743 mail, which should help.
14744
14745 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14746 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14747 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14748 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14749 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14750 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14751 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14752 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14753 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14754 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14755 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14756
14757 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14758 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14759 incoming mail.
14760
14761
14762 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14763 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14764
14765 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14766 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14767 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14768
14769 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14770 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14771 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14772 Spool}).
14773
14774 @menu
14775 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14776 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14777 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14778 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14779 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14780 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14781 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14782 @end menu
14783
14784
14785 @node Unix Mail Box
14786 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14787 @cindex nnmbox
14788 @cindex unix mail box
14789
14790 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14791 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14792 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14793 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14794 which group it belongs in.
14795
14796 Virtual server settings:
14797
14798 @table @code
14799 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14800 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14801 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14802 @file{~/mbox}.
14803
14804 @item nnmbox-active-file
14805 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14806 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14807 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14808
14809 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14810 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14811 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14812 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14813 @end table
14814
14815
14816 @node Rmail Babyl
14817 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14818 @cindex nnbabyl
14819 @cindex Rmail mbox
14820
14821 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14822 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14823 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14824 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14825 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14826
14827 Virtual server settings:
14828
14829 @table @code
14830 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14831 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14832 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14833
14834 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14835 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14836 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14837 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14838
14839 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14840 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14841 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14842 @code{t}
14843 @end table
14844
14845
14846 @node Mail Spool
14847 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14848 @cindex nnml
14849 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14850
14851 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14852 format. It should be used with some caution.
14853
14854 @vindex nnml-directory
14855 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14856 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14857 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14858 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14859
14860 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14861 care of all that.
14862
14863 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14864 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14865 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14866 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14867 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14868 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14869 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14870 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14871
14872 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14873 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14874 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14875 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14876
14877 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14878 @cindex marks
14879 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14880 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14881 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14882 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14883 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14884 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14885 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14886 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14887 directory).
14888
14889 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14890 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14891 them next time it starts.
14892
14893 Virtual server settings:
14894
14895 @table @code
14896 @item nnml-directory
14897 @vindex nnml-directory
14898 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14899 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14900 is @file{~/Mail}).
14901
14902 @item nnml-active-file
14903 @vindex nnml-active-file
14904 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14905 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14906
14907 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14908 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14909 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14910 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14911
14912 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14913 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14914 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14915 @code{t}.
14916
14917 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14918 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14919 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14920 default is @code{nil}.
14921
14922 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14923 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14924 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14925
14926 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14927 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14928 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14929
14930 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14931 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14932 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14933 default is @code{nil}.
14934
14935 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14936 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14937 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14938
14939 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14940 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14941 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14942 files.
14943
14944 @end table
14945
14946 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14947 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14948 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14949 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14950 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14951 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14952 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14953 Commands}).
14954
14955
14956 @node MH Spool
14957 @subsubsection MH Spool
14958 @cindex nnmh
14959 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14960
14961 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14962 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14963 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14964 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14965 for.
14966
14967 Virtual server settings:
14968
14969 @table @code
14970 @item nnmh-directory
14971 @vindex nnmh-directory
14972 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14973 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14974 @file{~/Mail})
14975
14976 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14977 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14978 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14979 @code{t}.
14980
14981 @item nnmh-be-safe
14982 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14983 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14984 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14985 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14986 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14987 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14988 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14989 @end table
14990
14991
14992 @node Maildir
14993 @subsubsection Maildir
14994 @cindex nnmaildir
14995 @cindex maildir
14996
14997 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
14998 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
14999 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15000 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15001 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15002 within a maildir.
15003
15004 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15005 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15006 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15007 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15008 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15009 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15010 that appear as group in Gnus.
15011
15012 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15013 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15014 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15015
15016 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15017 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15018 another, and you will keep your marks.
15019
15020 Virtual server settings:
15021
15022 @table @code
15023 @item directory
15024 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15025 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15026 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15027 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15028 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15029 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15030 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15031 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15032 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15033 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15034
15035 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15036 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15037 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15038 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15039 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15040 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15041 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15042 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15043 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15044 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15045 value.
15046
15047 @item target-prefix
15048 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15049 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15050 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15051 closed.
15052
15053 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15054 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15055 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15056 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15057 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15058 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15059 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15060 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15061 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15062
15063 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15064 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15065 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15066 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15067 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15068
15069 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15070 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15071 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15072 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15073 @code{force} argument.
15074
15075 @item directory-files
15076 This should be a function with the same interface as
15077 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15078 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15079 parameter is optional; the default is
15080 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15081 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15082 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15083 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15084 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15085 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15086
15087 @item get-new-mail
15088 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15089 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15090 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15091 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15092 value is @code{nil}.
15093
15094 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15095 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15096 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15097 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15098 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15099 @end table
15100
15101 @subsubsection Group parameters
15102
15103 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15104 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15105 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15106 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15107 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15108 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15109 another back end.
15110
15111 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15112 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15113 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15114 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15115 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15116 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15117 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15118 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15119 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15120
15121 @table @code
15122 @item expire-age
15123 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15124 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15125 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15126 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15127 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (overrideable by
15128 the @code{expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) group parameters. If you
15129 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15130 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15131 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15132 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15133 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15134 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15135
15136 @item expire-group
15137 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15138 @example
15139 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15140 @end example
15141 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15142 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15143 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15144 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15145 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15146 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15147 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15148 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15149 article. So that form can refer to
15150 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15151 article. @emph{If this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir} does
15152 not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15153 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15154
15155 @item read-only
15156 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15157 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15158 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15159 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15160 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15161 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15162 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15163 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15164 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15165 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15166 contain extra copies of the articles.
15167
15168 @item directory-files
15169 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15170 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15171 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15172 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15173
15174 @item distrust-Lines:
15175 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15176 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15177 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15178
15179 @item always-marks
15180 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15181 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15182 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15183 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15184 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15185 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15186
15187 @item never-marks
15188 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15189 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15190 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15191 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15192 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15193 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15194 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15195
15196 @item nov-cache-size
15197 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15198 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15199 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15200 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15201 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15202 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15203 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15204 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15205 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15206 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15207 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15208 @end table
15209
15210 @subsubsection Article identification
15211 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15212 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15213 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15214 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15215 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15216 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15217 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15218 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15219 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15220 request the article in the summary buffer.
15221
15222 @subsubsection NOV data
15223 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15224 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15225 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15226 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15227 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15228 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15229 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15230 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15231 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15232 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15233 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15234
15235 @subsubsection Article marks
15236 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15237 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15238 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15239 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15240 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15241 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15242 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15243 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15244
15245 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15246 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15247 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15248 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15249 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15250 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15251 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15252 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15253 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15254
15255
15256 @node Mail Folders
15257 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15258 @cindex nnfolder
15259 @cindex mbox folders
15260 @cindex mail folders
15261
15262 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15263 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15264 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15265 numbers and arrival dates.
15266
15267 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15268 @cindex marks
15269 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15270 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15271 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15272 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15273 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15274 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15275 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15276 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15277 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15278 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15279
15280 Virtual server settings:
15281
15282 @table @code
15283 @item nnfolder-directory
15284 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15285 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15286 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15287 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15288
15289 @item nnfolder-active-file
15290 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15291 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15292
15293 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15294 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15295 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15296 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15297
15298 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15299 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15300 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15301 default is @code{t}
15302
15303 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15304 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15305 @cindex backup files
15306 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15307 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15308 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15309 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15310
15311 @lisp
15312 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15313 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15314
15315 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15316 @end lisp
15317
15318 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15319 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15320 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15321 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15322 extract some information from it before removing it.
15323
15324 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15325 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15326 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15327 default is @code{nil}.
15328
15329 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15330 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15331 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15332
15333 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15334 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15335 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15336 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15337
15338 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15339 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15340 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15341 default is @code{nil}.
15342
15343 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15344 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15345 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15346
15347 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15348 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15349 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15350 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15351
15352 @end table
15353
15354
15355 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15356 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15357 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15358 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15359 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15360 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15361 though.
15362
15363 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15364 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15365
15366 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15367 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15368 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15369 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15370 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15371
15372 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15373 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15374 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15375 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15376 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15377 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15378 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15379 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15380 via NFS).
15381
15382 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15383 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15384 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15385 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15386
15387 @table @code
15388 @item nnmbox
15389
15390 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15391 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15392 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15393 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15394 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15395 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15396 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15397 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15398 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15399 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15400 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15401 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15402 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15403 what's where.
15404
15405 @item nnbabyl
15406
15407 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15408 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15409 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15410 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15411 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15412 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15413 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15414 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15415 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15416 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15417 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15418 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15419 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15420 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15421
15422 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15423 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15424 look at your mail.
15425
15426 @item nnml
15427
15428 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15429 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15430 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15431 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15432 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15433 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15434 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15435 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15436 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15437 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15438 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15439 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15440 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15441 provided by the active file and overviews.
15442
15443 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15444 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15445 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15446 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15447 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15448 wins big.
15449
15450 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15451 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15452 tiny files.
15453
15454 @item nnmh
15455
15456 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15457 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15458 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15459 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15460 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15461 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15462 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15463
15464 @item nnfolder
15465
15466 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15467 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15468 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15469 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15470 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15471 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15472 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15473 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15474 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15475
15476 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15477 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15478 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15479 friendly mail back end all over.
15480
15481 @item nnmaildir
15482
15483 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15484 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15485 mail back ends.
15486
15487 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15488 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15489 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15490 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15491 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15492 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15493 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15494 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15495 file system.
15496
15497 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15498 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15499 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15500 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15501 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15502 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15503 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15504 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15505 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15506 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15507 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15508
15509 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15510 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15511 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15512 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15513 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15514 @code{nnmaildir}.
15515
15516 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15517 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15518 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15519 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15520 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15521 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15522 removed in the future.
15523
15524 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15525 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15526 on your file system.
15527
15528 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15529 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15530
15531 @end table
15532
15533
15534 @node Browsing the Web
15535 @section Browsing the Web
15536 @cindex web
15537 @cindex browsing the web
15538 @cindex www
15539 @cindex http
15540
15541 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15542 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15543 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15544 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15545 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15546 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15547 even know what a news group is.
15548
15549 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15550 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15551 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15552 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15553 you mad in the end.
15554
15555 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15556 to do it instead?
15557
15558 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15559 interfaces to these sources.
15560
15561 @menu
15562 * Archiving Mail::
15563 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15564 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15565 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15566 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15567 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15568 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
15569 @end menu
15570
15571 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
15572
15573 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15574 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15575 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15576 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15577 though, you should be ok.
15578
15579 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15580 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15581 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15582 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15583 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15584
15585 @node Archiving Mail
15586 @subsection Archiving Mail
15587 @cindex archiving mail
15588 @cindex backup of mail
15589
15590 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15591 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15592 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15593 marks is fairly simple.
15594
15595 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15596 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15597 though.)
15598
15599 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15600 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15601 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15602 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15603 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15604 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15605 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15606 before you restore the data.
15607
15608 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15609 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15610 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15611 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15612 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15613 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15614 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15615 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15616 is unnecessary in that case.
15617
15618 @node Web Searches
15619 @subsection Web Searches
15620 @cindex nnweb
15621 @cindex Google
15622 @cindex dejanews
15623 @cindex gmane
15624 @cindex Usenet searches
15625 @cindex searching the Usenet
15626
15627 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15628 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15629 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15630 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15631 searches without having to use a browser.
15632
15633 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15634 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15635 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15636 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15637 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15638
15639 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15640 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15641 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15642 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15643 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15644 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15645 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15646 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15647 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15648 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15649 group as read.
15650
15651 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15652 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15653 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15654 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15655 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15656 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15657
15658 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
15659 to use @code{nnweb}.
15660
15661 Virtual server variables:
15662
15663 @table @code
15664 @item nnweb-type
15665 @vindex nnweb-type
15666 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15667 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15668 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15669
15670 @item nnweb-search
15671 @vindex nnweb-search
15672 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15673
15674 @item nnweb-max-hits
15675 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15676 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15677 999.
15678
15679 @item nnweb-type-definition
15680 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15681 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15682 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15683 present:
15684
15685 @table @code
15686 @item article
15687 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15688 understands.
15689
15690 @item map
15691 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15692
15693 @item search
15694 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15695
15696 @item address
15697 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15698 to.
15699
15700 @item id
15701 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15702 @end table
15703
15704 @end table
15705
15706
15707 @node Slashdot
15708 @subsection Slashdot
15709 @cindex Slashdot
15710 @cindex nnslashdot
15711
15712 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15713 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15714 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15715
15716 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15717 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15718
15719 @lisp
15720 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15721 '((nnslashdot "")))
15722 @end lisp
15723
15724 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15725 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15726 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15727 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15728 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15729 Methods}).
15730
15731 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15732 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15733
15734 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15735 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15736 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15737 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15738 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15739 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15740 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15741
15742 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15743
15744 @table @code
15745 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15746 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15747 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15748 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15749 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15750 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15751 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15752
15753 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15754 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15755 The login name to use when posting.
15756
15757 @item nnslashdot-password
15758 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15759 The password to use when posting.
15760
15761 @item nnslashdot-directory
15762 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15763 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15764 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15765
15766 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15767 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15768 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15769 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15770 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15771
15772 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15773 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15774 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15775
15776 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15777 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15778 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15779 article. The default is
15780 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15781
15782 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15783 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15784 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15785
15786 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15787 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15788 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15789 updated. The default is 0.
15790
15791 @end table
15792
15793
15794
15795 @node Ultimate
15796 @subsection Ultimate
15797 @cindex nnultimate
15798 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15799
15800 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15801 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15802 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15803 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15804
15805 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15806 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15807 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15808 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15809 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15810 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15811 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15812
15813 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15814
15815 @table @code
15816 @item nnultimate-directory
15817 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15818 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15819 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15820 @end table
15821
15822
15823 @node Web Archive
15824 @subsection Web Archive
15825 @cindex nnwarchive
15826 @cindex Web Archive
15827
15828 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15829 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15830 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15831 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15832 groups updated.
15833
15834 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15835 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15836 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15837 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15838 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15839 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15840 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15841 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15842
15843 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15844
15845 @table @code
15846 @item nnwarchive-directory
15847 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15848 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15849 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15850
15851 @item nnwarchive-login
15852 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15853 The account name on the web server.
15854
15855 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15856 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15857 The password for your account on the web server.
15858 @end table
15859
15860 @node RSS
15861 @subsection RSS
15862 @cindex nnrss
15863 @cindex RSS
15864
15865 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15866 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15867 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15868 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15869 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15870
15871 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15872 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15873
15874 @kindex G R (Summary)
15875 Use @kbd{G R} from the summary buffer to subscribe to a feed---you
15876 will be prompted for the location of the feed.
15877
15878 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15879 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET y}, then
15880 subscribe to groups.
15881
15882 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15883
15884 @table @code
15885 @item nnrss-directory
15886 @vindex nnrss-directory
15887 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15888 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15889
15890 @item nnrss-use-local
15891 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15892 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15893 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15894 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15895 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15896 download script using @command{wget}.
15897 @end table
15898
15899 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15900 the summary buffer.
15901
15902 @lisp
15903 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15904 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15905
15906 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15907 (let ((descr
15908 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15909 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15910 @end lisp
15911
15912 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15913 summary buffer.
15914 @lisp
15915 (require 'browse-url)
15916
15917 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15918 (interactive "p")
15919 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15920 (mail-header-extra
15921 (gnus-data-header
15922 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15923 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15924 (if url
15925 (progn
15926 (browse-url (cdr url))
15927 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15928 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15929
15930 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15931 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15932 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15933 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15934 @end lisp
15935
15936 @node Customizing w3
15937 @subsection Customizing w3
15938 @cindex w3
15939 @cindex html
15940 @cindex url
15941 @cindex Netscape
15942
15943 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
15944 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
15945 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
15946
15947 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
15948 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
15949 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
15950
15951 @lisp
15952 (eval-after-load "w3"
15953 '(progn
15954 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
15955 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
15956 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
15957 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
15958 (browse-url url)
15959 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
15960 @end lisp
15961
15962 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
15963 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
15964 follow the link.
15965
15966
15967 @node IMAP
15968 @section IMAP
15969 @cindex nnimap
15970 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
15971
15972 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
15973 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
15974 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
15975 specify the network address of the server.
15976
15977 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
15978 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
15979 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
15980 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
15981 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
15982 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
15983
15984 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
15985 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
15986 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
15987 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
15988
15989 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
15990 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
15991 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
15992 usage explained in this section.
15993
15994 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
15995 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
15996 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
15997 see below.)
15998
15999 @lisp
16000 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16001 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16002 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16003 (nnimap "dolk"
16004 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16005 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16006 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16007 (nnimap "barbar"
16008 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16009 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16010 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16011 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16012 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16013 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16014 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16015 (nnimap-stream network))
16016 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16017 (nnimap "vic20"
16018 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16019 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16020 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16021 @end lisp
16022
16023 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16024 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16025 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16026 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16027
16028 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16029 server:
16030
16031 @table @code
16032
16033 @item nnimap-address
16034 @vindex nnimap-address
16035
16036 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16037 server name if not specified.
16038
16039 @item nnimap-server-port
16040 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16041 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16042
16043 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16044
16045 @lisp
16046 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16047 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16048 @end lisp
16049
16050 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16051 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16052 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16053 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16054 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16055 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16056 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16057
16058 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16059 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16060 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16061 mailbox.
16062
16063 Example server specification:
16064
16065 @lisp
16066 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16067 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16068 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16069 @end lisp
16070
16071 @item nnimap-stream
16072 @vindex nnimap-stream
16073 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16074 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16075 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16076 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16077 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16078
16079 Example server specification:
16080
16081 @lisp
16082 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16083 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16084 @end lisp
16085
16086 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16087
16088 @itemize @bullet
16089 @item
16090 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16091 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16092 @item
16093 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16094 @item
16095 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16096 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16097 @samp{starttls}.
16098 @item
16099 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16100 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16101 @item
16102 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16103 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16104 @item
16105 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16106 @item
16107 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16108 @end itemize
16109
16110 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16111 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16112 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16113 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16114 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16115 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16116 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16117 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16118 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16119 program.
16120
16121 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16122 needed. It is available from
16123 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16124
16125 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16126 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16127 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16128 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16129 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16130 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16131 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16132 tried.
16133
16134 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16135 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16136 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16137 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16138 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16139 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16140 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16141 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16142
16143 @vindex imap-shell-program
16144 @vindex imap-shell-host
16145 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16146 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16147
16148 @item nnimap-authenticator
16149 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16150
16151 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16152 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16153
16154 Example server specification:
16155
16156 @lisp
16157 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16158 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16159 @end lisp
16160
16161 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16162
16163 @itemize @bullet
16164 @item
16165 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16166 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16167 @item
16168 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16169 @code{imtest}.
16170 @item
16171 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16172 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16173 @item
16174 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16175 @item
16176 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16177 @item
16178 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16179 @end itemize
16180
16181 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16182 @cindex expunging
16183 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16184 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16185 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16186 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16187 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16188 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16189 similar).
16190
16191 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16192 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16193 running in circles yet?
16194
16195 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16196 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16197 variable.
16198
16199 The possible options are:
16200
16201 @table @code
16202
16203 @item always
16204 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16205 closing a mailbox.
16206 @item never
16207 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16208 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16209 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16210 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16211 @item ask
16212 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16213 articles or not.
16214
16215 @end table
16216
16217 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16218 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16219
16220 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16221 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16222 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16223 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16224 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16225 has only one.)
16226
16227 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16228 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16229
16230 @lisp
16231 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16232 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16233 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16234 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16235 @end lisp
16236
16237 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16238 as ticked for other users.
16239
16240 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16241 @cindex expunging
16242 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16243
16244 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16245 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16246 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16247 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16248
16249 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16250 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16251 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16252 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16253
16254 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16255 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16256
16257 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16258 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16259 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16260 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16261
16262 @example
16263 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16264 @end example
16265
16266 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16267 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16268 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16269 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16270 @code{port imap}.
16271
16272 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16273 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16274
16275 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16276 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16277 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16278
16279 @end table
16280
16281 @menu
16282 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16283 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16284 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16285 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16286 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16287 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16288 @end menu
16289
16290
16291
16292 @node Splitting in IMAP
16293 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16294 @cindex splitting imap mail
16295
16296 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16297 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16298 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16299 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16300 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16301
16302 And it does.
16303
16304 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16305 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16306 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16307
16308 Here are the variables of interest:
16309
16310 @table @code
16311
16312 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16313 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16314 @cindex crosspost
16315 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16316
16317 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16318 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16319 found will be used.
16320
16321 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16322
16323 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16324 @cindex splitting, inbox
16325 @cindex inbox
16326 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16327
16328 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16329 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16330 splitting is disabled!
16331
16332 @lisp
16333 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16334 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16335 @end lisp
16336
16337 No nnmail equivalent.
16338
16339 @item nnimap-split-rule
16340 @cindex splitting, rules
16341 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16342
16343 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16344 this variable.
16345
16346 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16347 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16348 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16349 Neither did I, we need examples.
16350
16351 @lisp
16352 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16353 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16354 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16355 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16356 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16357 @end lisp
16358
16359 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16360 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16361 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16362
16363 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16364 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16365 instance:
16366
16367 @lisp
16368 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16369 @end lisp
16370
16371 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16372 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16373
16374 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16375 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16376 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16377 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16378
16379 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16380 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16381 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16382 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16383 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16384 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16385
16386 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16387 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16388 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16389
16390 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16391 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16392 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16393
16394 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16395
16396 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16397 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16398 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16399
16400 @lisp
16401 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16402 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16403 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16404 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16405 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16406 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16407 @end lisp
16408
16409 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16410 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16411 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16412 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16413 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16414 group/function elements.
16415
16416 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16417
16418 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16419 @cindex splitting
16420 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16421
16422 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16423 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16424
16425 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16426 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16427 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16428 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16429
16430 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16431 @cindex splitting, fancy
16432 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16433 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16434
16435 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16436 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16437 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16438
16439 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16440 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16441 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16442 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16443
16444 Example:
16445
16446 @lisp
16447 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16448 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16449 @end lisp
16450
16451 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16452
16453 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16454 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16455 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16456
16457 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16458 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16459 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16460 splitting function that analyses the body to split the article.
16461
16462 @end table
16463
16464 @node Expiring in IMAP
16465 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16466 @cindex expiring imap mail
16467
16468 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16469 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16470 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16471 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16472 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16473 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16474 process.
16475
16476 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16477 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16478 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16479 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16480 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16481 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16482 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16483 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16484
16485 @table @code
16486
16487 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16488 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16489
16490 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16491 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16492
16493 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16494
16495 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16496 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16497 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16498 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16499
16500 @end table
16501
16502 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16503 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16504 @cindex editing imap acls
16505 @cindex Access Control Lists
16506 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16507 @kindex G l (Group)
16508 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16509
16510 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16511 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16512 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16513 doesn't.
16514
16515 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16516 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16517 editing window with detailed instructions.
16518
16519 Some possible uses:
16520
16521 @itemize @bullet
16522 @item
16523 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16524 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16525 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16526 @item
16527 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16528 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16529 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16530 INBOX.mailbox).
16531 @end itemize
16532
16533 @node Expunging mailboxes
16534 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16535 @cindex expunging
16536
16537 @cindex expunge
16538 @cindex manual expunging
16539 @kindex G x (Group)
16540 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16541
16542 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16543 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16544 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16545
16546 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16547 delete them.
16548
16549 @node A note on namespaces
16550 @subsection A note on namespaces
16551 @cindex IMAP namespace
16552 @cindex namespaces
16553
16554 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16555 by the following text in the RFC:
16556
16557 @display
16558 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16559
16560 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16561 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16562 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16563 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16564
16565 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16566 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16567 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16568 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16569 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16570 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16571 @end display
16572
16573 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16574 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16575 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16576
16577 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16578 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16579 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16580 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16581 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16582 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16583 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16584 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16585 Gnus.
16586
16587 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16588 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16589 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16590
16591 @node Debugging IMAP
16592 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16593 @cindex IMAP debugging
16594 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16595
16596 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16597 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16598 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behaviour, chances
16599 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16600
16601 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16602 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16603 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16604 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16605 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16606 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16607 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16608
16609
16610 @vindex imap-log
16611 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16612 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16613 follows:
16614
16615 @lisp
16616 (setq imap-log t)
16617 @end lisp
16618
16619 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16620 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16621 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16622 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16623 data.
16624
16625 @node Other Sources
16626 @section Other Sources
16627
16628 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16629 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16630 newsgroups.
16631
16632 @menu
16633 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16634 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16635 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16636 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16637 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16638 @end menu
16639
16640
16641 @node Directory Groups
16642 @subsection Directory Groups
16643 @cindex nndir
16644 @cindex directory groups
16645
16646 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16647 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16648 names, of course.
16649
16650 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16651 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16652 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16653 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16654
16655 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16656 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16657 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16658 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16659 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16660
16661 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16662
16663 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16664 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16665 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16666 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16667
16668
16669 @node Anything Groups
16670 @subsection Anything Groups
16671 @cindex nneething
16672
16673 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16674 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16675 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16676 true.
16677
16678 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16679 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16680 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16681 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16682 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16683 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16684 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16685 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16686 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16687 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16688 elements.
16689
16690 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16691 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16692 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16693 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16694
16695 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16696 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16697 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16698 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16699
16700 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16701 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16702 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16703 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16704 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16705 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16706 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16707 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16708
16709 Some variables:
16710
16711 @table @code
16712 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16713 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16714 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16715 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16716
16717 @item nneething-exclude-files
16718 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16719 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16720 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16721
16722 @item nneething-include-files
16723 @vindex nneething-include-files
16724 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16725 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16726
16727 @item nneething-map-file
16728 @vindex nneething-map-file
16729 Name of the map files.
16730 @end table
16731
16732
16733 @node Document Groups
16734 @subsection Document Groups
16735 @cindex nndoc
16736 @cindex documentation group
16737 @cindex help group
16738
16739 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16740 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16741
16742 @table @code
16743 @cindex Babyl
16744 @cindex Rmail mbox
16745
16746 @item babyl
16747 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16748 @cindex mbox
16749 @cindex Unix mbox
16750
16751 @item mbox
16752 The standard Unix mbox file.
16753
16754 @cindex MMDF mail box
16755 @item mmdf
16756 The MMDF mail box format.
16757
16758 @item news
16759 Several news articles appended into a file.
16760
16761 @item rnews
16762 @cindex rnews batch files
16763 The rnews batch transport format.
16764 @cindex forwarded messages
16765
16766 @item forward
16767 Forwarded articles.
16768
16769 @item nsmail
16770 Netscape mail boxes.
16771
16772 @item mime-parts
16773 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16774
16775 @item standard-digest
16776 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16777
16778 @item mime-digest
16779 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16780
16781 @item lanl-gov-announce
16782 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16783
16784 @item rfc822-forward
16785 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16786
16787 @item outlook
16788 The Outlook mail box.
16789
16790 @item oe-dbx
16791 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16792
16793 @item exim-bounce
16794 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16795
16796 @item forward
16797 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16798
16799 @item rfc934
16800 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16801
16802 @item mailman
16803 A mailman digest.
16804
16805 @item clari-briefs
16806 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16807
16808 @item slack-digest
16809 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16810
16811 @item mail-in-mail
16812 The last resort.
16813 @end table
16814
16815 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16816 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16817 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16818 file is.
16819
16820 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16821 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16822 group. And that's it.
16823
16824 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16825 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16826 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16827 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16828 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16829 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16830 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16831 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16832 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16833 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16834
16835 Virtual server variables:
16836
16837 @table @code
16838 @item nndoc-article-type
16839 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16840 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16841 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16842 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16843 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16844 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16845
16846 @item nndoc-post-type
16847 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16848 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16849 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16850 and @code{news}.
16851 @end table
16852
16853 @menu
16854 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16855 @end menu
16856
16857
16858 @node Document Server Internals
16859 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16860
16861 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16862 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16863 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16864 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16865
16866 First, here's an example document type definition:
16867
16868 @example
16869 (mmdf
16870 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16871 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16872 @end example
16873
16874 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16875 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16876 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16877 types can be defined with very few settings:
16878
16879 @table @code
16880 @item first-article
16881 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16882 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16883 totally ignored.
16884
16885 @item article-begin
16886 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16887 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
16888
16889 @item head-begin-function
16890 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16891 the article.
16892
16893 @item nndoc-head-begin
16894 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16895 article.
16896
16897 @item nndoc-head-end
16898 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16899 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16900
16901 @item body-begin-function
16902 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16903 of the article.
16904
16905 @item body-begin
16906 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16907 to @samp{^\n}.
16908
16909 @item body-end-function
16910 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16911 the article.
16912
16913 @item body-end
16914 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
16915
16916 @item file-end
16917 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
16918 regexp will be totally ignored.
16919
16920 @end table
16921
16922 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
16923 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
16924 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
16925 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
16926 something that's palatable for Gnus:
16927
16928 @table @code
16929 @item prepare-body-function
16930 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
16931 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
16932 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
16933
16934 @item article-transform-function
16935 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
16936 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
16937 body of the article.
16938
16939 @item generate-head-function
16940 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
16941 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
16942 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
16943 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
16944
16945 @end table
16946
16947 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
16948 digests:
16949
16950 @example
16951 (standard-digest
16952 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16953 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16954 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
16955 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
16956 (head-end . "^ ?$")
16957 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
16958 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
16959 (subtype digest guess))
16960 @end example
16961
16962 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
16963 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
16964 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
16965 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
16966 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
16967
16968 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
16969 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
16970 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
16971 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
16972 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
16973 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
16974 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
16975 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
16976 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
16977 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
16978 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
16979 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
16980
16981
16982 @node SOUP
16983 @subsection SOUP
16984 @cindex SOUP
16985 @cindex offline
16986
16987 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
16988 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
16989 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
16990
16991 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
16992 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
16993 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
16994 newsreaders.
16995
16996 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
16997 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
16998 that interested in doing things properly.
16999
17000 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17001 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17002 fiddly.
17003
17004 First some terminology:
17005
17006 @table @dfn
17007
17008 @item server
17009 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17010 get news and/or mail from.
17011
17012 @item home machine
17013 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17014 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17015
17016 @item packet
17017 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17018 of packets:
17019
17020 @table @dfn
17021 @item message packets
17022 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17023 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17024 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17025
17026 @item response packets
17027 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17028 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17029 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17030
17031 @end table
17032
17033 @end table
17034
17035
17036 @enumerate
17037
17038 @item
17039 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17040 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17041 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17042 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17043
17044 @item
17045 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17046
17047 @item
17048 You put the packet in your home directory.
17049
17050 @item
17051 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17052 the native or secondary server.
17053
17054 @item
17055 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17056 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17057
17058 @item
17059 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17060 packet.
17061
17062 @item
17063 You transfer this packet to the server.
17064
17065 @item
17066 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17067
17068 @item
17069 You then repeat until you die.
17070
17071 @end enumerate
17072
17073 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17074 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17075
17076 @menu
17077 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17078 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17079 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17080 @end menu
17081
17082
17083 @node SOUP Commands
17084 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17085
17086 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17087
17088 @table @kbd
17089 @item G s b
17090 @kindex G s b (Group)
17091 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17092 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17093 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17094 process/prefix convention.
17095
17096 @item G s w
17097 @kindex G s w (Group)
17098 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17099 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17100
17101 @item G s s
17102 @kindex G s s (Group)
17103 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17104 Send all replies from the replies packet
17105 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17106
17107 @item G s p
17108 @kindex G s p (Group)
17109 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17110 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17111
17112 @item G s r
17113 @kindex G s r (Group)
17114 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17115 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17116
17117 @item O s
17118 @kindex O s (Summary)
17119 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17120 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17121 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17122 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17123
17124 @end table
17125
17126
17127 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17128 thingies:
17129
17130 @table @code
17131
17132 @item gnus-soup-directory
17133 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17134 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17135 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17136
17137 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17138 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17139 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17140 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17141
17142 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17143 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17144 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17145 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17146
17147 @item gnus-soup-packer
17148 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17149 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17150 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17151
17152 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17153 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17154 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17155 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17156
17157 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17158 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17159 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17160
17161 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17162 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17163 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17164 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17165
17166 @end table
17167
17168
17169 @node SOUP Groups
17170 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17171 @cindex nnsoup
17172
17173 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17174 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17175 you can read them at leisure.
17176
17177 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17178
17179 @table @code
17180
17181 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17182 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17183 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17184 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17185
17186 @item nnsoup-directory
17187 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17188 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17189 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17190
17191 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17192 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17193 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17194 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17195
17196 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17197 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17198 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17199 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17200 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17201
17202 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17203 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17204 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17205 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17206
17207 @item nnsoup-active-file
17208 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17209 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17210 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17211 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17212 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17213
17214 @item nnsoup-packer
17215 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17216 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17217 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17218
17219 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17220 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17221 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17222 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17223
17224 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17225 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17226 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17227 @file{~/}.
17228
17229 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17230 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17231 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17232 @samp{Soupout}.
17233
17234 @item nnsoup-always-save
17235 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17236 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17237
17238 @end table
17239
17240
17241 @node SOUP Replies
17242 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17243
17244 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17245 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17246 more for that to happen.
17247
17248 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17249 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17250 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17251 @sc{soup} system.
17252
17253 In specific, this is what it does:
17254
17255 @lisp
17256 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17257 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17258 @end lisp
17259
17260 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17261 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17262 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17263
17264
17265 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17266 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17267 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17268 @cindex gateways
17269
17270 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17271 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17272 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17273
17274 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17275 used to post with.
17276
17277 Server variables:
17278
17279 @table @code
17280 @item nngateway-address
17281 @vindex nngateway-address
17282 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17283
17284 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17285 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17286 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17287 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17288 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17289 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17290 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17291 gateway address.
17292
17293 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17294 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17295 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17296
17297 @example
17298 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17299 @end example
17300
17301 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17302
17303 @example
17304 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17305 @end example
17306
17307 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17308
17309 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17310 @table @code
17311
17312 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17313 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17314 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17315
17316 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17317
17318 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17319 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17320 @code{nngateway-address}.
17321 @end table
17322
17323 @end table
17324
17325 Here's an example:
17326
17327 @lisp
17328 (setq gnus-post-method
17329 '(nngateway
17330 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17331 (nngateway-header-transformation
17332 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17333 @end lisp
17334
17335 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17336
17337 @lisp
17338 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17339 @end lisp
17340
17341
17342
17343 @node Combined Groups
17344 @section Combined Groups
17345
17346 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17347 groups.
17348
17349 @menu
17350 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17351 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17352 @end menu
17353
17354
17355 @node Virtual Groups
17356 @subsection Virtual Groups
17357 @cindex nnvirtual
17358 @cindex virtual groups
17359 @cindex merging groups
17360
17361 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17362 other groups.
17363
17364 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17365 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17366 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17367
17368 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17369 regexp to match component groups.
17370
17371 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17372 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17373 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17374 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17375 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17376 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17377 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17378 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17379
17380 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17381 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17382
17383 @lisp
17384 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17385 @end lisp
17386
17387 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17388 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17389
17390 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17391 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17392 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17393 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17394
17395 @example
17396 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17397 @end example
17398
17399 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17400 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17401 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17402
17403 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17404 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17405 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17406 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17407 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17408
17409 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17410 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17411 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17412
17413 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17414 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17415 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17416 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17417 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17418 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17419 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17420 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17421 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17422 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17423 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17424
17425 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17426 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17427 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17428 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17429 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17430 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17431 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17432
17433 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17434 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17435
17436 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17437 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17438 inherited.
17439
17440
17441 @node Kibozed Groups
17442 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17443 @cindex nnkiboze
17444 @cindex kibozing
17445
17446 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17447 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17448 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17449 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17450
17451 @kindex G k (Group)
17452 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17453 buffer.
17454
17455 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17456 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17457 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17458 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17459
17460 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17461 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17462 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17463
17464 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17465 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17466 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17467 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17468 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17469 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17470 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17471 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17472
17473 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17474 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17475 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17476 Stranger things have happened.
17477
17478 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17479 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17480
17481 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17482 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17483 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17484 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17485 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17486 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17487 component articles.
17488
17489 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17490 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17491
17492
17493 @node Gnus Unplugged
17494 @section Gnus Unplugged
17495 @cindex offline
17496 @cindex unplugged
17497 @cindex agent
17498 @cindex Gnus agent
17499 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17500
17501 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17502 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17503 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17504 read news. Believe it or not.
17505
17506 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17507 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17508 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17509 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17510 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17511
17512 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17513 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17514 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17515 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17516 reading news on a machine.
17517
17518 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17519 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17520
17521 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17522
17523 @menu
17524 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17525 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17526 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17527 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17528 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17529 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17530 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17531 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17532 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17533 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17534 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17535 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17536 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17537 @end menu
17538
17539
17540 @node Agent Basics
17541 @subsection Agent Basics
17542
17543 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17544
17545 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17546 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17547 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17548 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17549
17550 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17551 connected to the net continuously.
17552
17553 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17554 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17555
17556 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17557 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17558 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17559 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17560 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17561
17562 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17563 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17564 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17565 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17566 they're kinda like plugged always).
17567
17568 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17569 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17570 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17571 the culprit.
17572
17573 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17574 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17575 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17576 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17577 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17578
17579 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17580
17581 @itemize @bullet
17582
17583 @item
17584 @findex gnus-unplugged
17585 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17586 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17587 already fetched while in this mode.
17588
17589 @item
17590 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17591 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17592 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17593 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17594 Source Specifiers}).
17595
17596 @item
17597 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17598 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17599 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17600 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17601 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17602
17603 @item
17604 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17605 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17606 then you read the news offline.
17607
17608 @item
17609 And then you go to step 2.
17610 @end itemize
17611
17612 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17613 the Agent.
17614
17615 @itemize @bullet
17616
17617 @item
17618 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17619 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17620 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17621 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17622 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17623 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17624 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17625 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17626
17627 @item
17628 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17629 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17630 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17631 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17632
17633 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17634 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17635 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17636 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17637 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17638 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17639 configure them.
17640
17641 @item
17642 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17643 @end itemize
17644
17645
17646 @node Agent Categories
17647 @subsection Agent Categories
17648
17649 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17650 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17651 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17652 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17653 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17654 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17655 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17656
17657 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17658 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17659 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17660 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17661 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17662
17663 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17664 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17665 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17666 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17667 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17668 sink.
17669
17670 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17671 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17672 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17673 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17674 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17675 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17676 your settings.
17677
17678 @menu
17679 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17680 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17681 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17682 @end menu
17683
17684
17685 @node Category Syntax
17686 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17687
17688 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17689 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17690 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17691 listed below.
17692
17693 @cindex Agent Parameters
17694 @table @code
17695 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17696 The name of the category.
17697
17698 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17699 The list of groups that are in this category.
17700
17701 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17702 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17703 are eligible for downloading; and
17704
17705 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17706 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17707 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17708 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17709
17710 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17711 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17712 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17713 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17714 only groups that should not be expired.
17715
17716 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17717 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17718 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17719
17720 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17721 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17722
17723 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17724 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17725
17726 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17727 an integer that overrides the value of
17728 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17729
17730 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17731 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17732
17733 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17734 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17735 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17736 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17737 @c all other symbols disable them.
17738
17739 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17740 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17741 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17742 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17743 all other symbols enable them.
17744 @end table
17745
17746 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17747 created.
17748
17749 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17750 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17751 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17752 category.
17753
17754 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17755 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17756 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17757 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17758
17759 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17760 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17761 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17762
17763 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17764 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17765 operators sprinkled in between.
17766
17767 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17768
17769 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17770 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17771
17772 @lisp
17773 short
17774 @end lisp
17775
17776 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17777 short (for some value of ``short'').
17778
17779 Here's a more complex predicate:
17780
17781 @lisp
17782 (or high
17783 (and
17784 (not low)
17785 (not long)))
17786 @end lisp
17787
17788 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17789 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17790 drift.
17791
17792 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17793 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17794 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17795
17796 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17797 you want to do, you can write your own.
17798
17799 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17800 bound to the value determined by calling
17801 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17802 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17803 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17804 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17805 predicate to individual groups.
17806
17807 @table @code
17808 @item short
17809 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17810 lines; default 100.
17811
17812 @item long
17813 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17814 lines; default 200.
17815
17816 @item low
17817 True iff the article has a download score less than
17818 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17819
17820 @item high
17821 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17822 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17823
17824 @item spam
17825 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17826 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17827 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17828
17829 @item true
17830 Always true.
17831
17832 @item false
17833 Always false.
17834 @end table
17835
17836 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17837 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17838 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17839 useful values.
17840
17841 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17842 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17843 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17844 something along the lines of the following:
17845
17846 @lisp
17847 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17848 "Say whether an article is old."
17849 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17850 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17851 @end lisp
17852
17853 with the predicate then defined as:
17854
17855 @lisp
17856 (not my-article-old-p)
17857 @end lisp
17858
17859 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17860 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17861 wherever.
17862
17863 @lisp
17864 (require 'gnus-agent)
17865 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17866 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17867 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17868 @end lisp
17869
17870 and simply specify your predicate as:
17871
17872 @lisp
17873 (not old)
17874 @end lisp
17875
17876 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17877 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17878 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17879 just don't give a damn.
17880
17881 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17882 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17883 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17884 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17885 parameters like so:
17886
17887 @lisp
17888 (agent-predicate . short)
17889 @end lisp
17890
17891 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17892 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17893 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17894
17895 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17896
17897 @lisp
17898 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17899 @end lisp
17900
17901 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17902 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
17903 predicate is assumed to be a list.
17904
17905
17906 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
17907 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
17908 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
17909 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
17910 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
17911 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
17912
17913 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
17914 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
17915 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
17916 if it's to be specific to that group.
17917
17918 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
17919 three forms:
17920
17921 @enumerate
17922 @item
17923 Score rule
17924
17925 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
17926 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
17927
17928 example:
17929
17930 @itemize @bullet
17931 @item
17932 Category specification
17933
17934 @lisp
17935 (("from"
17936 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17937 ("lines"
17938 (500 -100 nil <)))
17939 @end lisp
17940
17941 @item
17942 Group/Topic Parameter specification
17943
17944 @lisp
17945 (agent-score ("from"
17946 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17947 ("lines"
17948 (500 -100 nil <)))
17949 @end lisp
17950
17951 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
17952 @end itemize
17953
17954 @item
17955 Agent score file
17956
17957 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
17958 keywords stated above.
17959
17960 example:
17961
17962 @itemize @bullet
17963 @item
17964 Category specification
17965
17966 @lisp
17967 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
17968 @end lisp
17969
17970 or perhaps
17971
17972 @lisp
17973 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
17974 @end lisp
17975
17976 @item
17977 Group Parameter specification
17978
17979 @lisp
17980 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
17981 @end lisp
17982
17983 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
17984 about parenthesis?
17985 @end itemize
17986
17987 @item
17988 Use @code{normal} score files
17989
17990 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
17991 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
17992 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
17993 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
17994
17995 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
17996 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
17997 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
17998 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
17999
18000 @itemize @bullet
18001 @item
18002 Category Specification
18003
18004 @lisp
18005 file
18006 @end lisp
18007
18008 @item
18009 Group Parameter specification
18010
18011 @lisp
18012 (agent-score . file)
18013 @end lisp
18014 @end itemize
18015 @end enumerate
18016
18017 @node Category Buffer
18018 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18019
18020 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18021 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18022 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18023
18024 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18025
18026 @table @kbd
18027 @item q
18028 @kindex q (Category)
18029 @findex gnus-category-exit
18030 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18031
18032 @item e
18033 @kindex e (Category)
18034 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18035 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18036 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18037
18038 @item k
18039 @kindex k (Category)
18040 @findex gnus-category-kill
18041 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18042
18043 @item c
18044 @kindex c (Category)
18045 @findex gnus-category-copy
18046 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18047
18048 @item a
18049 @kindex a (Category)
18050 @findex gnus-category-add
18051 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18052
18053 @item p
18054 @kindex p (Category)
18055 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18056 Edit the predicate of the current category
18057 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18058
18059 @item g
18060 @kindex g (Category)
18061 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18062 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18063 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18064
18065 @item s
18066 @kindex s (Category)
18067 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18068 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18069 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18070
18071 @item l
18072 @kindex l (Category)
18073 @findex gnus-category-list
18074 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18075 @end table
18076
18077
18078 @node Category Variables
18079 @subsubsection Category Variables
18080
18081 @table @code
18082 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18083 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18084 Hook run in category buffers.
18085
18086 @item gnus-category-line-format
18087 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18088 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18089 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18090
18091 @table @samp
18092 @item c
18093 The name of the category.
18094
18095 @item g
18096 The number of groups in the category.
18097 @end table
18098
18099 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18100 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18101 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18102
18103 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18104 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18105 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18106
18107 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18108 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18109 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18110
18111 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18112 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18113 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18114 0.
18115
18116 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18117 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18118 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18119 0.
18120
18121 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18122 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18123 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18124 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18125 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18126 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18127 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18128 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18129 read.
18130 Default 7.
18131
18132 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18133 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18134 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18135 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18136 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18137 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18138 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18139
18140 @end table
18141
18142
18143 @node Agent Commands
18144 @subsection Agent Commands
18145 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18146 @kindex J j (Agent)
18147
18148 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18149 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18150 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18151
18152
18153 @menu
18154 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18155 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18156 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18157 @end menu
18158
18159
18160
18161
18162 @node Group Agent Commands
18163 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18164
18165 @table @kbd
18166 @item J u
18167 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18168 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18169 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18170 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18171
18172 @item J c
18173 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18174 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18175 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18176
18177 @item J s
18178 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18179 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18180 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18181 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18182
18183 @item J S
18184 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18185 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18186 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18187 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18188
18189 @item J a
18190 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18191 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18192 Add the current group to an Agent category
18193 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18194 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18195
18196 @item J r
18197 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18198 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18199 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18200 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18201 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18202
18203 @item J Y
18204 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18205 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18206 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18207
18208
18209 @end table
18210
18211
18212 @node Summary Agent Commands
18213 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18214
18215 @table @kbd
18216 @item J #
18217 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18218 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18219 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18220
18221 @item J M-#
18222 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18223 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18224 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18225 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18226
18227 @cindex %
18228 @item @@
18229 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18230 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18231 Toggle whether to download the article
18232 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18233 default.
18234
18235 @item J c
18236 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18237 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18238 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18239
18240 @item J S
18241 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18242 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18243 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18244 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18245
18246 @item J s
18247 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18248 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18249 Download all processable articles in this group.
18250 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18251
18252 @item J u
18253 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18254 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18255 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18256 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18257
18258 @end table
18259
18260
18261 @node Server Agent Commands
18262 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18263
18264 @table @kbd
18265 @item J a
18266 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18267 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18268 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18269 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18270
18271 @item J r
18272 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18273 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18274 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18275 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18276
18277 @end table
18278
18279
18280 @node Agent Visuals
18281 @subsection Agent Visuals
18282
18283 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18284 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18285 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18286 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18287 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18288 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18289 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18290 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18291 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18292 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18293
18294 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18295 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18296 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18297 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18298 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18299 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18300 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18301 articles will be available when unplugged.
18302
18303 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18304 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18305 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18306 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18307 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18308 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18309 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18310 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18311
18312 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18313 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18314 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18315 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18316 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18317 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18318 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18319 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18320 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18321
18322 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18323 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18324 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18325 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18326 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18327
18328 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18329 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18330 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18331 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18332 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18333 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18334 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18335 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second, if
18336 you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18337 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to t. This
18338 parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an Agent
18339 Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18340 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18341
18342 @node Agent as Cache
18343 @subsection Agent as Cache
18344
18345 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18346 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18347 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18348 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18349 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18350 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18351 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18352 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18353 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18354
18355 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18356 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18357 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18358 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18359 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18360
18361 @node Agent Expiry
18362 @subsection Agent Expiry
18363
18364 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18365 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18366 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18367 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18368 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18369 @cindex agent expiry
18370 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18371 @cindex expiry
18372
18373 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18374 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18375 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18376 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18377 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18378 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18379 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18380 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18381
18382 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18383 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18384 synchronized with the group.
18385
18386 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18387 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18388
18389 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18390 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18391 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18392 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18393 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18394 be kept indefinitely.
18395
18396 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18397 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18398 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18399 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18400
18401 @node Agent Regeneration
18402 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18403
18404 @cindex agent regeneration
18405 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18406 @cindex regeneration
18407
18408 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18409 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18410 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18411 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18412 internal inconsistencies.
18413
18414 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18415 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18416 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18417 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18418 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18419 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18420
18421 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18422 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18423 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18424 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18425 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18426 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18427
18428 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18429 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18430 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18431 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18432 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18433 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18434 agent as unread.
18435
18436 @node Agent and IMAP
18437 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18438
18439 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18440 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18441 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18442 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18443
18444 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18445 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18446 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18447 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18448
18449 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18450 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18451 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18452 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18453
18454 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18455 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18456 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18457 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18458 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18459 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18460
18461 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18462 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18463 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18464 in the group buffer.
18465
18466 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18467 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18468
18469 @itemize @bullet
18470
18471 @item
18472 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18473
18474 @item
18475 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18476
18477 @end itemize
18478
18479 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18480 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18481 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18482 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18483 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18484 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18485 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18486 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18487
18488
18489 @node Outgoing Messages
18490 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18491
18492 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18493 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18494 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18495
18496 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18497 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18498 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18499 messages in the draft group.
18500
18501
18502
18503 @node Agent Variables
18504 @subsection Agent Variables
18505
18506 @table @code
18507 @item gnus-agent-directory
18508 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18509 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18510 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18511
18512 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18513 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18514 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18515 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18516 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18517 by default.
18518
18519 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18520 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18521 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18522
18523 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18524 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18525 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18526
18527 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18528 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18529 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18530
18531 @item gnus-agent-cache
18532 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18533 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18534 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18535 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18536
18537 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18538 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18539 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18540 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18541 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18542 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18543 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18544 online status.
18545
18546 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18547 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18548 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18549 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18550 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18551 read. The default is t.
18552
18553 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18554 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18555 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18556 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18557 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18558 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18559 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18560 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18561 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18562 over and over again.
18563
18564 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18565 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18566 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18567 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18568 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18569 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18570 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18571 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18572 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18573 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18574 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18575 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18576 see any cycling.
18577
18578 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18579 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18580 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18581 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18582 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18583 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18584 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18585 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18586 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18587
18588 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18589 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18590 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18591 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18592 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18593 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18594
18595 The legal values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18596 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18597 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18598 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18599 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18600
18601 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18602 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18603 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18604 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18605 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18606 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18607 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18608 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18609 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18610 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18611 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18612
18613 @end table
18614
18615
18616 @node Example Setup
18617 @subsection Example Setup
18618
18619 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18620 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18621 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18622
18623 @lisp
18624 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18625 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18626 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18627
18628 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18629 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18630 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18631
18632 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18633 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18634
18635 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18636 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18637 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18638 @end lisp
18639
18640 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18641 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18642 gnus}.
18643
18644 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18645 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18646 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18647 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18648 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18649 once.
18650
18651 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18652 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18653 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18654 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18655 back all the killed groups.)
18656
18657 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18658 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18659 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18660
18661
18662 @node Batching Agents
18663 @subsection Batching Agents
18664 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18665
18666 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18667 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18668 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18669
18670 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18671 following incantation:
18672
18673 @example
18674 #!/bin/sh
18675 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18676 @end example
18677
18678
18679 @node Agent Caveats
18680 @subsection Agent Caveats
18681
18682 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18683 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18684 may ask:
18685
18686 @table @dfn
18687 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18688
18689 @strong{No}. If you want this behaviour, add
18690 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18691 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18692
18693 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18694 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18695
18696 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18697
18698 @end table
18699
18700 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18701 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18702 locally stored articles.
18703
18704
18705 @node Scoring
18706 @chapter Scoring
18707 @cindex scoring
18708
18709 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18710 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18711 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18712 attention!
18713
18714 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18715 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18716 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18717 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18718 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18719
18720 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18721 before generating the summary buffer.
18722
18723 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18724 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18725 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18726
18727 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18728 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18729 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18730 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18731
18732 @menu
18733 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18734 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18735 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18736 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18737 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18738 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18739 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18740 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18741 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18742 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18743 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18744 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18745 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18746 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18747 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18748 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18749 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18750 @end menu
18751
18752
18753 @node Summary Score Commands
18754 @section Summary Score Commands
18755 @cindex score commands
18756
18757 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18758 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18759 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18760 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18761 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18762
18763 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18764 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18765 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18766 score file the current one.
18767
18768 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18769
18770 @table @kbd
18771
18772 @item V s
18773 @kindex V s (Summary)
18774 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18775 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18776
18777 @item V S
18778 @kindex V S (Summary)
18779 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18780 Display the score of the current article
18781 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18782
18783 @item V t
18784 @kindex V t (Summary)
18785 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18786 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18787 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18788 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18789 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18790 score file and edit it.
18791
18792 @item V w
18793 @kindex V w (Summary)
18794 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18795 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18796
18797 @item V R
18798 @kindex V R (Summary)
18799 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18800 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18801 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18802 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18803 effect you're having.
18804
18805 @item V c
18806 @kindex V c (Summary)
18807 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18808 Make a different score file the current
18809 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18810
18811 @item V e
18812 @kindex V e (Summary)
18813 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18814 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18815 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18816 File Editing}).
18817
18818 @item V f
18819 @kindex V f (Summary)
18820 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18821 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18822 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18823
18824 @item V F
18825 @kindex V F (Summary)
18826 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18827 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18828 after editing score files.
18829
18830 @item V C
18831 @kindex V C (Summary)
18832 @findex gnus-score-customize
18833 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18834 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18835
18836 @end table
18837
18838 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18839
18840 @table @kbd
18841
18842 @item V m
18843 @kindex V m (Summary)
18844 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18845 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18846 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18847
18848 @item V x
18849 @kindex V x (Summary)
18850 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18851 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18852 expunge all articles below this score
18853 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18854 @end table
18855
18856 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18857 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18858 them.)
18859
18860 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18861 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18862
18863 @enumerate
18864 @item
18865 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18866 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18867 @item
18868 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18869 keys are available:
18870 @table @kbd
18871
18872 @item a
18873 Score on the author name.
18874
18875 @item s
18876 Score on the subject line.
18877
18878 @item x
18879 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18880
18881 @item r
18882 Score on the @code{References} line.
18883
18884 @item d
18885 Score on the date.
18886
18887 @item l
18888 Score on the number of lines.
18889
18890 @item i
18891 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18892
18893 @item e
18894 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18895 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18896
18897 @item f
18898 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18899 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18900 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18901
18902 @item b
18903 Score on the body.
18904
18905 @item h
18906 Score on the head.
18907
18908 @item t
18909 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
18910 files.)
18911
18912 @end table
18913
18914 @item
18915 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
18916 what headers you are scoring on.
18917
18918 @table @code
18919
18920 @item strings
18921
18922 @table @kbd
18923
18924 @item e
18925 Exact matching.
18926
18927 @item s
18928 Substring matching.
18929
18930 @item f
18931 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
18932
18933 @item r
18934 Regexp matching
18935 @end table
18936
18937 @item date
18938 @table @kbd
18939
18940 @item b
18941 Before date.
18942
18943 @item a
18944 After date.
18945
18946 @item n
18947 This date.
18948 @end table
18949
18950 @item number
18951 @table @kbd
18952
18953 @item <
18954 Less than number.
18955
18956 @item =
18957 Equal to number.
18958
18959 @item >
18960 Greater than number.
18961 @end table
18962 @end table
18963
18964 @item
18965 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
18966 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
18967 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
18968 file.
18969 @table @kbd
18970
18971 @item t
18972 Temporary score entry.
18973
18974 @item p
18975 Permanent score entry.
18976
18977 @item i
18978 Immediately scoring.
18979 @end table
18980
18981 @item
18982 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
18983 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
18984 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
18985
18986 @end enumerate
18987
18988 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
18989 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
18990 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
18991 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
18992
18993 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
18994 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
18995 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
18996 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
18997 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
18998
18999 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19000 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19001 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19002 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19003 current score file.
19004
19005 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19006 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19007 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19008
19009
19010 @node Group Score Commands
19011 @section Group Score Commands
19012 @cindex group score commands
19013
19014 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19015
19016 @table @kbd
19017
19018 @item W f
19019 @kindex W f (Group)
19020 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19021 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19022 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19023 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19024
19025 @end table
19026
19027 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19028
19029 @findex gnus-batch-score
19030 @cindex batch scoring
19031 @example
19032 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19033 @end example
19034
19035
19036 @node Score Variables
19037 @section Score Variables
19038 @cindex score variables
19039
19040 @table @code
19041
19042 @item gnus-use-scoring
19043 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19044 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19045 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19046
19047 @item gnus-kill-killed
19048 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19049 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19050 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19051 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19052 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19053 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19054 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19055
19056 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19057 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19058 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19059 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19060 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19061
19062 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19063 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19064 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19065 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19066
19067 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19068 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19069 @cindex score cache
19070 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19071 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19072 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19073 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19074 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19075 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19076 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19077 be cached.
19078
19079 @item gnus-save-score
19080 @vindex gnus-save-score
19081 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19082 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19083 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19084
19085 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19086 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19087 across group visits.
19088
19089 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19090 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19091 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19092 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19093 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19094 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19095 manually entered data.
19096
19097 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19098 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19099 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19100
19101 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19102 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19103 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19104 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19105 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19106 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19107
19108 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19109 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19110 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19111 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19112
19113 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19114 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19115 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19116 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19117
19118 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19119 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19120 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19121 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19122
19123 Predefined functions available are:
19124 @table @code
19125
19126 @item gnus-score-find-single
19127 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19128 Only apply the group's own score file.
19129
19130 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19131 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19132 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19133 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19134 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19135 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19136 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19137 then a regexp match is done.
19138
19139 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19140 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19141
19142 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19143 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19144 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19145 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19146
19147 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19148 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19149 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19150 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19151 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19152 server.
19153
19154 @end table
19155 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19156 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19157 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19158 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19159 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19160 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19161 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19162 Phu.
19163
19164 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19165 overall score file, you could use the value
19166 @example
19167 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19168 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19169 @end example
19170
19171 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19172 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19173 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19174 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19175 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19176
19177 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19178 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19179 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19180 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19181 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19182 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19183 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19184 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19185
19186 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19187 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19188 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19189
19190 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19191 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19192 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19193 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19194 threading---according to the current value of
19195 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19196 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19197 simplified in this manner.
19198
19199 @end table
19200
19201
19202 @node Score File Format
19203 @section Score File Format
19204 @cindex score file format
19205
19206 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19207 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19208 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19209
19210 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19211
19212 @lisp
19213 (("from"
19214 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19215 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19216 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19217 ("subject"
19218 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19219 ("xref"
19220 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19221 ("lines"
19222 (2 -100 nil <))
19223 (mark 0)
19224 (expunge -1000)
19225 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19226 (read-only nil)
19227 (orphan -10)
19228 (adapt t)
19229 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19230 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19231 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19232 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19233 (eval (ding)))
19234 @end lisp
19235
19236 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19237 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19238
19239 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19240 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19241 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19242
19243 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19244
19245 @table @code
19246
19247 @item STRING
19248 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19249 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19250 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19251 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19252 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19253 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19254 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19255 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19256 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19257 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19258 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19259 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19260 to articles that matches these score entries.
19261
19262 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19263 score entry has one to four elements.
19264 @enumerate
19265
19266 @item
19267 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19268 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19269 integer.
19270
19271 @item
19272 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19273 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19274 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19275 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19276 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19277 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19278
19279 @item
19280 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19281 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19282 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19283 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19284 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19285
19286 @item
19287 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19288 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19289 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19290 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19291 @table @dfn
19292
19293 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19294 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19295 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19296 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19297 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19298 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19299 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19300 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19301 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19302 instead, if you feel like.
19303
19304 @item Extra
19305 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19306 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19307 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19308 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19309 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19310 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19311 overviews:
19312
19313 @lisp
19314 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19315 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19316 @end lisp
19317
19318 @item Lines, Chars
19319 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19320 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19321
19322 These predicates are true if
19323
19324 @example
19325 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19326 @end example
19327
19328 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19329 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19330 following form:
19331
19332 @lisp
19333 (< header-value 4)
19334 @end lisp
19335
19336 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19337 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19338 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19339 it's not. I think.)
19340
19341 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19342 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19343 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19344 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19345
19346 @item Date
19347 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19348 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19349 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19350 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19351 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19352 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19353 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19354
19355 @cindex ISO8601
19356 @cindex date
19357 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19358 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19359 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19360 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19361 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19362 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19363 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19364 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19365 whole family, eh?)
19366
19367 @item Head, Body, All
19368 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19369 header uses.
19370
19371 @item Followup
19372 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19373 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19374 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19375 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19376 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19377 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19378 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19379 files.)
19380
19381 @item Thread
19382 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19383 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19384 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19385 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19386 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19387 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19388 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19389 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19390 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19391 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19392 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19393 @end table
19394 @end enumerate
19395
19396 @cindex score file atoms
19397 @item mark
19398 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19399 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19400
19401 @item expunge
19402 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19403 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19404
19405 @item mark-and-expunge
19406 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19407 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19408 summary buffer.
19409
19410 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19411 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19412 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19413 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19414 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19415
19416 @item files
19417 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19418 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19419 this one was.
19420
19421 @item exclude-files
19422 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19423 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19424 other.
19425
19426 @item eval
19427 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19428 ignored when handling global score files.
19429
19430 @item read-only
19431 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19432 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19433 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19434 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19435
19436 @item orphan
19437 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19438 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19439 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19440 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19441
19442 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19443
19444 @example
19445 (orphan -500)
19446 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19447 @end example
19448
19449 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19450 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19451 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19452 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19453 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19454
19455 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19456 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19457 scoring rules exist.
19458
19459 @item adapt
19460 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19461 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19462 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19463 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19464 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19465 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19466 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19467 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19468 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19469 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19470 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19471 it.
19472
19473 @item adapt-file
19474 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19475 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19476 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19477 file for a number of groups.
19478
19479 @item local
19480 @cindex local variables
19481 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19482 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19483 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19484 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19485 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19486 be evaluated.
19487 @end table
19488
19489
19490 @node Score File Editing
19491 @section Score File Editing
19492
19493 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19494 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19495 with a mode for that.
19496
19497 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19498 additional commands:
19499
19500 @table @kbd
19501
19502 @item C-c C-c
19503 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19504 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19505 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19506 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19507
19508 @item C-c C-d
19509 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19510 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19511 Insert the current date in numerical format
19512 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19513 you were wondering.
19514
19515 @item C-c C-p
19516 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19517 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19518 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19519 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19520 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19521 you.
19522
19523 @end table
19524
19525 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19526
19527 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19528 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19529
19530 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19531 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19532
19533
19534 @node Adaptive Scoring
19535 @section Adaptive Scoring
19536 @cindex adaptive scoring
19537
19538 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19539 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19540 stupidity, to be precise.
19541
19542 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19543 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19544 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19545 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19546 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19547 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19548 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19549 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19550 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19551
19552 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19553 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19554 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19555 might look something like this:
19556
19557 @lisp
19558 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19559 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19560 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19561 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19562 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19563 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19564 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19565 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19566 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19567 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19568 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19569 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19570 @end lisp
19571
19572 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19573 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19574 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19575 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19576 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19577 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19578 entries.
19579
19580 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19581 will be applied to each article.
19582
19583 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19584 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19585 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19586 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19587
19588 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19589 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19590 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19591 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19592
19593 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19594 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19595 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19596 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19597
19598 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19599 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19600 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19601 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19602 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19603 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19604
19605 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19606 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19607 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19608
19609 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19610 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19611 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19612
19613 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19614 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19615 let you use different rules in different groups.
19616
19617 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19618 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19619 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19620 is @file{ADAPT}.
19621
19622 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19623 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19624 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19625 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19626 the length of the match is less than
19627 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19628 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19629 this problem.
19630
19631 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19632 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19633 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19634 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19635 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19636
19637 @lisp
19638 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19639 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19640 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19641 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19642 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19643 @end lisp
19644
19645 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19646 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19647 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19648 score with 30 points.
19649
19650 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19651 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19652 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19653 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19654 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19655
19656 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19657 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19658 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19659 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19660 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19661
19662 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19663 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19664 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19665 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19666
19667 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19668 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19669 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19670 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19671
19672 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19673 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19674 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19675 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19676 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19677
19678 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19679 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19680 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19681
19682 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19683 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19684 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19685 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19686
19687
19688 @node Home Score File
19689 @section Home Score File
19690
19691 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19692 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19693 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19694 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19695
19696 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19697 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19698 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19699
19700 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19701 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19702 be:
19703
19704 @enumerate
19705 @item
19706 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19707 groups.
19708
19709 @item
19710 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19711 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19712 parameter.
19713
19714 @item
19715 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19716
19717 @enumerate
19718 @item
19719 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19720 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19721
19722 @item
19723 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19724 be used as the home score file.
19725
19726 @item
19727 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19728 @end enumerate
19729
19730 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19731 for matches.
19732
19733 @end enumerate
19734
19735 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19736
19737 @lisp
19738 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19739 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19740 @end lisp
19741
19742 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19743 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19744
19745 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19746 @lisp
19747 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19748 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19749 @end lisp
19750
19751 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19752 Other functions include
19753
19754 @table @code
19755 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19756 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19757 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19758 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19759
19760 @end table
19761
19762 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19763 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19764 their own home score files:
19765
19766 @lisp
19767 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19768 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19769 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19770 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19771 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19772 @end lisp
19773
19774 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19775 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19776 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19777 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19778 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19779
19780 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19781 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19782 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19783 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19784 precedence over this variable.
19785
19786
19787 @node Followups To Yourself
19788 @section Followups To Yourself
19789
19790 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19791 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19792 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19793 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19794 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19795 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19796
19797 @table @code
19798
19799 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19800 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19801 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19802 article.
19803
19804 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19805 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19806 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19807 your own article.
19808 @end table
19809
19810 @vindex message-sent-hook
19811 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19812 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19813 @lisp
19814 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19815 @end lisp
19816
19817
19818 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19819 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19820 mine:
19821
19822 @example
19823 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19824 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19825 @end example
19826
19827 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19828 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19829 myself:
19830
19831 @lisp
19832 ("references"
19833 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19834 1000 nil r))
19835 @end lisp
19836
19837 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19838 is system-dependent.
19839
19840
19841 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19842 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19843 @cindex scoring on other headers
19844
19845 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19846 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19847 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19848 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19849 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19850
19851 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19852 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19853 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19854 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19855 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19856
19857 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19858
19859 @lisp
19860 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19861 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19862 @end lisp
19863
19864 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19865 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19866 time if you have much mail.
19867
19868 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19869 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19870
19871 See? Simple.
19872
19873
19874 @node Scoring Tips
19875 @section Scoring Tips
19876 @cindex scoring tips
19877
19878 @table @dfn
19879
19880 @item Crossposts
19881 @cindex crossposts
19882 @cindex scoring crossposts
19883 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19884 the @code{Xref} header.
19885 @lisp
19886 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19887 @end lisp
19888
19889 @item Multiple crossposts
19890 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19891 more than, say, 3 groups:
19892 @lisp
19893 ("xref"
19894 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19895 -1000 nil r))
19896 @end lisp
19897
19898 @item Matching on the body
19899 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19900 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19901 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
19902 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
19903 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
19904 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
19905 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
19906 the matches.
19907
19908 @item Marking as read
19909 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
19910 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
19911 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
19912 @lisp
19913 ((mark -100))
19914 @end lisp
19915 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
19916
19917 @item Negated character classes
19918 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
19919 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
19920 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
19921 @end table
19922
19923
19924 @node Reverse Scoring
19925 @section Reverse Scoring
19926 @cindex reverse scoring
19927
19928 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
19929 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
19930 like this in your score file:
19931
19932 @lisp
19933 (("subject"
19934 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
19935 (mark 1)
19936 (expunge 1))
19937 @end lisp
19938
19939 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
19940 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
19941
19942
19943 @node Global Score Files
19944 @section Global Score Files
19945 @cindex global score files
19946
19947 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
19948 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
19949 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
19950
19951 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
19952 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
19953 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
19954
19955 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
19956 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
19957 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
19958 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
19959 files are applicable to which group.
19960
19961 To use the score file
19962 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
19963 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
19964 say this:
19965
19966 @lisp
19967 (setq gnus-global-score-files
19968 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
19969 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
19970 @end lisp
19971
19972 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
19973 @noindent
19974 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
19975 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
19976 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
19977 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
19978
19979 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
19980 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
19981
19982 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
19983 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
19984 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
19985 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
19986 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
19987 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
19988
19989 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
19990 head:
19991
19992 @itemize @bullet
19993
19994 @item
19995 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
19996 @item
19997 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
19998 @item
19999 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20000 @item
20001 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20002 lowered out of existence.
20003 @item
20004 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20005 articles completely.
20006
20007 @item
20008 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20009 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20010 old articles for a long time.
20011 @end itemize
20012
20013 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20014 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20015 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20016 holding our breath yet?
20017
20018
20019 @node Kill Files
20020 @section Kill Files
20021 @cindex kill files
20022
20023 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20024 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20025 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20026
20027 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20028 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20029 files into score files.
20030
20031 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20032 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20033 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20034 that isn't a very good idea.
20035
20036 Normal kill files look like this:
20037
20038 @lisp
20039 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20040 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20041 (gnus-expunge "X")
20042 @end lisp
20043
20044 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20045 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20046
20047 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20048 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20049 interpreting it.
20050
20051 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20052
20053 @table @kbd
20054
20055 @item M-k
20056 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20057 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20058 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20059
20060 @item M-K
20061 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20062 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20063 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20064 @end table
20065
20066 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20067
20068 @table @kbd
20069
20070 @item M-k
20071 @kindex M-k (Group)
20072 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20073 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20074
20075 @item M-K
20076 @kindex M-K (Group)
20077 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20078 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20079 @end table
20080
20081 Kill file variables:
20082
20083 @table @code
20084 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20085 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20086 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20087 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20088 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20089 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20090 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20091
20092 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20093 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20094 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20095 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20096 kills.
20097
20098 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20099 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20100 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20101 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20102 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20103 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20104 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20105 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20106 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20107
20108 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20109 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20110 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20111
20112 @end table
20113
20114
20115 @node Converting Kill Files
20116 @section Converting Kill Files
20117 @cindex kill files
20118 @cindex converting kill files
20119
20120 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20121 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20122 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20123 by hand.
20124
20125 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20126 You can fetch it from
20127 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20128
20129 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20130 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20131 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20132 before.
20133
20134
20135 @node GroupLens
20136 @section GroupLens
20137 @cindex GroupLens
20138
20139 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20140 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20141
20142 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20143 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20144 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20145 news articles generated every day.
20146
20147 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20148 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20149 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20150 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20151 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20152 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20153 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20154 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20155 article.
20156
20157 @menu
20158 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20159 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20160 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20161 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20162 @end menu
20163
20164
20165 @node Using GroupLens
20166 @subsection Using GroupLens
20167
20168 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20169 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20170 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20171
20172 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20173
20174 @table @code
20175
20176 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20177 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20178 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20179 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20180
20181 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20182 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20183 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20184 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20185
20186 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20187 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20188 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20189
20190 @end table
20191
20192 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20193 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20194 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20195 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20196 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20197 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20198
20199
20200 @node Rating Articles
20201 @subsection Rating Articles
20202
20203 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20204 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20205 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20206 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20207 like this one?''
20208
20209 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20210
20211 @table @kbd
20212
20213 @item r
20214 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20215 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20216 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20217
20218 @item k
20219 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20220 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20221 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20222 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20223 threads in rec.humor.
20224
20225 @end table
20226
20227 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20228 the score of the article you're reading.
20229
20230 @table @kbd
20231
20232 @item 1-5 n
20233 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20234 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20235 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20236
20237 @item 1-5 ,
20238 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20239 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20240 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20241
20242 @end table
20243
20244 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20245 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20246
20247
20248 @node Displaying Predictions
20249 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20250
20251 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20252 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20253 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20254 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20255 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20256
20257 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20258 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20259 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20260 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20261 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20262 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20263 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20264 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20265 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20266 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20267 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20268 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20269 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20270
20271 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20272 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20273 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20274 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20275
20276 The following are valid values for that variable.
20277
20278 @table @code
20279 @item prediction-spot
20280 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20281 displayed.
20282
20283 @item confidence-interval
20284 A numeric confidence interval.
20285
20286 @item prediction-bar
20287 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20288
20289 @item confidence-bar
20290 Numerical confidence.
20291
20292 @item confidence-spot
20293 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20294
20295 @item prediction-num
20296 Plain-old numeric value.
20297
20298 @item confidence-plus-minus
20299 Prediction +/- confidence.
20300
20301 @end table
20302
20303
20304 @node GroupLens Variables
20305 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20306
20307 @table @code
20308
20309 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20310 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20311 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20312 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20313 %s\n}.
20314
20315 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20316 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20317 default.
20318
20319 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20320 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20321
20322 @item grouplens-score-offset
20323 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20324 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20325 default is 0.
20326
20327 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20328 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20329 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20330
20331 @end table
20332
20333
20334 @node Advanced Scoring
20335 @section Advanced Scoring
20336
20337 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20338 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20339 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20340 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20341 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20342
20343 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20344 scoring patterns.
20345
20346 @menu
20347 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20348 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20349 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20350 @end menu
20351
20352
20353 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20354 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20355
20356 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20357 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20358 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20359 non-@code{nil} value.
20360
20361 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20362 operator, and various match operators.
20363
20364 Logical operators:
20365
20366 @table @code
20367 @item &
20368 @itemx and
20369 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20370 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20371 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20372 @code{true}.
20373
20374 @item |
20375 @itemx or
20376 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20377 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20378 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20379
20380 @item !
20381 @itemx not
20382 @itemx ¬
20383 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20384 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20385
20386 @end table
20387
20388 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20389 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20390 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20391 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20392 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20393 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20394 the ancestry you want to go.
20395
20396 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20397 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20398 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20399 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20400 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20401
20402
20403 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20404 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20405
20406 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20407 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20408 of parentheses.
20409
20410 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20411 when he's talking about Gnus:
20412
20413 @example
20414 @group
20415 ((&
20416 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20417 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20418 1000)
20419 @end group
20420 @end example
20421
20422 Quite simple, huh?
20423
20424 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20425
20426 @example
20427 ((&
20428 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20429 (|
20430 ("subject" "Gnus")
20431 ("lines" 100 >)))
20432 1000)
20433 @end example
20434
20435 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20436 really don't want to read what he's written:
20437
20438 @example
20439 ((&
20440 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20441 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20442 -100000)
20443 @end example
20444
20445 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20446 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20447 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20448 very interesting:
20449
20450 @example
20451 ((&
20452 (1-
20453 (&
20454 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20455 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20456 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20457 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20458 1000)
20459 @end example
20460
20461 The possibilities are endless.
20462
20463
20464 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20465 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20466
20467 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20468 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20469 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20470 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20471 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20472 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20473 @samp{subject}) first.
20474
20475 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20476 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20477 something like:
20478
20479 @example
20480 ...
20481 (1-
20482 (1-
20483 ("from" "lars")))
20484 ...
20485 @end example
20486
20487 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20488 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20489
20490 @example
20491 (1-
20492 (&
20493 ("from" "Lars")
20494 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20495 @end example
20496
20497 than it is to say:
20498
20499 @example
20500 (&
20501 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20502 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20503 @end example
20504
20505
20506 @node Score Decays
20507 @section Score Decays
20508 @cindex score decays
20509 @cindex decays
20510
20511 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20512 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20513 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20514 use them in any sensible way.
20515
20516 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20517 @findex gnus-decay-score
20518 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20519 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20520 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20521 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20522 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20523 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20524 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20525 definition of that function:
20526
20527 @lisp
20528 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20529 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20530 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20531 (let ((n (- score
20532 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20533 (min (abs score)
20534 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20535 (* (abs score)
20536 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20537 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20538 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20539 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20540 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20541 (string-to-number
20542 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20543 (floor n))))
20544 @end lisp
20545
20546 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20547 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20548 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20549 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20550
20551 @enumerate
20552 @item
20553 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20554
20555 @item
20556 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20557
20558 @item
20559 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20560 score.
20561 @end enumerate
20562
20563 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20564 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20565 the new score, which should be an integer.
20566
20567 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20568 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20569
20570 @iftex
20571 @iflatex
20572 @chapter Message
20573 @include message.texi
20574 @chapter Emacs MIME
20575 @include emacs-mime.texi
20576 @chapter Sieve
20577 @include sieve.texi
20578 @chapter PGG
20579 @include pgg.texi
20580 @end iflatex
20581 @end iftex
20582
20583 @node Various
20584 @chapter Various
20585
20586 @menu
20587 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20588 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20589 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20590 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20591 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20592 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20593 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20594 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20595 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20596 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20597 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20598 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20599 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20600 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20601 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20602 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20603 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20604 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20605 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20606 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20607 @end menu
20608
20609
20610 @node Process/Prefix
20611 @section Process/Prefix
20612 @cindex process/prefix convention
20613
20614 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20615 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20616
20617 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20618 command to be performed on.
20619
20620 It goes like this:
20621
20622 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20623 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20624 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20625 with the current one.
20626
20627 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20628 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20629 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20630
20631 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20632 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20633 the process mark.
20634
20635 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20636 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20637
20638 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20639 are avoided.
20640
20641 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20642 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20643 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20644 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20645
20646 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20647 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20648 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20649 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20650 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20651 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20652 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20653 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20654
20655 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20656 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20657 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20658 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20659 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20660
20661
20662 @node Interactive
20663 @section Interactive
20664 @cindex interaction
20665
20666 @table @code
20667
20668 @item gnus-novice-user
20669 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20670 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20671 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20672 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20673 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20674 default.
20675
20676 @item gnus-expert-user
20677 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20678 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20679 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20680 matter how strange.
20681
20682 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20683 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20684 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20685 is @code{t} by default.
20686
20687 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20688 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20689 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20690 default.
20691 @end table
20692
20693
20694 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20695 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20696 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20697
20698 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20699 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20700 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20701 rule of 900 to the current article.
20702
20703 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20704 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20705 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20706 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20707 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20708 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20709 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20710
20711 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20712 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20713 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20714 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20715 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20716 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20717 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20718 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20719 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20720
20721 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20722 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20723 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20724
20725 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20726 Interactive}.
20727
20728
20729 @node Formatting Variables
20730 @section Formatting Variables
20731 @cindex formatting variables
20732
20733 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20734 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20735 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20736 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20737 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20738 be annoyed by.
20739
20740 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20741 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20742 lots of percentages everywhere.
20743
20744 @menu
20745 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20746 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20747 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20748 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20749 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20750 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20751 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20752 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20753 @end menu
20754
20755 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20756 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20757 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20758 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20759 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20760 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20761 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20762 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20763
20764 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20765 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20766
20767 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20768 @findex gnus-update-format
20769 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20770 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20771 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20772 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20773
20774
20775
20776 @node Formatting Basics
20777 @subsection Formatting Basics
20778
20779 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20780 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20781 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20782
20783 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20784 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20785 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20786 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20787 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20788 the right instead.
20789
20790 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20791 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20792 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20793 less than 4 characters wide.
20794
20795 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20796 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20797
20798
20799 @node Mode Line Formatting
20800 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20801
20802 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20803 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20804 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20805 with the following two differences:
20806
20807 @enumerate
20808
20809 @item
20810 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20811
20812 @item
20813 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20814 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20815 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20816 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20817 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20818 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20819 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20820
20821 @end enumerate
20822
20823
20824 @node Advanced Formatting
20825 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20826
20827 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20828 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20829 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20830 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20831
20832 These are the valid modifiers:
20833
20834 @table @code
20835 @item pad
20836 @itemx pad-left
20837 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20838 length.
20839
20840 @item pad-right
20841 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20842 length.
20843
20844 @item max
20845 @itemx max-left
20846 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20847
20848 @item max-right
20849 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20850 length.
20851
20852 @item cut
20853 @itemx cut-left
20854 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20855
20856 @item cut-right
20857 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20858
20859 @item ignore
20860 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20861
20862 @item form
20863 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20864 used.
20865
20866 Here's an example:
20867
20868 @lisp
20869 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20870 @end lisp
20871
20872 @end table
20873
20874 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20875 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20876 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20877 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20878 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20879 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20880 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20881
20882 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20883 last operation, padding.
20884
20885 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20886 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20887 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20888 @xref{Compilation}.
20889
20890
20891 @node User-Defined Specs
20892 @subsection User-Defined Specs
20893
20894 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
20895 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
20896 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
20897 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
20898 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
20899 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
20900 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
20901 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
20902 should protect against that.
20903
20904 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
20905 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
20906
20907 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
20908 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
20909 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
20910 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
20911 inserted.
20912
20913
20914 @node Formatting Fonts
20915 @subsection Formatting Fonts
20916
20917 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
20918 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
20919 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
20920 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
20921 over it.
20922
20923 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
20924 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
20925 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
20926 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
20927 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
20928 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
20929
20930 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
20931 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
20932 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
20933 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
20934 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
20935 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
20936 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
20937 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
20938 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
20939 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
20940 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
20941 paragraph.)
20942
20943 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
20944
20945 @lisp
20946 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
20947 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
20948 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
20949
20950 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
20951 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
20952 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
20953 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
20954 ;; @r{Set the color.}
20955 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
20956 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
20957
20958 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
20959 (setq gnus-group-line-format
20960 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
20961 @end lisp
20962
20963 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
20964 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
20965
20966 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
20967 mode-line variables.
20968
20969 @node Positioning Point
20970 @subsection Positioning Point
20971
20972 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
20973 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
20974 line. You can customize this behaviour in three different ways.
20975
20976 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
20977
20978 @findex gnus-goto-colon
20979 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
20980 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
20981
20982 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
20983 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
20984 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
20985 place point there.
20986
20987
20988 @node Tabulation
20989 @subsection Tabulation
20990
20991 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
20992 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
20993 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
20994 about lining up the following text afterwards.
20995
20996 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
20997 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
20998
20999 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21000 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21001 This is the soft tabulator.
21002
21003 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21004 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21005 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21006
21007
21008 @node Wide Characters
21009 @subsection Wide Characters
21010
21011 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21012 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21013 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21014
21015 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21016 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21017 these countries, that's not true.
21018
21019 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21020 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21021 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21022 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21023 for Emacs.
21024
21025
21026 @node Window Layout
21027 @section Window Layout
21028 @cindex window layout
21029
21030 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21031
21032 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21033 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21034 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21035 @code{t} by default.
21036
21037 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21038 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21039
21040 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21041 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21042 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21043
21044 @lisp
21045 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21046 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21047 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21048 (article 1.0))))
21049 @end lisp
21050
21051 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21052 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21053 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21054 possible names is listed below.
21055
21056 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21057 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21058
21059 @lisp
21060 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21061 (article 1.0)))
21062 @end lisp
21063
21064 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21065 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21066 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21067 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21068 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21069 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21070 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21071 size spec per split.
21072
21073 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21074 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21075 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21076 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21077 present) gets focus.
21078
21079 Here's a more complicated example:
21080
21081 @lisp
21082 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21083 (summary 0.25 point)
21084 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21085 (article 1.0)))
21086 @end lisp
21087
21088 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21089 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21090 occupy, not a percentage.
21091
21092 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21093 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21094 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21095 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21096 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21097 is non-@code{nil}.
21098
21099 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21100
21101 @lisp
21102 (article (horizontal 1.0
21103 (vertical 0.5
21104 (group 1.0)
21105 (gnus-carpal 4))
21106 (vertical 1.0
21107 (summary 0.25 point)
21108 (summary-carpal 4)
21109 (article 1.0))))
21110 @end lisp
21111
21112 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21113 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21114
21115 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21116 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21117 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21118 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21119 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21120
21121 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21122 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21123 lines from the splits.
21124
21125 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21126 may look like:
21127
21128 @example
21129 @group
21130 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21131 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21132 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21133 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21134 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21135 size = number | frame-params
21136 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21137 @end group
21138 @end example
21139
21140 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21141 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21142 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21143 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21144
21145 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21146 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21147 @cindex window height
21148 @cindex window width
21149 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21150 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21151 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21152 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21153 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21154 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21155
21156 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21157 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21158 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21159 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21160
21161 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21162 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21163 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21164 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21165 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21166 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21167 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21168 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21169 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21170 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21171 configuration list.
21172
21173 @lisp
21174 (gnus-configure-frame
21175 '(horizontal 1.0
21176 (vertical 10
21177 (group 1.0)
21178 (article 0.3 point))
21179 (vertical 1.0
21180 (article 1.0)
21181 (horizontal 4
21182 (group 1.0)
21183 (article 10)))))
21184 @end lisp
21185
21186 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21187 @code{frame} split:
21188
21189 @lisp
21190 (gnus-configure-frame
21191 '(frame 1.0
21192 (vertical 1.0
21193 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21194 (article 1.0))
21195 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21196 (user-position . t)
21197 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21198 (picon 1.0))))
21199
21200 @end lisp
21201
21202 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21203 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21204 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21205 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21206 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21207 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21208 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21209 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21210 is such a plist.
21211 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21212 be found in its default value.
21213
21214 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21215 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21216 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21217 might be used:
21218
21219 @lisp
21220 (message (horizontal 1.0
21221 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21222 (vertical 0.24
21223 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21224 '(summary 0.5))
21225 (group 1.0))))
21226 @end lisp
21227
21228 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21229 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21230 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21231
21232 @lisp
21233 (message
21234 (frame 1.0
21235 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21236 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21237 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21238 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21239 (name . "Message"))
21240 (message 1.0 point))))
21241 @end lisp
21242
21243 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21244 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21245 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21246 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21247 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21248
21249 @lisp
21250 (gnus-add-configuration
21251 '(article (vertical 1.0
21252 (group 4)
21253 (summary .25 point)
21254 (article 1.0))))
21255 @end lisp
21256
21257 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21258 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21259 Gnus has been loaded.
21260
21261 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21262 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21263 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21264 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21265 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21266
21267 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21268 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21269 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21270 windows resized.
21271
21272 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21273
21274 @itemize @bullet
21275 @item
21276 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21277 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21278
21279 @ifinfo
21280 @example
21281 +---+---------+
21282 | G | Summary |
21283 | r +---------+
21284 | o | |
21285 | u | Article |
21286 | p | |
21287 +---+---------+
21288 @end example
21289 @end ifinfo
21290
21291 @lisp
21292 (gnus-add-configuration
21293 '(article
21294 (horizontal 1.0
21295 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21296 (vertical 1.0
21297 (summary 0.16 point)
21298 (article 1.0)))))
21299
21300 (gnus-add-configuration
21301 '(summary
21302 (horizontal 1.0
21303 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21304 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21305 @end lisp
21306
21307 @end itemize
21308
21309
21310 @node Faces and Fonts
21311 @section Faces and Fonts
21312 @cindex faces
21313 @cindex fonts
21314 @cindex colors
21315
21316 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21317 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21318 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21319 interface.
21320
21321
21322 @node Compilation
21323 @section Compilation
21324 @cindex compilation
21325 @cindex byte-compilation
21326
21327 @findex gnus-compile
21328
21329 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21330 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21331 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21332 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21333 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21334 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21335 course.)
21336
21337 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21338 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21339 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21340 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21341 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21342 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21343 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21344
21345
21346 @node Mode Lines
21347 @section Mode Lines
21348 @cindex mode lines
21349
21350 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21351 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21352 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21353 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21354 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21355 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21356 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21357 quicker.
21358
21359 @cindex display-time
21360
21361 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21362 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21363 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21364 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21365 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21366 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21367 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21368 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21369 this variable:
21370
21371 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21372 @lisp
21373 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21374 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21375 (+ 21
21376 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21377 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21378 (length display-time-string)))))
21379 @end lisp
21380
21381 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21382 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21383 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21384 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21385 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21386
21387
21388 @node Highlighting and Menus
21389 @section Highlighting and Menus
21390 @cindex visual
21391 @cindex highlighting
21392 @cindex menus
21393
21394 @vindex gnus-visual
21395 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21396 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21397 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21398 file.
21399
21400 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21401 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21402
21403 @table @code
21404 @item group-highlight
21405 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21406 @item summary-highlight
21407 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21408 @item article-highlight
21409 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21410 @item highlight
21411 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21412 @item group-menu
21413 Create menus in the group buffer.
21414 @item summary-menu
21415 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21416 @item article-menu
21417 Create menus in the article buffer.
21418 @item browse-menu
21419 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21420 @item server-menu
21421 Create menus in the server buffer.
21422 @item score-menu
21423 Create menus in the score buffers.
21424 @item menu
21425 Create menus in all buffers.
21426 @end table
21427
21428 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21429 buffers, you could say something like:
21430
21431 @lisp
21432 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21433 @end lisp
21434
21435 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21436
21437 @lisp
21438 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21439 @end lisp
21440
21441 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21442 in all Gnus buffers.
21443
21444 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21445
21446 @table @code
21447 @item gnus-mouse-face
21448 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21449 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21450 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21451
21452 @end table
21453
21454 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21455
21456 @table @code
21457
21458 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21459 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21460 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21461
21462 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21463 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21464 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21465
21466 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21467 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21468 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21469
21470 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21471 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21472 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21473
21474 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21475 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21476 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21477
21478 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21479 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21480 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21481
21482 @end table
21483
21484
21485 @node Buttons
21486 @section Buttons
21487 @cindex buttons
21488 @cindex mouse
21489 @cindex click
21490
21491 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21492 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21493 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21494 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21495 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21496
21497 Right.
21498
21499 @vindex gnus-carpal
21500 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21501 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21502 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21503
21504
21505 @table @code
21506
21507 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21508 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21509 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21510
21511 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21512 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21513 Face used on buttons.
21514
21515 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21516 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21517 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21518
21519 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21520 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21521 Buttons in the group buffer.
21522
21523 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21524 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21525 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21526
21527 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21528 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21529 Buttons in the server buffer.
21530
21531 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21532 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21533 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21534 @end table
21535
21536 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21537 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21538 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21539
21540
21541 @node Daemons
21542 @section Daemons
21543 @cindex demons
21544 @cindex daemons
21545
21546 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21547 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21548 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21549 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21550 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21551
21552 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21553 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21554 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21555
21556 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21557 been idle for thirty minutes:
21558
21559 @lisp
21560 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21561 @end lisp
21562
21563 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21564 Emacs is idle:
21565
21566 @lisp
21567 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21568 @end lisp
21569
21570 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21571 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21572 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21573
21574 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21575 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21576 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21577 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21578
21579 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21580 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21581 @var{idle} minutes.
21582
21583 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21584 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21585 minutes.
21586
21587 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21588 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21589 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21590
21591 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21592 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21593 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21594 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21595
21596 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21597 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21598
21599 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21600 @lisp
21601 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21602 @end lisp
21603
21604 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21605 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21606 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21607 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21608 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21609 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21610 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21611 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21612 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21613 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21614 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21615
21616 @findex gnus-demon-init
21617 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21618 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21619 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21620 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21621 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21622
21623 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21624 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21625 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21626 behave.
21627
21628
21629 @node NoCeM
21630 @section NoCeM
21631 @cindex nocem
21632 @cindex spam
21633
21634 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21635 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21636
21637 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21638 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21639 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21640 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21641 away.
21642
21643 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21644 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21645 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21646 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21647
21648 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21649 this will make spam disappear.
21650
21651 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21652
21653 @table @code
21654 @item gnus-use-nocem
21655 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21656 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21657 by default.
21658
21659 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21660 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21661 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21662 default is
21663 @lisp
21664 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21665 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21666 @end lisp
21667
21668 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21669 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21670 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21671 people you want to listen to. The default is
21672 @lisp
21673 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21674 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21675 @end lisp
21676 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21677
21678 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21679 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21680
21681 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21682 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21683 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21684 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21685 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21686 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21687 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21688 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21689 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21690 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21691
21692 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21693 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21694
21695 @lisp
21696 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21697 @end lisp
21698
21699 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21700 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21701
21702 @lisp
21703 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21704 @end lisp
21705
21706 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21707
21708
21709 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21710 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21711 @findex mc-verify
21712 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21713 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21714 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
21715 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21716
21717 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
21718 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
21719
21720 @lisp
21721 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
21722
21723 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
21724 (not (eq 'forged
21725 (ignore-errors
21726 (if (mc-verify)
21727 t
21728 'forged)))))
21729 @end lisp
21730
21731 This might be dangerous, though.
21732
21733 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21734 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21735 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21736 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21737
21738 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21739 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21740 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21741 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21742 might then see old spam.
21743
21744 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21745 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21746 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21747 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21748 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21749 issuers.
21750
21751 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21752 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21753 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21754 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21755
21756 @end table
21757
21758 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21759 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21760 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21761 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21762
21763
21764 @node Undo
21765 @section Undo
21766 @cindex undo
21767
21768 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21769 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21770 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21771
21772 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21773 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21774 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21775 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21776 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21777 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21778 @code{undo} function.
21779
21780 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21781 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21782 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21783 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21784 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21785 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21786 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21787 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21788 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21789 never be totally undoable.
21790
21791 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21792 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21793 @findex gnus-undo
21794 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21795 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21796 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21797 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21798 command.
21799
21800
21801 @node Predicate Specifiers
21802 @section Predicate Specifiers
21803 @cindex predicate specifiers
21804
21805 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21806 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21807 to type all that much.
21808
21809 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21810
21811 Here's an example:
21812
21813 @lisp
21814 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21815 gnus-article-unread-p)
21816 @end lisp
21817
21818 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21819 functions all take one parameter.
21820
21821 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21822 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21823 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21824 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21825 specifier.
21826
21827
21828 @node Moderation
21829 @section Moderation
21830 @cindex moderation
21831
21832 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21833 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21834 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21835 get a copy.
21836
21837 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21838 buffers. Put
21839
21840 @lisp
21841 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21842 @end lisp
21843
21844 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21845
21846 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21847 supposed to work:
21848
21849 @enumerate
21850 @item
21851 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21852 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21853 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21854
21855 @item
21856 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21857 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21858
21859 @item
21860 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21861 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21862 @kbd{c} command.
21863 @end enumerate
21864
21865 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21866
21867 @lisp
21868 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21869 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21870 @end lisp
21871
21872
21873 @node Image Enhancements
21874 @section Image Enhancements
21875
21876 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21877 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21878 taken advantage of that.
21879
21880 @menu
21881 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21882 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21883 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21884 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21885 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21886 @end menu
21887
21888
21889 @node X-Face
21890 @subsection X-Face
21891 @cindex x-face
21892
21893 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
21894 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
21895 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
21896 readers.
21897
21898 @cindex x-face
21899 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
21900 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
21901 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
21902 @iftex
21903 @iflatex
21904 \include{xface}
21905 @end iflatex
21906 @end iftex
21907 @c @anchor{X-Face}
21908
21909 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
21910 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
21911 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
21912 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
21913
21914 The variable that controls this is the
21915 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
21916 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
21917 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
21918 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
21919 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
21920
21921 The default action under Emacs 20 is to fork off the @code{display}
21922 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For
21923 the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
21924 like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux system.} to
21925 view the face.
21926
21927 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
21928 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
21929 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
21930 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
21931 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
21932 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
21933 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
21934 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
21935
21936 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
21937 @code{xface}).
21938
21939 @noindent
21940 Face and variable:
21941
21942 @table @code
21943 @item gnus-x-face
21944 @vindex gnus-x-face
21945 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
21946 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
21947 default colors are black and white.
21948 @end table
21949
21950 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
21951 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
21952
21953 @findex gnus-random-x-face
21954 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
21955 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
21956 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
21957 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
21958 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
21959 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
21960 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
21961 header data as a string.
21962
21963 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
21964 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
21965 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
21966 randomly generated data.
21967
21968 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
21969 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
21970 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
21971 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
21972 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
21973
21974 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
21975 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21976
21977 @lisp
21978 (setq message-required-news-headers
21979 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21980 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
21981 @end lisp
21982
21983 Using the last function would be something like this:
21984
21985 @lisp
21986 (setq message-required-news-headers
21987 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21988 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
21989 (gnus-x-face-from-file
21990 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
21991 @end lisp
21992
21993
21994 @node Face
21995 @subsection Face
21996 @cindex face
21997
21998 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
21999
22000 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22001 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22002 represent the author of the message.
22003
22004 @cindex face
22005 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22006 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22007 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22008 specifications.
22009
22010 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22011 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22012
22013 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22014 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22015 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22016
22017 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22018 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22019 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22020 converts the file to Face format by using the
22021 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22022
22023 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22024 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22025
22026 @lisp
22027 (setq message-required-news-headers
22028 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22029 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22030 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22031 @end lisp
22032
22033
22034 @node Smileys
22035 @subsection Smileys
22036 @cindex smileys
22037
22038 @iftex
22039 @iflatex
22040 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22041 \input{smiley}
22042 @end iflatex
22043 @end iftex
22044
22045 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22046 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22047
22048 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22049 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22050
22051 @lisp
22052 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22053 @end lisp
22054
22055 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22056 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22057 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22058 text and maps that to file names.
22059
22060 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22061 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22062 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22063 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22064 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22065 displayed.
22066
22067 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22068 files:
22069
22070 @table @code
22071
22072 @item smiley-data-directory
22073 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22074 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22075
22076 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22077 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22078 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22079
22080 @end table
22081
22082
22083 @node Picons
22084 @subsection Picons
22085
22086 @iftex
22087 @iflatex
22088 \include{picons}
22089 @end iflatex
22090 @end iftex
22091
22092 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22093 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22094 over your shoulder as you read news.
22095
22096 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22097
22098 @iftex
22099 @iflatex
22100 \margindex{}
22101 @end iflatex
22102 @end iftex
22103
22104 @quotation
22105 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22106 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22107 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22108 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22109 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22110 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22111 @code{GIF} formats.
22112 @end quotation
22113
22114 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22115 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22116 point your Web browser at
22117 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22118
22119 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22120 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22121
22122 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22123 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22124 Picons databases.
22125
22126 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22127
22128 @table @code
22129
22130 @item gnus-picon-databases
22131 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22132 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22133 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22134 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22135 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22136
22137 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22138 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22139 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22140 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22141
22142 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22143 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22144 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22145 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22146
22147 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22148 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22149 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22150 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22151 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22152
22153 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22154 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22155 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22156 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22157
22158 @end table
22159
22160
22161 @node XVarious
22162 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22163
22164 @table @code
22165 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22166 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22167 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22168 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22169 unusual directory structure.
22170
22171 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22172 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22173 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
22174 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
22175
22176 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22177 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22178 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
22179 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
22180 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
22181 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
22182
22183 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22184 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22185 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22186 default.
22187
22188 @end table
22189
22190 @subsubsection Toolbar
22191
22192 @table @code
22193
22194 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22195 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22196 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
22197 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
22198 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
22199
22200 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22201 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22202 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22203
22204 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22205 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22206 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22207
22208 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22209 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22210 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22211
22212 @end table
22213
22214 @iftex
22215 @iflatex
22216 \margindex{}
22217 @end iflatex
22218 @end iftex
22219
22220
22221 @node Fuzzy Matching
22222 @section Fuzzy Matching
22223 @cindex fuzzy matching
22224
22225 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22226 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22227
22228 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22229 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22230 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22231
22232 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22233 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22234 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22235 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22236 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22237
22238
22239 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22240 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22241 @cindex email spam
22242 @cindex spam
22243 @cindex UCE
22244 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22245
22246 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22247 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22248 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22249 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22250 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22251 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22252 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22253 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22254 in the end.
22255
22256 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22257 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22258 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22259 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22260 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22261 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22262
22263 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22264
22265 @menu
22266 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22267 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22268 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22269 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22270 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22271 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22272 @end menu
22273
22274 @node The problem of spam
22275 @subsection The problem of spam
22276 @cindex email spam
22277 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22278 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22279 @cindex UCE
22280 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22281
22282 First, some background on spam.
22283
22284 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22285 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22286 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22287 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22288 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22289 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22290 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22291 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22292 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22293
22294 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22295 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22296 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22297 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22298 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22299 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22300 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22301 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22302 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22303 and processing.
22304
22305 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22306 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22307 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22308 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22309 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22310 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22311 from Bulgarian IPs.
22312
22313 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22314 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22315 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22316 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22317
22318 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22319 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22320 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22321 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22322
22323 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22324 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22325 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22326 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22327 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22328 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22329 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22330 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22331 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22332
22333 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22334 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22335 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22336 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22337 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22338 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22339 down for some time because of the incident.
22340
22341 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22342 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22343 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22344 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22345 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22346 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22347 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22348 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22349 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22350 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22351 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22352
22353 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22354 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22355 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22356 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22357 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22358 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22359 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22360 spam plague.
22361
22362 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22363 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22364 @cindex email spam
22365 @cindex spam
22366 @cindex UCE
22367 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22368
22369 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22370 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22371
22372 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22373 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22374 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22375 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22376 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22377 part of the mail address.)
22378
22379 @lisp
22380 (setq message-default-news-headers
22381 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22382 @end lisp
22383
22384 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22385 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22386
22387 @lisp
22388 (...
22389 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22390 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22391 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22392 "spam"))
22393 ...)
22394 @end lisp
22395
22396 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22397 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22398 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22399 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22400
22401 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22402 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22403 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22404 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22405 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22406 your fancy split rule in this way:
22407
22408 @lisp
22409 (
22410 ...
22411 (to "larsi" "misc")
22412 "spam")
22413 @end lisp
22414
22415 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22416 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22417 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22418 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22419 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22420
22421 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22422 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22423 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22424 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22425
22426 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22427
22428
22429 @node SpamAssassin
22430 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22431 @cindex SpamAssassin
22432 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22433 @cindex DCC
22434
22435 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22436 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22437 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22438 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22439 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22440 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22441 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22442
22443 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22444 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22445 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22446 recipes.
22447
22448 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22449 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22450 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22451 Specifiers}) follow.
22452
22453 @lisp
22454 (setq mail-sources
22455 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22456 (pop :user "jrl"
22457 :server "pophost"
22458 :postscript
22459 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22460 @end lisp
22461
22462 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22463 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22464 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22465
22466 @lisp
22467 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22468 ...))
22469 @end lisp
22470
22471 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22472
22473 @lisp
22474 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22475 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22476 ...))
22477 @end lisp
22478
22479 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22480 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22481 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22482 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22483
22484 @lisp
22485 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22486 ...))
22487 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22488 (save-excursion
22489 (save-restriction
22490 (widen)
22491 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22492 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22493 "spam"))))
22494 @end lisp
22495
22496 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22497 downloaded by default. You need to set
22498 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22499 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22500
22501 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22502 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22503 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22504
22505 @lisp
22506 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22507 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22508 (interactive)
22509 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22510 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22511 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22512 @end lisp
22513
22514 @node Hashcash
22515 @subsection Hashcash
22516 @cindex hashcash
22517
22518 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22519 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22520 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22521 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22522 in smaller communities.
22523
22524 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22525 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22526 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22527 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22528 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22529 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22530 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22531 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22532 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22533 one of them separately.
22534
22535 @cindex X-Hashcash
22536 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22537 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22538 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22539 header. For more details, and for the external application
22540 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22541 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22542 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22543
22544 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22545 like:
22546
22547 @lisp
22548 (require 'hashcash)
22549 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22550 @end lisp
22551
22552 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22553 contrib directory or at
22554 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22555
22556 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22557
22558 @table @code
22559
22560 @item hashcash-default-payment
22561 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22562 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22563 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22564 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22565
22566 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22567 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22568 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22569 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22570 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22571 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22572 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22573 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22574 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22575
22576 @item hashcash
22577 @vindex hashcash
22578 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22579
22580 @end table
22581
22582 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22583 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22584 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22585 a useful contribution, however.
22586
22587 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22588 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22589 @cindex spam filtering
22590 @cindex spam
22591
22592 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22593 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22594 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22595 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22596 non-spam messages.
22597
22598 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22599 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22600 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22601 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22602 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22603
22604 @example
22605 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22606 (spam-initialize)
22607 @end example
22608
22609 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22610
22611 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22612 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22613 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22614 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22615 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22616
22617 You get the following keyboard commands:
22618
22619 @table @kbd
22620
22621 @item M-d
22622 @itemx M s x
22623 @itemx S x
22624 @kindex M-d
22625 @kindex S x
22626 @kindex M s x
22627 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22628 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22629
22630 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22631 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22632 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22633 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22634
22635 @item M s t
22636 @itemx S t
22637 @kindex M s t
22638 @kindex S t
22639 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22640 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22641
22642 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22643
22644 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22645
22646 @end table
22647
22648 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22649 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22650 group.
22651
22652 @menu
22653 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22654 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22655 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22656 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22657 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22658 * BBDB Whitelists::
22659 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22660 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22661 * Blackholes::
22662 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22663 * Bogofilter::
22664 * ifile spam filtering::
22665 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22666 * SpamOracle::
22667 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22668 @end menu
22669
22670 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22671 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22672 @cindex spam filtering
22673 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22674 @cindex spam
22675
22676 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22677 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22678
22679 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22680 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22681 leaving a group.
22682
22683 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22684 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22685 when you enter the group.
22686
22687 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22688 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22689 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22690 Incoming Mail}.
22691
22692 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22693 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22694 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22695 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22696 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22697 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22698 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22699 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22700 customize-variable} as usual).
22701
22702 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22703 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22704 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22705 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22706 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22707 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22708
22709 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22710 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22711 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22712 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22713 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22714 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22715 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22716 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22717 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22718
22719 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22720 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22721 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22722 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22723 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22724 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22725 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22726 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22727 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22728 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22729
22730 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22731 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22732 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22733 depending on the article's classification. If the
22734 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22735 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22736 current group.
22737
22738 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22739 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22740 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22741 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22742 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22743 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22744 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22745 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22746 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22747 which is what most people want. If the
22748 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22749 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22750
22751 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22752 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22753
22754 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22755 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22756 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22757 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22758 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22759 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22760 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22761 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22762 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22763 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22764 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22765
22766 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22767 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22768
22769 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22770 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22771 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22772
22773 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22774 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22775 @cindex spam filtering
22776 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22777 @cindex spam
22778
22779 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22780 must add the following to your fancy split list
22781 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22782
22783 @example
22784 (: spam-split)
22785 @end example
22786
22787 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22788 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22789 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22790
22791 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22792
22793 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22794 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22795 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22796 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22797 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22798 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22799 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22800 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22801 actually give you the group
22802 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22803 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22804
22805 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22806 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22807 this useful?
22808
22809 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22810 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22811
22812 @example
22813 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22814 (any "ding" "ding")
22815 (: spam-split)
22816 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22817 "mail")
22818 @end example
22819
22820 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22821 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22822 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22823 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22824 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22825 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22826
22827 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22828 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22829 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22830
22831 @example
22832 nnimap-split-fancy
22833 '(|
22834 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22835 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22836 (any "ding" "ding")
22837 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22838 (: spam-split)
22839 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22840 "mail")
22841 @end example
22842
22843 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22844 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22845 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22846 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22847 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22848 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22849 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22850
22851 You should still have specific checks such as
22852 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22853 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22854 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22855 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22856 is usually not critical, though.
22857
22858 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22859
22860 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22861 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22862 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22863 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22864 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22865 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22866 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22867 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22868
22869 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22870
22871 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22872 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22873 don't.}
22874
22875 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22876 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22877 @cindex spam filtering
22878 @cindex spam filtering variables
22879 @cindex spam variables
22880 @cindex spam
22881
22882 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22883 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22884 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22885 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22886 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22887 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
22888 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
22889 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
22890 will be detected later.
22891
22892 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
22893 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
22894 for more information.
22895
22896 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
22897 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
22898 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
22899 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
22900 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
22901 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
22902 by customizing the corresponding variable
22903 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
22904 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
22905 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
22906 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
22907 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
22908 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
22909 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
22910 default.
22911
22912 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
22913 @cindex $
22914 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
22915 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
22916 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
22917 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
22918 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
22919 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
22920 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
22921 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
22922 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
22923 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
22924 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
22925 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
22926 processor which will study them as spam samples.
22927
22928 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
22929 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
22930 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
22931 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
22932 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
22933 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
22934 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
22935 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
22936
22937 @defvar ham-marks
22938 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22939 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
22940 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
22941 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
22942 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
22943 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
22944 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
22945 happy for you.
22946 @end defvar
22947
22948 @defvar spam-marks
22949 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22950 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
22951 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
22952 you really want to.
22953 @end defvar
22954
22955 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
22956 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
22957 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
22958 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
22959 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
22960 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
22961 and nothing else.
22962
22963 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
22964 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
22965 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
22966 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
22967 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
22968 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
22969 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
22970 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
22971 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
22972 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
22973 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
22974 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
22975 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
22976 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
22977 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
22978
22979 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22980 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22981
22982 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
22983 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
22984 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
22985
22986 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
22987 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
22988
22989 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
22990 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
22991 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
22992 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
22993 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
22994
22995 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
22996 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
22997 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
22998 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
22999 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23000 it there.
23001
23002 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23003 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23004 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23005 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23006 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23007 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23008 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23009 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23010 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23011 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23012 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23013 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23014 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23015
23016 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23017 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23018
23019 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23020 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23021 training} groups.
23022
23023 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23024 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23025 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23026 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23027 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23028 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23029 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23030
23031 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23032 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23033 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23034 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23035
23036 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23037 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23038 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23039 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23040 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23041 from the mail server.
23042
23043 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23044 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23045 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23046 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23047
23048 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23049 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23050 @cindex spam filtering
23051 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23052 @cindex spam configuration examples
23053 @cindex spam
23054
23055 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23056
23057 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23058 @example
23059 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23060 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23061 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23062 (spam-initialize)
23063
23064 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23065 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23066
23067 (setq
23068 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23069 spam-use-BBDB t
23070 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23071 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23072 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23073 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23074 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23075 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23076 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23077 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23078 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23079 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23080 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23081 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23082 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23083 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23084 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23085 (any "ding" "ding")
23086 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23087 (: spam-split)
23088 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23089 "mail"))
23090
23091 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23092
23093 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23094 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23095 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23096 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23097
23098 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23099
23100 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23101 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23102 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23103 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23104 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23105
23106 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23107 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23108
23109 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23110
23111 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23112 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23113
23114 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23115 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23116 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23117
23118 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23119
23120 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23121 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23122
23123 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23124 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23125 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23126 (ham-marks
23127 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23128 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23129 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23130 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23131
23132 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23133 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23134 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23135
23136 @end example
23137
23138 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23139 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23140
23141 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23142 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23143 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23144 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23145 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23146 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23147 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23148 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23149 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23150
23151 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23152 does most of the job for me:
23153
23154 @lisp
23155 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23156 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23157 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23158 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23159 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23160 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23161 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23162 @end lisp
23163
23164 @itemize
23165
23166 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23167
23168 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23169 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23170 bogofilter or DCC).
23171
23172 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23173 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23174 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23175 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23176 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23177 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23178 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23179
23180 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23181 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23182 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23183 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23184 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23185 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23186
23187 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23188
23189 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23190 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23191 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23192 @samp{training.ham}.
23193 @end itemize
23194
23195 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23196
23197 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23198
23199 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23200 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23201 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23202
23203 @lisp
23204 ("^gmane\\."
23205 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23206 @end lisp
23207
23208 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23209 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23210 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23211 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23212 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23213
23214 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23215 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23216 @cindex spam filtering
23217 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23218 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23219 @cindex spam
23220
23221 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23222
23223 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23224 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23225 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23226 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23227 be spammers.
23228
23229 @end defvar
23230
23231 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23232
23233 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23234 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23235 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23236 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23237 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23238
23239 @end defvar
23240
23241 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23242
23243 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23244 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23245 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23246
23247 @end defvar
23248
23249 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23250
23251 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23252 customizing the group parameters or the
23253 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23254 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23255 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23256
23257 @emph{WARNING}
23258
23259 Instead of the obsolete
23260 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23261 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23262 the same way, we promise.
23263
23264 @end defvar
23265
23266 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23267
23268 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23269 customizing the group parameters or the
23270 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23271 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23272 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23273 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23274 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23275
23276 @emph{WARNING}
23277
23278 Instead of the obsolete
23279 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23280 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23281 the same way, we promise.
23282
23283 @end defvar
23284
23285 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23286 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23287 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23288 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23289 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23290
23291 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23292 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23293 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23294 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23295
23296 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23297 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23298 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23299 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23300 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23301 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23302
23303 @node BBDB Whitelists
23304 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23305 @cindex spam filtering
23306 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23307 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23308 @cindex spam
23309
23310 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23311
23312 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23313 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23314 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23315 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23316 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23317 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23318 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23319
23320 @end defvar
23321
23322 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23323
23324 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23325 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23326 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23327 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23328 classified as spammers.
23329
23330 @end defvar
23331
23332 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23333
23334 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23335 customizing the group parameters or the
23336 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23337 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23338 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23339 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23340 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23341
23342 @emph{WARNING}
23343
23344 Instead of the obsolete
23345 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23346 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23347 the same way, we promise.
23348
23349 @end defvar
23350
23351 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23352 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23353 @cindex spam reporting
23354 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23355 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23356 @cindex spam
23357
23358 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23359
23360 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23361 customizing the group parameters or the
23362 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23363 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23364 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23365 HTTP request.
23366
23367 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23368
23369 @emph{WARNING}
23370
23371 Instead of the obsolete
23372 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23373 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23374 same way, we promise.
23375
23376 @end defvar
23377
23378 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23379
23380 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23381 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23382 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23383 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23384 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23385 Gmane provides.
23386
23387 @end defvar
23388
23389 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23390 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23391 @cindex spam filtering
23392 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23393 @cindex spam
23394
23395 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23396
23397 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23398 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23399 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23400 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23401 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23402 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23403 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23404 ham.
23405
23406 @end defvar
23407
23408 @node Blackholes
23409 @subsubsection Blackholes
23410 @cindex spam filtering
23411 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23412 @cindex spam
23413
23414 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23415
23416 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23417 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23418 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23419 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23420 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23421 contains outdated servers.
23422
23423 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23424 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23425 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23426 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23427 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23428 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23429
23430 @end defvar
23431
23432 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23433
23434 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23435
23436 @end defvar
23437
23438 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23439
23440 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23441 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23442
23443 @end defvar
23444
23445 @defvar spam-use-dig
23446
23447 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23448 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23449
23450 @end defvar
23451
23452 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23453 ham processor for blackholes.
23454
23455 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23456 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23457 @cindex spam filtering
23458 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23459 @cindex spam
23460
23461 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23462
23463 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23464 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23465 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23466 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23467 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23468 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23469
23470 @end defvar
23471
23472 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23473
23474 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23475 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23476
23477 @end defvar
23478
23479 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23480
23481 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23482 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23483
23484 @end defvar
23485
23486 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23487 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23488
23489 @node Bogofilter
23490 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23491 @cindex spam filtering
23492 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23493 @cindex spam
23494
23495 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23496
23497 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23498 speedy Bogofilter.
23499
23500 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23501 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23502 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23503 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23504 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23505 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23506
23507 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23508 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23509 documentation.
23510
23511 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23512 processing will be turned off.
23513
23514 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23515
23516 @end defvar
23517
23518 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23519
23520 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23521 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23522 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23523 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23524 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23525 installation documents for details.
23526
23527 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23528
23529 @end defvar
23530
23531 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23532 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23533 customizing the group parameters or the
23534 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23535 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23536 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23537
23538 @emph{WARNING}
23539
23540 Instead of the obsolete
23541 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23542 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23543 the same way, we promise.
23544 @end defvar
23545
23546 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23547 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23548 customizing the group parameters or the
23549 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23550 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23551 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23552 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23553 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23554
23555 @emph{WARNING}
23556
23557 Instead of the obsolete
23558 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23559 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23560 the same way, we promise.
23561 @end defvar
23562
23563 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23564
23565 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23566 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23567 database directory.
23568
23569 @end defvar
23570
23571 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23572 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23573 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23574 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23575 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23576 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23577
23578 @node ifile spam filtering
23579 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23580 @cindex spam filtering
23581 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23582 @cindex spam
23583
23584 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23585
23586 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23587 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23588
23589 @end defvar
23590
23591 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23592
23593 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23594 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23595 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23596
23597 @end defvar
23598
23599 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23600
23601 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23602 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23603 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23604 @end defvar
23605
23606 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23607
23608 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23609 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23610
23611 @end defvar
23612
23613 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23614 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23615 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23616 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23617 functionality.
23618
23619 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23620 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23621 @cindex spam filtering
23622 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23623 @cindex spam-stat
23624 @cindex spam
23625
23626 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23627
23628 @defvar spam-use-stat
23629
23630 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23631 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23632
23633 @end defvar
23634
23635 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23636 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23637 customizing the group parameters or the
23638 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23639 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23640 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23641
23642 @emph{WARNING}
23643
23644 Instead of the obsolete
23645 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23646 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23647 the same way, we promise.
23648 @end defvar
23649
23650 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23651 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23652 customizing the group parameters or the
23653 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23654 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23655 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23656 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23657 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23658
23659 @emph{WARNING}
23660
23661 Instead of the obsolete
23662 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23663 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23664 the same way, we promise.
23665 @end defvar
23666
23667 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23668 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23669 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23670 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23671 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23672
23673 @node SpamOracle
23674 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23675 @cindex spam filtering
23676 @cindex SpamOracle
23677 @cindex spam
23678
23679 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23680 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23681 installed separately.
23682
23683 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23684 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23685 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23686 mail as a spam mail or not.
23687
23688 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23689 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23690 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23691
23692 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23693 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23694
23695 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23696 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23697 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23698 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23699 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23700 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23701 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23702 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23703 in @samp{INBOX}:
23704
23705 @example
23706 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23707 spam-split-group "Junk"
23708 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23709 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23710 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23711 @end example
23712
23713 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23714 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23715 SpamOracle.
23716 @end defvar
23717
23718 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23719 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23720 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23721 can be customized.
23722 @end defvar
23723
23724 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23725 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23726 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23727 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23728 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23729 database to live somewhere special, set
23730 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23731 @end defvar
23732
23733 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23734 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23735 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23736 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23737 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23738 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23739 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23740 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23741 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23742 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23743
23744 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23745 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23746 customizing the group parameter or the
23747 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23748 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23749 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23750
23751 @emph{WARNING}
23752
23753 Instead of the obsolete
23754 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23755 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23756 the same way, we promise.
23757 @end defvar
23758
23759 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23760 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23761 customizing the group parameter or the
23762 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23763 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23764 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23765 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23766 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23767
23768 @emph{WARNING}
23769
23770 Instead of the obsolete
23771 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23772 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23773 the same way, we promise.
23774 @end defvar
23775
23776 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23777 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23778 messages.
23779 @example
23780 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23781 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23782 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23783 @end example
23784 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23785 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23786 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23787 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23788 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23789 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23790
23791 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23792 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23793 @cindex spam filtering
23794 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23795 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23796
23797 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23798 incoming mail, provide the following:
23799
23800 @enumerate
23801
23802 @item
23803 Code
23804
23805 @lisp
23806 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23807 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23808 @end lisp
23809
23810 Add
23811 @lisp
23812 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23813 @end lisp
23814 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23815
23816 Add
23817 @lisp
23818 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23819 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23820 @end lisp
23821
23822 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23823
23824 Add
23825 @lisp
23826 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23827 nil
23828 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23829 nil)
23830 @end lisp
23831
23832 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23833 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23834 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23835 Blackbox.
23836
23837 @item
23838 Functionality
23839
23840 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23841 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23842 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23843 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23844 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23845
23846 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23847 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23848 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23849
23850 @end enumerate
23851
23852 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23853
23854 @enumerate
23855
23856 @item
23857 Code
23858
23859 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23860 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23861
23862 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23863 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23864 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23865 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23866
23867 @lisp
23868 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23869 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23870 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23871
23872 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23873 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23874 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23875
23876 @end lisp
23877
23878 @item
23879 Gnus parameters
23880
23881 Add
23882 @lisp
23883 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23884 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23885 @end lisp
23886 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23887 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
23888 variable customization.
23889
23890 Add
23891 @lisp
23892 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
23893 @end lisp
23894 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
23895 @code{gnus.el}.
23896
23897 @end enumerate
23898
23899
23900 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23901 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23902 @cindex Paul Graham
23903 @cindex Graham, Paul
23904 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
23905 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
23906 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
23907
23908 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
23909 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
23910 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
23911 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
23912 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
23913 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
23914 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
23915 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
23916 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
23917 or not.
23918
23919 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
23920 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
23921 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
23922 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
23923 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
23924 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
23925 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
23926 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
23927
23928 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
23929 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
23930 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
23931 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
23932 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
23933
23934 @menu
23935 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
23936 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
23937 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
23938 @end menu
23939
23940 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23941 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23942
23943 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
23944 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
23945 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
23946 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
23947 need several hundred emails in both collections.
23948
23949 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
23950 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
23951 per mail. Use the following:
23952
23953 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
23954 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
23955 is treated as one spam mail.
23956 @end defun
23957
23958 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
23959 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
23960 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
23961 @end defun
23962
23963 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
23964 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
23965 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
23966 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
23967 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
23968 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
23969
23970 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
23971 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
23972 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
23973 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
23974 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
23975
23976 @defvar spam-stat
23977 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
23978 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
23979 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
23980 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
23981 @end defvar
23982
23983 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
23984 reset the dictionary.
23985
23986 @defun spam-stat-reset
23987 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
23988 @end defun
23989
23990 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
23991 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
23992 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
23993 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
23994 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
23995 only non-spam mails.
23996
23997 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
23998 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
23999 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24000 @end defun
24001
24002 @defun spam-stat-save
24003 Save the dictionary.
24004 @end defun
24005
24006 @defvar spam-stat-file
24007 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24008 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24009 @end defvar
24010
24011 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24012 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24013
24014 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24015 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24016
24017 @lisp
24018 (require 'spam-stat)
24019 (spam-stat-load)
24020 @end lisp
24021
24022 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24023 created.
24024
24025 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24026 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24027 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24028 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24029
24030 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24031 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24032 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24033 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24034
24035 @lisp
24036 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24037 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24038 "mail.misc"))
24039 @end lisp
24040
24041 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24042 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24043 @end defvar
24044
24045 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24046 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24047 expression are considered potential spam.
24048
24049 @lisp
24050 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24051 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24052 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24053 "mail.misc"))
24054 @end lisp
24055
24056 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24057 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24058 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24059 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24060 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24061
24062 @lisp
24063 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24064 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24065 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24066 "mail.misc"))
24067 @end lisp
24068
24069 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24070 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24071 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24072 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24073 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24074 dictionary!
24075
24076 @lisp
24077 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24078 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24079 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24080 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24081 "mail.misc"))
24082 @end lisp
24083
24084
24085 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24086 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24087
24088 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24089
24090 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24091 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24092 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24093 @end defun
24094
24095 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24096 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24097 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24098 @end defun
24099
24100 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24101 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24102 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24103 already been processed as non-spam.
24104 @end defun
24105
24106 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24107 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24108 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24109 been processed as spam.
24110 @end defun
24111
24112 @defun spam-stat-save
24113 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24114 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24115 @end defun
24116
24117 @defun spam-stat-load
24118 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24119 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24120 @end defun
24121
24122 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24123 Return the spam score for a word.
24124 @end defun
24125
24126 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24127 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24128 @end defun
24129
24130 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24131 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24132 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24133 @end defun
24134
24135 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24136 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24137
24138 @lisp
24139 (require 'spam-stat)
24140 (spam-stat-load)
24141 @end lisp
24142
24143 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24144
24145 @smallexample
24146 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24147 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24148 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24149 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24150 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24151 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24152 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24153 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24154 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24155 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24156 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24157 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24158 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24159 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24160 @end smallexample
24161
24162 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24163
24164 @smallexample
24165 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24166 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24167 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24168 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24169 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24170 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24171 @end smallexample
24172
24173 @node Other modes
24174 @section Interaction with other modes
24175
24176 @subsection Dired
24177 @cindex dired
24178
24179 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24180 buffers. It is enabled with
24181 @lisp
24182 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24183 @end lisp
24184
24185 @table @kbd
24186 @item C-c C-m C-a
24187 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24188 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24189 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24190
24191 @item C-c C-m C-l
24192 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24193 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24194 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24195 buffer.
24196
24197 @item C-c C-m C-p
24198 @findex gnus-dired-print
24199 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24200 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24201 @end table
24202
24203 @node Various Various
24204 @section Various Various
24205 @cindex mode lines
24206 @cindex highlights
24207
24208 @table @code
24209
24210 @item gnus-home-directory
24211 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24212 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24213 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24214
24215 @item gnus-directory
24216 @vindex gnus-directory
24217 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24218 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24219 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24220
24221 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24222 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24223 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24224 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24225
24226 @item gnus-default-directory
24227 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24228 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24229 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24230 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24231 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24232 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24233 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24234
24235 @item gnus-verbose
24236 @vindex gnus-verbose
24237 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24238 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24239 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24240 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24241 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24242
24243 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24244 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24245 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24246 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24247
24248 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24249 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24250 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24251 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
24252 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24253 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24254 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24255 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24256 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24257 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24258
24259 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24260 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24261 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24262 read when doing the operation described above.
24263
24264 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24265 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24266 @cindex file names
24267 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24268 @cindex characters in file names
24269 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24270 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24271 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24272
24273 @lisp
24274 @group
24275 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24276 '((?: . ?_)))
24277 @end group
24278 @end lisp
24279
24280 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24281 Windows (phooey) systems.
24282
24283 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24284 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24285 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24286 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24287 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24288
24289 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24290 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24291 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24292 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24293 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24294
24295 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24296 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24297 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24298
24299 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24300 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24301
24302 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24303 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24304 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24305 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24306 group).
24307
24308 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24309
24310
24311 @end table
24312
24313 @node The End
24314 @chapter The End
24315
24316 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24317 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24318
24319 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24320
24321 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24322
24323 @quotation
24324 @strong{Te Deum}
24325
24326 @sp 1
24327 Not because of victories @*
24328 I sing,@*
24329 having none,@*
24330 but for the common sunshine,@*
24331 the breeze,@*
24332 the largess of the spring.
24333
24334 @sp 1
24335 Not for victory@*
24336 but for the day's work done@*
24337 as well as I was able;@*
24338 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24339 but at the common table.@*
24340 @end quotation
24341
24342
24343 @node Appendices
24344 @chapter Appendices
24345
24346 @menu
24347 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24348 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24349 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24350 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24351 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24352 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24353 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24354 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24355 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24356 @end menu
24357
24358
24359 @node XEmacs
24360 @section XEmacs
24361 @cindex XEmacs
24362 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24363
24364 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24365 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24366 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24367 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24368 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{w3},
24369 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24370
24371
24372 @node History
24373 @section History
24374
24375 @cindex history
24376 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24377 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24378
24379 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24380 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24381 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24382 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24383 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24384
24385 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24386 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24387 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24388 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24389 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24390 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24391
24392 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24393 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24394 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24395 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24396
24397 @menu
24398 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24399 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24400 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24401 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24402 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24403 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24404 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24405 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24406 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24407 @end menu
24408
24409
24410 @node Gnus Versions
24411 @subsection Gnus Versions
24412 @cindex ding Gnus
24413 @cindex September Gnus
24414 @cindex Red Gnus
24415 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24416 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24417 @cindex Oort Gnus
24418 @cindex No Gnus
24419 @cindex Gnus versions
24420
24421 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24422 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24423 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24424
24425 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24426 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24427
24428 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24429 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24430
24431 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24432 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24433
24434 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24435 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24436 1999.
24437
24438 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
24439
24440 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24441 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24442 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
24443 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
24444 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
24445 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24446
24447
24448 @node Other Gnus Versions
24449 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24450 @cindex Semi-gnus
24451
24452 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24453 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24454 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24455 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24456
24457 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24458 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24459 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24460 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24461 Japanese users.
24462
24463
24464 @node Why?
24465 @subsection Why?
24466
24467 What's the point of Gnus?
24468
24469 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24470 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24471 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24472 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24473 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24474 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24475 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24476 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24477 keep track of millions of people who post?
24478
24479 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24480 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24481 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24482 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24483 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24484 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24485 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24486 every one of you to explore and invent.
24487
24488 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24489 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24490
24491
24492 @node Compatibility
24493 @subsection Compatibility
24494
24495 @cindex compatibility
24496 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24497 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24498 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24499
24500 Our motto is:
24501 @quotation
24502 @cartouche
24503 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24504 @end cartouche
24505 @end quotation
24506
24507 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24508 their names.
24509
24510 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24511 Articles}.
24512
24513 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24514 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24515 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24516 important variables have their values copied into their global
24517 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24518 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24519
24520 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24521 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24522 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24523 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24524 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24525 peculiar results.
24526
24527 @cindex hilit19
24528 @cindex highlighting
24529 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24530 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24531 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24532 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24533 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24534 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24535 Away!
24536
24537 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24538 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24539 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24540 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24541
24542 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24543 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24544 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24545 to stop doing it the old way.
24546
24547 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24548
24549 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24550 @findex gnus-bug
24551 @cindex reporting bugs
24552 @cindex bugs
24553 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24554 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24555 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24556
24557 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24558 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24559 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24560 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24561 up at you.
24562
24563
24564 @node Conformity
24565 @subsection Conformity
24566
24567 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24568 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24569 with, of course.
24570
24571 @table @strong
24572
24573 @item RFC (2)822
24574 @cindex RFC 822
24575 @cindex RFC 2822
24576 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24577
24578 @item RFC 1036
24579 @cindex RFC 1036
24580 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24581
24582 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24583 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24584 We do have some breaches to this one.
24585
24586 @table @emph
24587
24588 @item X-Newsreader
24589 @itemx User-Agent
24590 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24591 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24592 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24593 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24594 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24595 @end table
24596
24597 @item USEFOR
24598 @cindex USEFOR
24599 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24600 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24601 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24602 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24603
24604 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24605 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24606 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24607
24608 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24609 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24610
24611 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24612 @cindex RFC 1991
24613 @cindex RFC 2440
24614 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24615 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24616 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24617 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24618 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24619 decryption).
24620
24621 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24622 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24623 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24624 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24625
24626 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24627 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24628
24629 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24630 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24631 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24632 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24633 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24634 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24635 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24636 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24637
24638 @end table
24639
24640 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24641 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24642 know.
24643
24644
24645 @node Emacsen
24646 @subsection Emacsen
24647 @cindex Emacsen
24648 @cindex XEmacs
24649 @cindex Mule
24650 @cindex Emacs
24651
24652 Gnus should work on:
24653
24654 @itemize @bullet
24655
24656 @item
24657 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24658
24659 @item
24660 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24661
24662 @end itemize
24663
24664 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24665 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24666 Emacs versions.
24667
24668 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24669 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24670 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24671 Emacsen.
24672
24673
24674 @node Gnus Development
24675 @subsection Gnus Development
24676
24677 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24678 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24679 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24680 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24681 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24682 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24683 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24684 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24685
24686 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24687 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24688 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24689 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24690 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24691
24692 @cindex Incoming*
24693 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24694 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24695 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24696 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24697 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24698
24699 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24700 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24701 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24702 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24703 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24704 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24705 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24706 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24707 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24708 can't be assumed to do so.
24709
24710
24711
24712 @node Contributors
24713 @subsection Contributors
24714 @cindex contributors
24715
24716 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24717 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24718 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24719 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24720 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24721 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24722 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24723 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24724 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24725 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24726
24727 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24728 wrong show.
24729
24730 @itemize @bullet
24731
24732 @item
24733 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24734
24735 @item
24736 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24737 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24738 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24739 functionality and stuff.
24740
24741 @item
24742 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24743 well as numerous other things).
24744
24745 @item
24746 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24747
24748 @item
24749 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24750
24751 @item
24752 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24753
24754 @item
24755 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24756
24757 @item
24758 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24759 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24760
24761 @item
24762 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24763
24764 @item
24765 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24766 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24767
24768 @item
24769 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24770
24771 @item
24772 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24773
24774 @item
24775 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24776
24777 @item
24778 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24779
24780 @item
24781 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24782 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24783
24784 @item
24785 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24786
24787 @item
24788 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24789
24790 @item
24791 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24792
24793 @item
24794 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24795 .newsrc files.
24796
24797 @item
24798 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24799
24800 @item
24801 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24802
24803 @item
24804 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24805
24806 @item
24807 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24808 well as autoconf support.
24809
24810 @end itemize
24811
24812 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24813 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24814
24815 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24816
24817 Christopher Davis,
24818 Andrew Eskilsson,
24819 Kai Grossjohann,
24820 Kevin Greiner,
24821 Jesper Harder,
24822 Paul Jarc,
24823 Simon Josefsson,
24824 David KÃ¥gedal,
24825 Richard Pieri,
24826 Fabrice Popineau,
24827 Daniel Quinlan,
24828 Michael Shields,
24829 Reiner Steib,
24830 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24831 Jack Vinson,
24832 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24833 and
24834 Teodor Zlatanov.
24835
24836 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24837
24838 Jari Aalto,
24839 Adrian Aichner,
24840 Vladimir Alexiev,
24841 Russ Allbery,
24842 Peter Arius,
24843 Matt Armstrong,
24844 Marc Auslander,
24845 Miles Bader,
24846 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24847 Frank Bennett,
24848 Robert Bihlmeyer,
24849 Chris Bone,
24850 Mark Borges,
24851 Mark Boyns,
24852 Lance A. Brown,
24853 Rob Browning,
24854 Kees de Bruin,
24855 Martin Buchholz,
24856 Joe Buehler,
24857 Kevin Buhr,
24858 Alastair Burt,
24859 Joao Cachopo,
24860 Zlatko Calusic,
24861 Massimo Campostrini,
24862 Castor,
24863 David Charlap,
24864 Dan Christensen,
24865 Kevin Christian,
24866 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24867 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24868 Laura Conrad,
24869 Michael R. Cook,
24870 Glenn Coombs,
24871 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24872 Neil Crellin,
24873 Frank D. Cringle,
24874 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24875 Andre Deparade,
24876 Ulrik Dickow,
24877 Dave Disser,
24878 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
24879 Joev Dubach,
24880 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24881 Dave Edmondson,
24882 Paul Eggert,
24883 Mark W. Eichin,
24884 Karl Eichwalder,
24885 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
24886 Michael Ernst,
24887 Luc Van Eycken,
24888 Sam Falkner,
24889 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
24890 Sigbjorn Finne,
24891 Sven Fischer,
24892 Paul Fisher,
24893 Decklin Foster,
24894 Gary D. Foster,
24895 Paul Franklin,
24896 Guy Geens,
24897 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
24898 David S. Goldberg,
24899 Michelangelo Grigni,
24900 Dale Hagglund,
24901 D. Hall,
24902 Magnus Hammerin,
24903 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
24904 Raja R. Harinath,
24905 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
24906 P. E. Jareth Hein,
24907 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
24908 Scott Hofmann,
24909 Marc Horowitz,
24910 Gunnar Horrigmo,
24911 Richard Hoskins,
24912 Brad Howes,
24913 Miguel de Icaza,
24914 François Felix Ingrand,
24915 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
24916 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
24917 Lee Iverson,
24918 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
24919 Rajappa Iyer,
24920 Andreas Jaeger,
24921 Adam P. Jenkins,
24922 Randell Jesup,
24923 Fred Johansen,
24924 Gareth Jones,
24925 Greg Klanderman,
24926 Karl Kleinpaste,
24927 Michael Klingbeil,
24928 Peter Skov Knudsen,
24929 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
24930 Petr Konecny,
24931 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
24932 Thor Kristoffersen,
24933 Jens Lautenbacher,
24934 Martin Larose,
24935 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
24936 Joerg Lenneis,
24937 Carsten Leonhardt,
24938 James LewisMoss,
24939 Christian Limpach,
24940 Markus Linnala,
24941 Dave Love,
24942 Mike McEwan,
24943 Tonny Madsen,
24944 Shlomo Mahlab,
24945 Nat Makarevitch,
24946 Istvan Marko,
24947 David Martin,
24948 Jason R. Mastaler,
24949 Gordon Matzigkeit,
24950 Timo Metzemakers,
24951 Richard Mlynarik,
24952 Lantz Moore,
24953 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
24954 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
24955 Hrvoje Niksic,
24956 Andy Norman,
24957 Fred Oberhauser,
24958 C. R. Oldham,
24959 Alexandre Oliva,
24960 Ken Olstad,
24961 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
24962 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
24963 Ettore Perazzoli,
24964 William Perry,
24965 Stephen Peters,
24966 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
24967 Ulrich Pfeifer,
24968 Matt Pharr,
24969 Andy Piper,
24970 John McClary Prevost,
24971 Bill Pringlemeir,
24972 Mike Pullen,
24973 Jim Radford,
24974 Colin Rafferty,
24975 Lasse Rasinen,
24976 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
24977 Joe Reiss,
24978 Renaud Rioboo,
24979 Roland B. Roberts,
24980 Bart Robinson,
24981 Christian von Roques,
24982 Markus Rost,
24983 Jason Rumney,
24984 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
24985 Jay Sachs,
24986 Dewey M. Sasser,
24987 Conrad Sauerwald,
24988 Loren Schall,
24989 Dan Schmidt,
24990 Ralph Schleicher,
24991 Philippe Schnoebelen,
24992 Andreas Schwab,
24993 Randal L. Schwartz,
24994 Danny Siu,
24995 Matt Simmons,
24996 Paul D. Smith,
24997 Jeff Sparkes,
24998 Toby Speight,
24999 Michael Sperber,
25000 Darren Stalder,
25001 Richard Stallman,
25002 Greg Stark,
25003 Sam Steingold,
25004 Paul Stevenson,
25005 Jonas Steverud,
25006 Paul Stodghill,
25007 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25008 Kurt Swanson,
25009 Samuel Tardieu,
25010 Teddy,
25011 Chuck Thompson,
25012 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25013 Philippe Troin,
25014 James Troup,
25015 Trung Tran-Duc,
25016 Jack Twilley,
25017 Aaron M. Ucko,
25018 Aki Vehtari,
25019 Didier Verna,
25020 Vladimir Volovich,
25021 Jan Vroonhof,
25022 Stefan Waldherr,
25023 Pete Ware,
25024 Barry A. Warsaw,
25025 Christoph Wedler,
25026 Joe Wells,
25027 Lee Willis,
25028 and
25029 Lloyd Zusman.
25030
25031
25032 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25033 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25034 (550kB and counting).
25035
25036 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25037 sure.
25038
25039 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25040 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25041
25042
25043 @node New Features
25044 @subsection New Features
25045 @cindex new features
25046
25047 @menu
25048 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25049 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25050 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25051 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25052 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25053 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10.
25054 @end menu
25055
25056 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25057 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25058 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25059
25060 @node ding Gnus
25061 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25062
25063 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25064
25065 @itemize @bullet
25066
25067 @item
25068 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25069 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25070
25071 @item
25072 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25073 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25074
25075 @item
25076 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25077
25078 @item
25079 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25080 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25081 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25082
25083 @item
25084 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25085 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25086 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25087 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25088
25089 @item
25090 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25091 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25092
25093 @item
25094 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25095 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25096 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25097
25098 @item
25099 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25100 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25101
25102 @item
25103 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25104 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25105 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25106
25107 @item
25108 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25109 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25110 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25111
25112 @item
25113 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25114 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25115
25116 @item
25117 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25118 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25119
25120 @item
25121 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25122 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25123
25124 @item
25125 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25126 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25127
25128 @item
25129 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25130 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25131
25132 @item
25133 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25134 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25135
25136 @item
25137 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25138
25139 @item
25140 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25141 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25142
25143 @item
25144 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25145 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25146
25147 @item
25148 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25149 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25150
25151 @item
25152 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25153
25154 @item
25155 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25156 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25157
25158 @item
25159 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25160 Articles}).
25161
25162 @item
25163 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25164 Buttons}).
25165
25166 @item
25167 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25168 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25169
25170 @item
25171 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25172 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25173
25174 @end itemize
25175
25176
25177 @node September Gnus
25178 @subsubsection September Gnus
25179
25180 @iftex
25181 @iflatex
25182 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25183 @end iflatex
25184 @end iftex
25185
25186 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25187
25188 @itemize @bullet
25189
25190 @item
25191 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25192 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25193 now obsolete.
25194
25195 @item
25196 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25197 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25198 Threading}).
25199
25200 @lisp
25201 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25202 @end lisp
25203
25204 @item
25205 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25206 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25207
25208 @item
25209 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25210 referred.
25211
25212 @item
25213 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25214
25215 @item
25216 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25217
25218 @item
25219 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25220
25221 @lisp
25222 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25223 @end lisp
25224
25225 @item
25226 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25227 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25228
25229 @lisp
25230 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25231 @end lisp
25232
25233 @item
25234 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25235 Groups}).
25236
25237 @item
25238 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25239 Topics}).
25240
25241 @lisp
25242 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25243 @end lisp
25244
25245 @item
25246 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25247
25248 @item
25249 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25250 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25251
25252 @lisp
25253 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25254 @end lisp
25255
25256 @item
25257 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25258 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25259
25260 @item
25261 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25262
25263 @item
25264 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25265 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25266 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25267
25268 @item
25269 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25270 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25271
25272 @item
25273 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25274
25275 @item
25276 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25277 Groups}).
25278
25279 @item
25280 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25281 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25282
25283 @item
25284 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25285 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25286
25287 @item
25288 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25289 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25290
25291 @item
25292 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25293 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25294 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25295
25296 @item
25297 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25298 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25299
25300 @item
25301 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25302
25303 @item
25304 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25305
25306 @item
25307 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25308
25309 @item
25310 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25311
25312 @item
25313 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25314 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25315
25316 @item
25317 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25318 Layout}).
25319
25320 @item
25321 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25322 @iftex
25323 @iflatex
25324 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25325 @end iflatex
25326 @end iftex
25327
25328 @item
25329 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25330
25331 @lisp
25332 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25333 @end lisp
25334
25335 @item
25336 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25337
25338 @lisp
25339 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25340 @end lisp
25341
25342 @item
25343 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25344
25345 @item
25346 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25347
25348 @item
25349 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25350 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25351
25352 @lisp
25353 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25354 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25355 @end lisp
25356
25357 @item
25358 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25359 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25360
25361 @lisp
25362 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25363 @end lisp
25364
25365 @item
25366 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25367 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25368
25369 @item
25370 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25371
25372 @item
25373 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25374 Articles}).
25375
25376 @lisp
25377 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25378 @end lisp
25379
25380 @item
25381 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25382 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25383
25384 @lisp
25385 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25386 @end lisp
25387
25388 @item
25389 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25390 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25391
25392 @item
25393 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25394 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25395
25396 @lisp
25397 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25398 @end lisp
25399
25400 @item
25401 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25402
25403 @item
25404 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25405
25406 @item
25407 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25408
25409 @end itemize
25410
25411
25412 @node Red Gnus
25413 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25414
25415 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25416
25417 @iftex
25418 @iflatex
25419 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25420 @end iflatex
25421 @end iftex
25422
25423 @itemize @bullet
25424
25425 @item
25426 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25427
25428 @item
25429 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25430 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25431
25432 @item
25433 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25434 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25435 Scoring}).
25436
25437 @item
25438 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25439 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25440
25441 @item
25442 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25443
25444 @item
25445 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25446 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25447
25448 @lisp
25449 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25450 @end lisp
25451
25452 @item
25453 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25454 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25455 been added.
25456
25457 @item
25458 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25459 Server Internals}).
25460
25461 @item
25462 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25463 Parameters}).
25464
25465 @item
25466 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25467
25468 @item
25469 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25470 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25471
25472 @item
25473 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25474 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25475 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25476
25477 @item
25478 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25479 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25480
25481 @item
25482 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25483 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25484
25485 @item
25486 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25487 (@pxref{Undo}).
25488
25489 @item
25490 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25491 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25492
25493 @item
25494 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25495 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25496
25497 @lisp
25498 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25499 @end lisp
25500
25501 @item
25502 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25503
25504 @lisp
25505 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25506 @end lisp
25507
25508 @item
25509 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25510 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25511
25512 @item
25513 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25514 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25515
25516 @item
25517 A new command for reading collections of documents
25518 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25519 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25520
25521 @item
25522 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25523 Marks}).
25524
25525 @item
25526 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25527 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25528
25529 @item
25530 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25531 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25532 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25533
25534 @item
25535 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25536 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25537 Sorting}).
25538
25539 @item
25540 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25541 Groups}).
25542
25543 @item
25544 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25545 Commands}).
25546 @iftex
25547 @iflatex
25548 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25549 @end iflatex
25550 @end iftex
25551
25552 @item
25553 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25554 Variables}).
25555
25556 @item
25557 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25558 Mail}).
25559
25560 @item
25561 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25562 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25563
25564 @item
25565 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25566
25567 @end itemize
25568
25569
25570 @node Quassia Gnus
25571 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25572
25573 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25574
25575 @itemize @bullet
25576
25577 @item
25578 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25579 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25580 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25581
25582 @item
25583 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25584 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25585 group, which is created automatically.
25586
25587 @item
25588 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25589 values.
25590
25591 @item
25592 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25593
25594 @item
25595 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25596 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25597
25598 @item
25599 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25600 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25601
25602 @item
25603 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25604
25605 @item
25606 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25607 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25608
25609 @item
25610 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25611
25612 @item
25613 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25614 details.
25615
25616 @item
25617 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25618 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25619
25620 @item
25621 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25622 control over simplification.
25623
25624 @item
25625 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25626
25627 @item
25628 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25629 limit.
25630
25631 @item
25632 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25633
25634 @item
25635 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25636
25637 @item
25638 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25639 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25640 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25641
25642 @item
25643 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25644 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25645
25646 @item
25647 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25648 text---@kbd{W d}.
25649
25650 @item
25651 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25652 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25653
25654 @item
25655 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25656 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25657
25658 @item
25659 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25660 has been added.
25661
25662 @item
25663 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25664
25665 @item
25666 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25667
25668 @item
25669 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25670 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25671
25672 @item
25673 A new function for citing in Message has been
25674 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25675
25676 @item
25677 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25678
25679 @item
25680 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25681 been added.
25682
25683 @item
25684 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25685 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25686
25687 @item
25688 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25689 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25690
25691 @item
25692 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25693
25694 @item
25695 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25696
25697 @end itemize
25698
25699 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25700 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25701
25702 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25703
25704 @itemize @bullet
25705
25706 @item
25707 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25708 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25709
25710 If you used procmail like in
25711
25712 @lisp
25713 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25714 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25715 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25716 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25717 @end lisp
25718
25719 this now has changed to
25720
25721 @lisp
25722 (setq mail-sources
25723 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25724 :suffix ".in")))
25725 @end lisp
25726
25727 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25728
25729 @item
25730 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25731 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25732
25733 @item
25734 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25735 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25736
25737 @item
25738 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25739 called to position point.
25740
25741 @item
25742 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25743 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25744
25745 @item
25746 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25747 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25748
25749 @item
25750 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25751 subtly different manner.
25752
25753 @item
25754 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25755 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25756 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25757
25758 @item
25759 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25760
25761 @end itemize
25762
25763 @node Oort Gnus
25764 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25765 @cindex Oort Gnus
25766
25767 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25768
25769 @itemize @bullet
25770
25771 @item
25772 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25773 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25774 region if the region is active.
25775
25776 @item
25777 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25778 using @kbd{G M}.
25779
25780 @item
25781 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25782 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25783
25784 @item
25785 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25786 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25787
25788 @item
25789 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25790
25791 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25792 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25793 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25794 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25795 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25796 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25797 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25798 isn't save in general.
25799
25800 @item
25801 Article Buttons
25802
25803 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25804 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25805 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25806 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25807
25808 @item
25809 Dired integration
25810
25811 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25812 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25813 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25814 entry.
25815
25816 @item
25817 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25818
25819 @item
25820 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25821
25822 @item
25823 Picons
25824
25825 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25826 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25827
25828 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25829 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25830 @xref{Picons}.
25831
25832 @item
25833 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25834 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25835
25836 @item
25837 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25838
25839 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25840 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25841
25842 @item
25843 Delayed articles
25844
25845 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25846 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25847 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25848
25849 @item
25850 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25851 decompressed when activated.
25852
25853 @item
25854 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25855 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25856
25857 @item
25858 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25859
25860 @item
25861 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25862 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25863
25864 @item
25865 Warn about email replies to news
25866
25867 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25868 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25869 you.
25870
25871 @item
25872 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25873 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25874 built.
25875
25876 @item
25877 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25878 opposed to old but unread messages).
25879
25880 @item
25881 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25882 Gcc articles as read.
25883
25884 @item
25885 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
25886
25887 @item
25888 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
25889 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
25890
25891 @item
25892 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
25893 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
25894
25895 @item
25896 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
25897 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
25898
25899 @item
25900 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
25901 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
25902
25903 @item
25904 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
25905
25906 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
25907 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
25908 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
25909 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
25910
25911 @item
25912 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
25913
25914 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
25915 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
25916 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
25917 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
25918 the second parameter.
25919
25920 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
25921 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
25922 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
25923 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
25924 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
25925 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
25926 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
25927 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
25928 cycle used under Unix systems.
25929
25930 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
25931 been removed.
25932
25933 @item
25934 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
25935
25936 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
25937 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
25938 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
25939 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
25940 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
25941 controls this.
25942
25943 @item
25944 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
25945
25946 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
25947 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
25948 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
25949 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
25950 citations.
25951
25952 @item
25953 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
25954
25955 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
25956 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
25957 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
25958 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
25959
25960 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
25961 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
25962 message cited below.
25963
25964 @item
25965 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
25966
25967 @item
25968 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
25969
25970 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
25971 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
25972 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
25973 variable in @file{~/.emacs} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
25974 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
25975 parameters, a'la:
25976 @lisp
25977 (setq gnus-parameters
25978 '(("mail\\..*"
25979 (gnus-show-threads nil)
25980 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
25981 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
25982 (to-group . "\\1"))))
25983 @end lisp
25984
25985 @item
25986 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
25987
25988 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.emacs} to
25989 disable it.
25990
25991 @item
25992 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
25993
25994 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
25995 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
25996 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
25997 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
25998 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
25999 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26000 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26001 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26002 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26003
26004 @item
26005 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26006
26007 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26008 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26009 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26010 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26011 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26012 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26013
26014 @item
26015 References and X-Draft-Headers are no longer generated when you start
26016 composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26017 @code{nil}.
26018
26019 @item
26020 Improved anti-spam features.
26021
26022 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26023 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26024 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26025 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26026 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26027
26028 @item
26029 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26030
26031 @item
26032 Face headers handling.
26033
26034 @item
26035 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26036 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26037
26038 @item
26039 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26040
26041 @item
26042 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26043
26044 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26045 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26046 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26047 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26048 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26049 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26050 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26051 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26052 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26053
26054 @item
26055 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26056
26057 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26058 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26059 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26060 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26061 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26062 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26063 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26064 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26065 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26066 was inserted directly.
26067
26068 @item
26069 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26070
26071 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26072 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26073 hierarchy.
26074
26075 @item
26076 @code{gnus-agent}
26077
26078 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26079 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26080 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26081 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26082 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26083 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26084 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26085 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26086 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26087 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26088 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26089 behaviour of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26090 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26091 is not needed any more.
26092
26093 @item
26094 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26095
26096 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26097 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26098 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26099 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26100 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26101 groups.
26102
26103 @item
26104 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26105
26106 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26107 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26108
26109 @item
26110 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26111
26112 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26113 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26114 lisp directory into load-path.
26115
26116 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26117 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26118
26119 @item
26120 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26121
26122 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26123
26124 @item
26125 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26126
26127 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26128 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26129 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26130 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26131
26132 @item
26133 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26134
26135 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26136 @lisp
26137 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26138 'bbdb-complete-name)
26139 @end lisp
26140
26141 @item
26142 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26143
26144 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26145 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26146 local files as external parts.
26147
26148 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26149 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26150 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26151 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26152 that support editing.
26153
26154 @item
26155 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26156
26157 The default value is determined from the
26158 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26159 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26160 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26161
26162 @item
26163 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26164
26165 Add a new format of match like
26166 @lisp
26167 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26168 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26169 @end lisp
26170 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26171 @lisp
26172 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26173 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26174 @end lisp
26175
26176 @item
26177 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26178
26179 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26180 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26181 need add those two headers too.
26182
26183 @item
26184 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26185
26186 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26187 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26188 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26189
26190 @item
26191 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26192 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26193 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26194 versions.
26195
26196 @item
26197 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26198
26199 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26200
26201 @item
26202 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26203
26204 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26205
26206 @item
26207 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26208
26209 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26210 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26211 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26212
26213 @item
26214 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26215
26216 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26217 the valid values.
26218
26219 @item
26220 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26221
26222 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26223 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26224 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26225 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26226 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26227 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26228 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26229 The behaviour can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26230
26231 @item
26232 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26233
26234 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26235 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26236 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26237 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26238 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26239
26240 @item
26241 Extended format specs.
26242
26243 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26244 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26245 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26246 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26247 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26248 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26249
26250 @item
26251 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26252
26253 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26254 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26255 out other articles.
26256
26257 @item Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26258
26259 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26260 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26261 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26262 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26263
26264 @item
26265 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26266
26267 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26268 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26269 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26270
26271 @item
26272 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26273
26274 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26275 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26276 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26277 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26278 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26279 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26280 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26281 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26282 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26283 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26284 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26285
26286 @item
26287 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26288 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26289
26290 @item
26291 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26292 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26293 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26294 message, Message Manual}).
26295
26296 @item
26297 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26298 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26299
26300 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26301 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26302 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26303 @lisp
26304 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26305 @end lisp
26306
26307 @item
26308 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26309 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26310
26311 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26312 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26313 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26314 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26315
26316 @item
26317 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26318
26319 @item
26320 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26321 C-m}.
26322
26323 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26324 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26325
26326 @item
26327 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26328
26329 The behaviour for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26330 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26331 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26332 invalidate the digital signature.
26333 @end itemize
26334
26335 @iftex
26336
26337 @page
26338 @node The Manual
26339 @section The Manual
26340 @cindex colophon
26341 @cindex manual
26342
26343 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26344 either @code{texi2dvi}
26345 @iflatex
26346 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26347 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26348 @end iflatex
26349 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26350
26351 The following conventions have been used:
26352
26353 @enumerate
26354
26355 @item
26356 This is a @samp{string}
26357
26358 @item
26359 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26360
26361 @item
26362 This is a @file{file}
26363
26364 @item
26365 This is a @code{symbol}
26366
26367 @end enumerate
26368
26369 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26370 mean:
26371
26372 @lisp
26373 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26374 @end lisp
26375
26376 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26377
26378 @lisp
26379 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26380 @end lisp
26381
26382 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26383 ever get them confused.
26384
26385 @iflatex
26386 @c @head
26387 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26388 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26389 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26390 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26391 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26392 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26393 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26394 @end iflatex
26395
26396 @end iftex
26397
26398
26399 @node On Writing Manuals
26400 @section On Writing Manuals
26401
26402 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26403 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26404 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26405 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26406 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26407 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26408 hand in hand.
26409
26410 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26411 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26412 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26413 started with Gnus.
26414
26415 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26416 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26417
26418
26419 @page
26420 @node Terminology
26421 @section Terminology
26422
26423 @cindex terminology
26424 @table @dfn
26425
26426 @item news
26427 @cindex news
26428 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26429 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26430 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26431 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26432 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26433
26434 @item mail
26435 @cindex mail
26436 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26437 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26438 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26439 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26440
26441 @item reply
26442 @cindex reply
26443 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26444
26445 @item follow up
26446 @cindex follow up
26447 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26448 are reading.
26449
26450 @item back end
26451 @cindex back end
26452 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26453 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26454 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26455 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26456 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26457 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26458 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26459 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26460 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26461 number 4711''.
26462
26463 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26464 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26465 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26466 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26467 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26468 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26469
26470 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26471 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26472 access the articles.
26473
26474 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26475 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26476 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26477 confusing.
26478
26479 @item native
26480 @cindex native
26481 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26482 default, way of getting news.
26483
26484 @item foreign
26485 @cindex foreign
26486 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26487 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26488 news.
26489
26490 @item secondary
26491 @cindex secondary
26492 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26493 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26494
26495 @item article
26496 @cindex article
26497 A message that has been posted as news.
26498
26499 @item mail message
26500 @cindex mail message
26501 A message that has been mailed.
26502
26503 @item message
26504 @cindex message
26505 A mail message or news article
26506
26507 @item head
26508 @cindex head
26509 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26510 put.
26511
26512 @item body
26513 @cindex body
26514 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26515 body.
26516
26517 @item header
26518 @cindex header
26519 A line from the head of an article.
26520
26521 @item headers
26522 @cindex headers
26523 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26524 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26525
26526 @item @acronym{NOV}
26527 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26528 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26529 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26530 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26531 normal @sc{head} format.
26532
26533 @item level
26534 @cindex levels
26535 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26536 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26537 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26538 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26539 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26540 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26541
26542 @item killed groups
26543 @cindex killed groups
26544 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26545 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26546
26547 @item zombie groups
26548 @cindex zombie groups
26549 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26550
26551 @item active file
26552 @cindex active file
26553 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26554 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26555 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26556
26557 @item bogus groups
26558 @cindex bogus groups
26559 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26560 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26561 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26562
26563 @item activating
26564 @cindex activating groups
26565 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26566 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26567 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26568
26569 @item server
26570 @cindex server
26571 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26572
26573 @item select method
26574 @cindex select method
26575 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26576 server settings.
26577
26578 @item virtual server
26579 @cindex virtual server
26580 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26581 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26582 whole is a virtual server.
26583
26584 @item washing
26585 @cindex washing
26586 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26587 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26588 original.
26589
26590 @item ephemeral groups
26591 @cindex ephemeral groups
26592 @cindex temporary groups
26593 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26594 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26595 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26596
26597 @item solid groups
26598 @cindex solid groups
26599 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26600 group buffer are solid groups.
26601
26602 @item sparse articles
26603 @cindex sparse articles
26604 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26605 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26606
26607 @item threading
26608 @cindex threading
26609 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26610 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26611
26612 @item root
26613 @cindex root
26614 @cindex thread root
26615 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26616 articles in the thread.
26617
26618 @item parent
26619 @cindex parent
26620 An article that has responses.
26621
26622 @item child
26623 @cindex child
26624 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26625
26626 @item digest
26627 @cindex digest
26628 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26629 specified by RFC 1153.
26630
26631 @item splitting
26632 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26633 @cindex mail sorting
26634 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26635 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26636 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26637
26638 @end table
26639
26640
26641 @page
26642 @node Customization
26643 @section Customization
26644 @cindex general customization
26645
26646 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26647 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26648 for some quite common situations.
26649
26650 @menu
26651 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26652 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26653 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26654 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26655 @end menu
26656
26657
26658 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26659 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26660
26661 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26662 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26663 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26664
26665 @table @code
26666
26667 @item gnus-read-active-file
26668 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26669 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
26670 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26671 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26672 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26673
26674 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26675 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26676 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26677 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26678 @end table
26679
26680
26681 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26682 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26683
26684 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26685 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26686 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26687
26688 @table @code
26689
26690 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26691 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26692 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26693 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26694 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26695
26696 @item gnus-visible-headers
26697 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26698 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26699 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26700 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26701
26702 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
26703 @lisp
26704 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26705 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26706 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26707 @end lisp
26708
26709 @item gnus-use-full-window
26710 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26711 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26712 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26713 want to read them anyway.
26714
26715 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26716 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26717 hidden initially.
26718
26719
26720 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26721 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26722 lines, which might save some time.
26723 @end table
26724
26725
26726 @node Little Disk Space
26727 @subsection Little Disk Space
26728 @cindex disk space
26729
26730 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26731 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26732
26733 @table @code
26734
26735 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26736 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26737 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26738 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26739 default.
26740
26741 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26742 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26743 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26744 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26745 default.
26746
26747 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26748 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26749 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26750 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26751 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26752
26753 @end table
26754
26755
26756 @node Slow Machine
26757 @subsection Slow Machine
26758 @cindex slow machine
26759
26760 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26761 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26762
26763 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26764 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26765
26766 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26767 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26768 summary buffer faster.
26769
26770
26771 @page
26772 @node Troubleshooting
26773 @section Troubleshooting
26774 @cindex troubleshooting
26775
26776 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26777 problems, really.
26778
26779 Ahem.
26780
26781 @enumerate
26782
26783 @item
26784 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26785
26786 @item
26787 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26788 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26789 Gnus will work.
26790
26791 @item
26792 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26793 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26794 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26795
26796 @item
26797 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26798 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26799
26800 @item
26801 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26802 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26803 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26804 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26805 something like that.
26806 @end enumerate
26807
26808 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26809
26810 @cindex bugs
26811 @cindex reporting bugs
26812
26813 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26814 @findex gnus-bug
26815 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26816 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26817 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26818 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26819
26820 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26821 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26822 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26823 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26824 time.
26825
26826 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26827 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26828 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26829 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26830 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26831 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26832
26833 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26834 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26835 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26836 the bug report.
26837
26838 @cindex patches
26839 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26840 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26841
26842 @cindex edebug
26843 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26844 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26845 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26846 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26847 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26848 you discover some weird behaviour when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26849 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26850 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26851 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26852 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26853 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26854 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26855 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26856 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26857
26858 @cindex elp
26859 @cindex profile
26860 @cindex slow
26861 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26862 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26863 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26864 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26865 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26866
26867 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26868 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26869 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26870 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26871 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26872 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
26873 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
26874 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
26875 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
26876 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
26877 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
26878 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
26879 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
26880 work perfectly.
26881
26882 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
26883 @cindex ding mailing list
26884 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
26885 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
26886 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
26887 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
26888
26889
26890 @page
26891 @node Gnus Reference Guide
26892 @section Gnus Reference Guide
26893
26894 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
26895 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
26896 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
26897 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
26898 it.
26899
26900 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
26901 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
26902 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
26903 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
26904 and general methods of operation.
26905
26906 @menu
26907 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
26908 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
26909 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
26910 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
26911 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
26912 * Group Info:: The group info format.
26913 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
26914 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
26915 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
26916 @end menu
26917
26918
26919 @node Gnus Utility Functions
26920 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
26921 @cindex Gnus utility functions
26922 @cindex utility functions
26923 @cindex functions
26924 @cindex internal variables
26925
26926 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
26927 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
26928 Below is a list of the most common ones.
26929
26930 @table @code
26931
26932 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
26933 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
26934 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
26935
26936 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
26937 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
26938 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
26939
26940 @item gnus-group-real-name
26941 @findex gnus-group-real-name
26942 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
26943 name.
26944
26945 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
26946 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
26947 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
26948 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
26949
26950 @item gnus-get-info
26951 @findex gnus-get-info
26952 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
26953
26954 @item gnus-group-unread
26955 @findex gnus-group-unread
26956 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
26957 unknown.
26958
26959 @item gnus-active
26960 @findex gnus-active
26961 The active entry for @var{group}.
26962
26963 @item gnus-set-active
26964 @findex gnus-set-active
26965 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
26966
26967 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26968 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26969 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
26970 exit.
26971
26972 @item gnus-continuum-version
26973 @findex gnus-continuum-version
26974 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
26975 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
26976 versions.
26977
26978 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
26979 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
26980 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
26981
26982 @item gnus-news-group-p
26983 @findex gnus-news-group-p
26984 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
26985
26986 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
26987 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
26988 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
26989
26990 @item gnus-server-to-method
26991 @findex gnus-server-to-method
26992 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
26993
26994 @item gnus-server-equal
26995 @findex gnus-server-equal
26996 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
26997
26998 @item gnus-group-native-p
26999 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27000 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27001
27002 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27003 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27004 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27005
27006 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27007 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27008 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27009
27010 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27011 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27012 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27013 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27014
27015 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27016 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27017 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27018
27019 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27020 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27021 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27022
27023 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27024 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27025 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27026 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27027
27028 @lisp
27029 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27030 @result{} t
27031 @end lisp
27032
27033 @item gnus-read-method
27034 @findex gnus-read-method
27035 Prompts the user for a select method.
27036
27037 @end table
27038
27039
27040 @node Back End Interface
27041 @subsection Back End Interface
27042
27043 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27044 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27045 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27046 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27047 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27048 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27049
27050 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27051 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27052 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27053 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27054 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27055 been opened, the function should fail.
27056
27057 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27058 name. Take this example:
27059
27060 @lisp
27061 (nntp "odd-one"
27062 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27063 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27064 @end lisp
27065
27066 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27067 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27068
27069 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27070 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27071 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27072
27073 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27074 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27075 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27076
27077 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27078 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27079 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27080 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27081 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27082 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27083 return value.
27084
27085 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27086 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27087 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27088 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27089 more.
27090
27091 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27092 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27093 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27094 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27095 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27096 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27097 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27098 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27099 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27100 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27101
27102 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27103 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27104 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27105 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27106 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27107 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27108 of numbers as long as possible.
27109
27110 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27111 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27112 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27113
27114 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27115 @code{nnchoke}.
27116
27117 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27118
27119 @menu
27120 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27121 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27122 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27123 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27124 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27125 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27126 @end menu
27127
27128
27129 @node Required Back End Functions
27130 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27131
27132 @table @code
27133
27134 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27135
27136 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27137 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27138 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27139 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27140
27141 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27142 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27143 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27144 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27145
27146 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27147 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27148 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27149 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27150 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27151 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27152 number, do maximum fetches.
27153
27154 Here's an example HEAD:
27155
27156 @example
27157 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27158 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27159 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27160 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27161 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27162 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27163 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27164 Lines: 26
27165 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27166 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27167 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27168 .
27169 @end example
27170
27171 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27172 these in the data buffer.
27173
27174 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27175
27176 @example
27177 headers = *head
27178 head = error / valid-head
27179 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27180 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27181 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27182 header = <text> eol
27183 @end example
27184
27185 @cindex BNF
27186 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27187
27188 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27189 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27190 separated by tabs.
27191
27192 @example
27193 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27194 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27195 field = <text except TAB>
27196 @end example
27197
27198 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27199 @pxref{Headers}.
27200
27201
27202 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27203
27204 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27205 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27206
27207 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27208 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27209 server. In fact, it should do so.
27210
27211 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27212 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27213
27214
27215 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27216
27217 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27218 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27219 reason.
27220
27221 There should be no data returned.
27222
27223
27224 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27225
27226 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27227 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27228 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27229 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27230
27231 There should be no data returned.
27232
27233
27234 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27235
27236 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27237 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27238 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27239 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27240
27241 There should be no data returned.
27242
27243
27244 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27245
27246 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27247
27248 There should be no data returned.
27249
27250
27251 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27252
27253 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27254 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27255 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27256 it would be nice if that were possible.
27257
27258 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27259 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27260 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27261 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27262 into its article buffer.
27263
27264 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27265 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27266 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27267 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27268 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27269 on successful article retrieval.
27270
27271
27272 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27273
27274 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27275 making @var{group} the current group.
27276
27277 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27278 the current group.
27279
27280 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27281
27282 @example
27283 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27284 @end example
27285
27286 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27287 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27288 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27289 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27290 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27291 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27292 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27293 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27294 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27295 highest as 0.
27296
27297 @example
27298 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27299 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27300 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27301 @end example
27302
27303
27304 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27305
27306 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27307 a no-op on most back ends.
27308
27309 There should be no data returned.
27310
27311
27312 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27313
27314 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27315 @emph{all}.
27316
27317 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27318
27319 @example
27320 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27321 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27322 @end example
27323
27324 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27325 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27326 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27327 and the highest as 0.
27328
27329 @example
27330 active-file = *active-line
27331 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27332 name = <string>
27333 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27334 @end example
27335
27336 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27337 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27338 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27339
27340
27341 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27342
27343 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27344 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27345 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27346 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27347 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27348 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27349
27350 There should be no result data from this function.
27351
27352 @end table
27353
27354
27355 @node Optional Back End Functions
27356 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27357
27358 @table @code
27359
27360 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27361
27362 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27363 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27364 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27365
27366 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27367 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27368 former is in the same format as the data from
27369 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27370 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27371
27372 @example
27373 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27374 @end example
27375
27376
27377 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27378
27379 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27380 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27381 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27382 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27383 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27384
27385 There should be no result data from this function.
27386
27387
27388 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27389
27390 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27391 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27392 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27393 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27394 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27395 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27396 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27397 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27398
27399 There should be no result data from this function.
27400
27401
27402 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27403
27404 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27405 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27406 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27407 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27408 propagate the mark information to the server.
27409
27410 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27411
27412 @example
27413 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27414 @end example
27415
27416 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27417 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27418 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27419 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27420 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27421 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27422 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27423 possible, not limit itself to these.
27424
27425 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27426 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27427 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27428 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27429
27430 An example action list:
27431
27432 @example
27433 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27434 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27435 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27436 @end example
27437
27438 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27439 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27440
27441 There should be no result data from this function.
27442
27443 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27444
27445 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27446 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27447 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27448 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27449 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27450
27451 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27452 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27453 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27454 expirable.
27455
27456 There should be no result data from this function.
27457
27458
27459 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27460
27461 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27462 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27463 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27464 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27465 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27466 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27467 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27468 local if that's practical.
27469
27470 There should be no result data from this function.
27471
27472
27473 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27474
27475 The result data from this function should be a description of
27476 @var{group}.
27477
27478 @example
27479 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27480 name = <string>
27481 description = <text>
27482 @end example
27483
27484 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27485
27486 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27487 groups available on the server.
27488
27489 @example
27490 description-buffer = *description-line
27491 @end example
27492
27493
27494 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27495
27496 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27497 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27498 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27499 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27500 in the active buffer format.
27501
27502 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27503 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27504 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27505 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27506 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27507 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27508 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27509
27510
27511 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27512
27513 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27514
27515 There should be no return data.
27516
27517
27518 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27519
27520 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27521 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27522 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27523 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27524 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27525 they are.
27526
27527 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27528 able to delete.
27529
27530 There should be no result data returned.
27531
27532
27533 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27534
27535 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27536 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27537
27538 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27539 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27540 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27541 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27542 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27543 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27544
27545 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27546 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27547 optimizations.
27548
27549 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27550 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27551
27552 There should be no data returned.
27553
27554
27555 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27556
27557 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27558 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27559 this function in short order.
27560
27561 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27562 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27563
27564 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27565 article for that group.
27566
27567 There should be no data returned.
27568
27569
27570 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27571
27572 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27573 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27574
27575 There should be no data returned.
27576
27577
27578 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27579
27580 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27581 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27582 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27583
27584 There should be no data returned.
27585
27586
27587 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27588
27589 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27590 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27591
27592 There should be no data returned.
27593
27594 @end table
27595
27596
27597 @node Error Messaging
27598 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27599
27600 @findex nnheader-report
27601 @findex nnheader-get-report
27602 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27603 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27604 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27605 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27606 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27607 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27608
27609 @lisp
27610 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27611
27612 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27613 @end lisp
27614
27615 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27616 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27617 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27618 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27619
27620 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27621 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27622 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27623
27624
27625 @node Writing New Back Ends
27626 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27627
27628 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27629 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27630 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27631 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27632 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27633 editing articles.
27634
27635 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27636 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27637 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27638
27639 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27640 package called @code{nnoo}.
27641
27642 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27643 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27644 following macros:
27645
27646 @table @code
27647
27648 @item nnoo-declare
27649 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27650 parameters. For instance:
27651
27652 @lisp
27653 (nnoo-declare nndir
27654 nnml nnmh)
27655 @end lisp
27656
27657 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27658 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27659
27660 @item defvoo
27661 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27662 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27663 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27664
27665 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27666 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27667 a function in those back ends.
27668
27669 @lisp
27670 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27671 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27672 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27673 @end lisp
27674
27675 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27676 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27677 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27678
27679 @item nnoo-define-basics
27680 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27681 have.
27682
27683 @lisp
27684 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27685 @end lisp
27686
27687 @item deffoo
27688 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27689 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27690 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27691
27692 @item nnoo-map-functions
27693 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27694 functions from the parent back ends.
27695
27696 @lisp
27697 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27698 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27699 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27700 @end lisp
27701
27702 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27703 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27704 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27705 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27706
27707 @item nnoo-import
27708 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27709 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27710 haven't already been defined.
27711
27712 @lisp
27713 (nnoo-import nndir
27714 (nnmh
27715 nnmh-request-list
27716 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27717 (nnml))
27718 @end lisp
27719
27720 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27721 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27722 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27723 defined now.
27724
27725 @end table
27726
27727 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27728
27729 @lisp
27730 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27731 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27732
27733 ;;; @r{Code:}
27734
27735 (require 'nnheader)
27736 (require 'nnmh)
27737 (require 'nnml)
27738 (require 'nnoo)
27739 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27740
27741 (nnoo-declare nndir
27742 nnml nnmh)
27743
27744 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27745 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27746 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27747
27748 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27749 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27750 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27751
27752 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27753 nil
27754 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27755 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27756 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27757
27758 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27759 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27760
27761 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27762
27763 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27764
27765 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27766 (setq nndir-directory
27767 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27768 server))
27769 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27770 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27771 (push `(nndir-current-group
27772 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27773 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27774 defs)
27775 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27776 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27777 defs)
27778 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27779
27780 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27781 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27782 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27783 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27784 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27785
27786 (nnoo-import nndir
27787 (nnmh
27788 nnmh-status-message
27789 nnmh-request-list
27790 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27791
27792 (provide 'nndir)
27793 @end lisp
27794
27795
27796 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27797 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27798
27799 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27800 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27801 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27802 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27803 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27804
27805 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27806 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27807
27808 Here's an example:
27809
27810 @lisp
27811 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27812 @end lisp
27813
27814 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27815
27816 The abilities can be:
27817
27818 @table @code
27819 @item mail
27820 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27821 @item post
27822 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27823 @item post-mail
27824 This back end supports both mail and news.
27825 @item none
27826 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27827 different.
27828 @item respool
27829 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27830 articles and groups.
27831 @item address
27832 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27833 true for almost all back ends.
27834 @item prompt-address
27835 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27836 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27837 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27838 @end table
27839
27840
27841 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27842 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27843
27844 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27845 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27846 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27847 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27848
27849 @lisp
27850 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27851 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27852 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27853 @end lisp
27854
27855 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27856 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27857 mail.
27858
27859 This function takes four parameters.
27860
27861 @table @var
27862 @item method
27863 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27864 the call.
27865
27866 @item exit-function
27867 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27868
27869 @item temp-directory
27870 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27871
27872 @item group
27873 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
27874 performed for one group only.
27875 @end table
27876
27877 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
27878 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
27879 find the article number assigned to this article.
27880
27881 The function also uses the following variables:
27882 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
27883 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
27884 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
27885 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
27886 this:
27887
27888 @example
27889 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
27890 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
27891 @end example
27892
27893
27894 @node Score File Syntax
27895 @subsection Score File Syntax
27896
27897 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
27898 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
27899 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
27900
27901 Here's a typical score file:
27902
27903 @lisp
27904 (("summary"
27905 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
27906 ("Gnus"))
27907 ("from"
27908 ("Lars" -1000))
27909 (mark -100))
27910 @end lisp
27911
27912 BNF definition of a score file:
27913
27914 @example
27915 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
27916 element = rule / atom
27917 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
27918 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
27919 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
27920 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
27921 quote = <ascii 34>
27922 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
27923 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
27924 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
27925 date-header = "date"
27926 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27927 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27928 score = "nil" / <integer>
27929 date = "nil" / <natural number>
27930 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
27931 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
27932 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
27933 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
27934 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27935 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27936 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
27937 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27938 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
27939 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
27940 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
27941 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
27942 exclude-files / read-only / touched
27943 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
27944 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
27945 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
27946 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
27947 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
27948 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
27949 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
27950 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
27951 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
27952 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
27953 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
27954 eval = "eval" space <form>
27955 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
27956 @end example
27957
27958 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
27959 discarded.
27960
27961 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
27962 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
27963 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
27964 one looong line, then that's ok.
27965
27966 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
27967 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27968
27969
27970 @node Headers
27971 @subsection Headers
27972
27973 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
27974 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
27975 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
27976 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
27977
27978 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
27979 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
27980 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
27981 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
27982 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
27983 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
27984 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
27985
27986 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
27987 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
27988 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
27989 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
27990 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
27991
27992 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
27993 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
27994
27995
27996 @node Ranges
27997 @subsection Ranges
27998
27999 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28000 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28001
28002 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28003 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28004 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28005 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28006
28007 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28008 sequence.
28009
28010 @example
28011 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28012 @end example
28013
28014 is transformed into
28015
28016 @example
28017 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28018 @end example
28019
28020 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28021 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28022
28023 @example
28024 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28025 @end example
28026
28027 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28028 is slightly tricky:
28029
28030 @example
28031 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28032 @end example
28033
28034 and
28035
28036 @example
28037 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28038 @end example
28039
28040 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28041
28042 @example
28043 (1 2 3 4 5)
28044 @end example
28045
28046 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28047 also valid:
28048
28049 @example
28050 (1 . 5)
28051 @end example
28052
28053 and is equal to the previous range.
28054
28055 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28056 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28057 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28058 range handling.)
28059
28060 @example
28061 range = simple-range / normal-range
28062 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28063 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28064 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28065 number *[ " " contents ]
28066 @end example
28067
28068 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28069 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28070 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28071 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28072 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28073 sequences.)
28074
28075
28076 @node Group Info
28077 @subsection Group Info
28078
28079 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28080 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28081 describes the group.
28082
28083 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28084 second is a more complex one:
28085
28086 @example
28087 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28088
28089 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28090 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28091 (nnml "")
28092 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28093 @end example
28094
28095 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28096 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28097 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28098 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28099 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28100 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28101 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28102 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28103 this section is about.
28104
28105 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28106 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28107 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28108
28109 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28110
28111 @example
28112 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28113 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28114 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28115 group = quote <string> quote
28116 ralevel = rank / level
28117 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28118 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28119 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28120 read = range
28121 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28122 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28123 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28124 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28125 @end example
28126
28127 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28128 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28129 in pseudo-BNF.
28130
28131 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28132 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28133
28134 @table @code
28135 @item gnus-info-group
28136 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28137 @findex gnus-info-group
28138 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28139 Get/set the group name.
28140
28141 @item gnus-info-rank
28142 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28143 @findex gnus-info-rank
28144 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28145 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28146
28147 @item gnus-info-level
28148 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28149 @findex gnus-info-level
28150 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28151 Get/set the group level.
28152
28153 @item gnus-info-score
28154 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28155 @findex gnus-info-score
28156 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28157 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28158
28159 @item gnus-info-read
28160 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28161 @findex gnus-info-read
28162 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28163 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28164
28165 @item gnus-info-marks
28166 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28167 @findex gnus-info-marks
28168 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28169 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28170
28171 @item gnus-info-method
28172 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28173 @findex gnus-info-method
28174 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28175 Get/set the group select method.
28176
28177 @item gnus-info-params
28178 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28179 @findex gnus-info-params
28180 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28181 Get/set the group parameters.
28182 @end table
28183
28184 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28185 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28186
28187 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28188 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28189 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28190 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28191
28192
28193 @node Extended Interactive
28194 @subsection Extended Interactive
28195 @cindex interactive
28196 @findex gnus-interactive
28197
28198 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28199 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28200 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28201
28202 @lisp
28203 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28204 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28205 ...
28206 )
28207 @end lisp
28208
28209 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28210 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28211 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28212 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28213 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28214 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28215 @code{interactive}.
28216
28217 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28218 adds a few more.
28219
28220 @table @samp
28221 @item y
28222 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28223 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28224 variable.
28225
28226 @item Y
28227 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28228 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28229 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28230
28231 @item A
28232 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28233 function.
28234
28235 @item H
28236 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28237 function.
28238
28239 @item g
28240 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28241 function.
28242
28243 @end table
28244
28245
28246 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28247 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28248 @cindex XEmacs
28249 @cindex Emacsen
28250
28251 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28252 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28253 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28254
28255 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28256 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28257 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28258 Gnus, that's very useful.
28259
28260 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28261 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28262 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28263 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28264 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28265 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28266 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28267 following function:
28268
28269 @lisp
28270 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28271 (start-itimer
28272 "gnus-run-at-time"
28273 `(lambda ()
28274 (,function ,@@args))
28275 time repeat))
28276 @end lisp
28277
28278 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28279 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28280 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28281 all over.
28282
28283 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28284 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28285 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28286
28287 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28288 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28289 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28290
28291
28292 @node Various File Formats
28293 @subsection Various File Formats
28294
28295 @menu
28296 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28297 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28298 @end menu
28299
28300
28301 @node Active File Format
28302 @subsubsection Active File Format
28303
28304 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28305 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28306 in each group.
28307
28308 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28309
28310 @example
28311 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28312 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28313 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28314 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28315 no.general 1000 900 y
28316 @end example
28317
28318 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28319
28320 @example
28321 active = *group-line
28322 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28323 group = <non-white-space string>
28324 spc = " "
28325 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28326 low-number = <positive integer>
28327 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28328 @end example
28329
28330 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28331 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28332
28333
28334 @node Newsgroups File Format
28335 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28336
28337 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28338 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28339 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28340 the user.
28341
28342 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28343 Here's the definition:
28344
28345 @example
28346 newsgroups = *line
28347 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28348 group = <non-white-space string>
28349 tab = <TAB>
28350 description = <string>
28351 @end example
28352
28353
28354 @page
28355 @node Emacs for Heathens
28356 @section Emacs for Heathens
28357
28358 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28359 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28360 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28361 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28362 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28363 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28364 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28365 cat instead.
28366
28367 @menu
28368 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28369 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28370 @end menu
28371
28372
28373 @node Keystrokes
28374 @subsection Keystrokes
28375
28376 @itemize @bullet
28377 @item
28378 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28379
28380 @item
28381 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28382 @end itemize
28383
28384 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28385 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28386 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28387 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28388 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28389 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28390
28391 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28392 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28393 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28394 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28395 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28396 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28397 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28398
28399 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28400 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28401 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28402 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28403 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28404 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28405 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28406
28407 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28408 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28409 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28410 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28411 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28412 it.
28413
28414
28415
28416 @node Emacs Lisp
28417 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28418
28419 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28420 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28421 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28422 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28423
28424 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28425 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28426 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28427 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28428 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28429 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28430 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
28431 to customize Gnus.
28432
28433 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28434 write the following:
28435
28436 @lisp
28437 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28438 @end lisp
28439
28440 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28441 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28442 you can go and fill your @file{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
28443 how Gnus works.
28444
28445 If you have put that thing in your @file{.emacs} file, it will be read
28446 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28447 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28448 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28449 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28450
28451 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28452 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28453 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28454
28455 Some pitfalls:
28456
28457 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28458 that means:
28459
28460 @lisp
28461 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28462 @end lisp
28463
28464 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28465 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28466
28467 @lisp
28468 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28469 @end lisp
28470
28471 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28472 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28473
28474 @page
28475 @include gnus-faq.texi
28476
28477 @node Index
28478 @chapter Index
28479 @printindex cp
28480
28481 @node Key Index
28482 @chapter Key Index
28483 @printindex ky
28484
28485 @summarycontents
28486 @contents
28487 @bye
28488
28489 @iftex
28490 @iflatex
28491 \end{document}
28492 @end iflatex
28493 @end iftex
28494
28495 @c Local Variables:
28496 @c mode: texinfo
28497 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28498 @c End:
28499
28500 @ignore
28501 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28502 @end ignore